home *** CD-ROM | disk | FTP | other *** search
Text File | 1994-03-01 | 557.2 KB | 12,639 lines |
- ***The Project Gutenberg Etext of Jules Verne's Classic Books****
- ******From the Earth to the Moon. . .and. . .Round the Moon******
- *******This file should be named moon10.txt or moon10.zip********
-
- Corrected EDITIONS of our etexts get a new NUMBER, moon11.txt.
- VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, moon10a.txt.
-
- This is **moon10.txt** and it shows italics as _italics_
- The file **moon10a.txt** has no markings for italics.
-
-
- Typed in by Rich Schroeppel.
- Proofread by one of our anonymous volunteers.
-
- Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
-
- We produce about one million dollars for each hour we work. One
- hundred hours is a conservative estimate for how long it we take
- to get any etext selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
- searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. This
- projected audience is one hundred million readers. If our value
- per text is nominally estimated at one dollar, then we produce a
- million dollars per hour; next year we will have to do four text
- files per month, thus upping our productivity to two million/hr.
- The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away One Trillion Etext
- Files by the December 31, 2001. [10,000 x 100,000,000=Trillion]
- This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers.
-
- We need your donations more than ever!
-
- All donations should be made to "Project Gutenberg/IBC", and are
- tax deductible to the extent allowable by law ("IBC" is Illinois
- Benedictine College). (Subscriptions to our paper newsletter go
- to IBC, too)
-
- For these and other matters, please mail to:
-
- David Turner, Project Gutenberg
- Illinois Benedictine College
- 5700 College Road
- Lisle, IL 60532-0900
-
- Email requests to:
- Internet: chipmonk@eagle.ibc.edu (David Turner)
- Compuserve: chipmonk@eagle.ibc.edu (David Turner)
- Attmail: internet!chipmonk@eagle.ibc.edu (David Turner)
- MCImail: (David Turner)
- ADDRESS TYPE: MCI / EMS: INTERNET / MBX:chipmonk@eagle.ibc.edu
-
- We would prefer to send you this information by email
- (Internet, Bitnet, Compuserve, ATTMAIL or MCImail).
-
- ******
- If you have an FTP program (or emulator), please:
-
- FTP directly to the Project Gutenberg archives:
- ftp mrcnext.cso.uiuc.edu
- login: anonymous
- password: your@login
- cd etext/etext91
- or cd etext92 [for new books] [now also cd etext/etext92]
- or cd etext/articles [get suggest gut for more information]
- dir [to see files]
- get or mget [to get files. . .set bin for zip files]
- GET INDEX and AAINDEX
- for a list of books
- and
- GET NEW GUT for general information
- and
- MGET GUT* for newsletters.
-
- **Information prepared by the Project Gutenberg legal advisor**
- (Three Pages)
-
- ****START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS**START****
-
- Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
- They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
- your copy of this etext, even if you got it for free from
- someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
- fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
- disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
- you can distribute copies of this etext if you want to.
-
- *BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS ETEXT
-
- By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext,
- you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept this
- "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive a
- refund of the money (if any) you paid for this etext by sending
- a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person you got
- it from. If you received this etext on a physical medium (such
- as a disk), you must return it with your request.
-
- ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM ETEXTS
-
- This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
- etexts, is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor
- Michael S. Hart through the Project Gutenberg Association (the
- "Project"). Among other things, this means that no one owns a
- United States copyright on or for this work, so the Project (and
- you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
- permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special
- rules, set forth below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute
- this etext under the Project's "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
-
- To create these etexts, the Project expends considerable efforts
- to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain works.
- Despite these efforts, the Project's etexts and any medium they
- may be on may contain "Defects". Among other things, Defects
- may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or corrupt data,
- transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual property
- infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other etext medium,
- a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be
- read by your equipment.
-
- DISCLAIMER
-
- But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
- [1] the Project (and any other party you may receive this etext
- from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext) disclaims all liability to
- you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal fees, and
- [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR UNDER STRICT LIABILI-
- TY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT, INCLUDING BUT NOT
- LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR INCIDENTAL
- DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
- DAMAGES.
-
- If you discover a Defect in this etext within 90 days of
- receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any) you
- paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that time to
- the person you received it from. If you received it on a
- physical medium, you must return it with your note, and such
- person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement copy.
- If you received it electronically, such person may choose to
- alternatively give you a second opportunity to receive it elec-
- tronically.
-
- THIS ETEXT IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
- WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
- TO THE ETEXT OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
- LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
- PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
-
- Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
- the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
- above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
- may have other legal rights.
-
- INDEMNITY
-
- You will indemnify and hold the Project, its directors,
- officers, members and agents harmless from all liability, cost
- and expense, including legal fees, that arise from any
- distribution of this etext for which you are responsible, and
- from [1] any alteration, modification or addition to the etext
- for which you are responsible, or [2] any Defect.
-
- DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
-
- You may distribute copies of this etext electronically, or by
- disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this "Small
- Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg, or:
-
- [1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this re-
- quires that you do not remove, alter or modify the etext or
- this "small print!" statement. You may however, if you
- wish, distribute this etext in machine readable binary,
- compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form, including any
- form resulting from conversion by word processing or hyper-
- text software, but only so long as *EITHER*:
-
- [*] The etext, when displayed, is clearly readable. We
- consider an etext *not* clearly readable if it
- contains characters other than those intended by the
- author of the work, although tilde (~), asterisk (*)
- and underline (_) characters may be used to convey
- punctuation intended by the author, and additional
- characters may be used to indicate hypertext links.
-
- [*] The etext may be readily converted by the reader at no
- expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent form
- by the program that displays the etext (as is the
- case, for instance, with most word processors).
-
- [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at no
- additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the etext
- in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC or
- other equivalent proprietary form).
-
- [2] Honor the etext refund and replacement provisions of this
- "Small Print!" statement.
-
- [3] Pay a trademark license fee of 20% (twenty percent) of the
- net profits you derive from distributing this etext under
- the trademark, determined in accordance with generally
- accepted accounting practices. The license fee:
- [*] Is required only if you derive such profits. In
- distributing under our trademark, you incur no
- obligation to charge money or earn profits for your
- distribution.
-
- [*] Shall be paid to "Project Gutenberg Association /
- Illinois Benedictine College" (or to such other person
- as the Project Gutenberg Association may direct)
- within the 60 days following each date you prepare (or
- were legally required to prepare) your year-end tax
- return with respect to your income for that year.
-
- WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
-
- The Project gratefully accepts contributions in money, time,
- scanning machines, OCR software, public domain etexts, royalty
- free copyright licenses, and every other sort of contribution
- you can think of. Money should be paid to "Project Gutenberg
- Association / Illinois Benedictine College".
-
- WRITE TO US! We can be reached at:
-
- Project Gutenberg Director of Communications (PGDIRCOM)
-
- Internet: pgdircom@vmd.cso.uiuc.edu
- Bitnet: pgdircom@uiucvmd
- CompuServe: internet:pgdircom@.vmd.cso.uiuc.edu
- Attmail: internet!vmd.cso.uiuc.edu!pgdircom
-
- Drafted by CHARLES B. KRAMER, Attorney
- CompuServe: 72600,2026
- Internet: 72600.2026@compuserve.com
- Tel: (212) 254-5093
- *END*THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS*Ver.07.02.92*END*
-
-
-
-
- FROM THE EARTH TO THE MOON
-
-
-
- Table of Contents
-
-
- I. The Gun Club
- II. President Barbicane's Communication
- III. Effect of the President's Communication
- IV. Reply From the Observatory of Cambridge
- V. The Romance of the Moon
- VI. The Permissive Limits of Ignorance and Belief in the United States
- VII. The Hymn of the Cannon-Ball
- VIII. History of the Cannon
- IX. The Question of the Powders
- X. One Enemy _V._ Twenty-Five Millions of Friends
- XI. Florida and Texas
- XII. Urbi et Orbi
- XIII. Stones Hill
- XIV. Pickaxe and Trowel
- XV. The Fete of the Casting
- XVI. The Columbiad
- XVII. A Telegraphic Dispatch
- XVIII. The Passenger of the Atlanta
- XIX. A Monster Meeting
- XX. Attack and Riposte
- XXI. How A Frenchman Manages An Affair
- XXII. The New Citizen of the United States
- XXIII. The Projectile-Vehicle
- XXIV. The Telescope of the Rocky Mountains
- XXV. Final Details
- XXVI. Fire!
- XXVII. Foul Weather
- XXVIII. A New Star
-
-
- A TRIP AROUND IT
-
- Preliminary Chapter-- Recapitulating the First Part of
- This Work, and Serving as a Preface to the Second
-
- I. From Twenty Minutes Past Ten to Forty-Seven Minutes Past Ten P. M.
- II. The First Half Hour
- III. Their Place of Shelter
- IV. A Little Algebra
- V. The Cold of Space
- VI. Question and Answer
- VII. A Moment of Intoxication
- VIII. At Seventy-Eight Thousand Five Hundred and Fourteen Leagues
- IX. The Consequences of A Deviation
- X. The Observers of the Moon
- XI. Fancy and Reality
- XII. Orographic Details
- XIII. Lunar Landscapes
- XIV. The Night of Three Hundred and Fifty-Four Hours and A Half
- XV. Hyperbola or Parabola
- XVI. The Southern Hemisphere
- XVII. Tycho
- XVIII. Grave Questions
- XIX. A Struggle Against the Impossible
- XX. The Soundings of the Susquehanna
- XXI. J. T. Maston Recalled
- XXII. Recovered From the Sea
- XXIII. The End
-
-
-
- FROM THE EARTH TO THE MOON
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER I
-
-
- THE GUN CLUB
-
-
- During the War of the Rebellion, a new and influential club was
- established in the city of Baltimore in the State of Maryland.
- It is well known with what energy the taste for military matters
- became developed among that nation of ship-owners, shopkeepers,
- and mechanics. Simple tradesmen jumped their counters to become
- extemporized captains, colonels, and generals, without having
- ever passed the School of Instruction at West Point;
- nevertheless; they quickly rivaled their compeers of the old
- continent, and, like them, carried off victories by dint of
- lavish expenditure in ammunition, money, and men.
-
- But the point in which the Americans singularly distanced the
- Europeans was in the science of gunnery. Not, indeed, that
- their weapons retained a higher degree of perfection than
- theirs, but that they exhibited unheard-of dimensions, and
- consequently attained hitherto unheard-of ranges. In point of
- grazing, plunging, oblique, or enfilading, or point-blank
- firing, the English, French, and Prussians have nothing to
- learn; but their cannon, howitzers, and mortars are mere
- pocket-pistols compared with the formidable engines of the
- American artillery.
-
- This fact need surprise no one. The Yankees, the first
- mechanicians in the world, are engineers-- just as the Italians
- are musicians and the Germans metaphysicians-- by right of birth.
- Nothing is more natural, therefore, than to perceive them
- applying their audacious ingenuity to the science of gunnery.
- Witness the marvels of Parrott, Dahlgren, and Rodman.
- The Armstrong, Palliser, and Beaulieu guns were compelled to bow
- before their transatlantic rivals.
-
- Now when an American has an idea, he directly seeks a second
- American to share it. If there be three, they elect a president
- and two secretaries. Given four, they name a keeper of records,
- and the office is ready for work; five, they convene a general
- meeting, and the club is fully constituted. So things were
- managed in Baltimore. The inventor of a new cannon associated
- himself with the caster and the borer. Thus was formed the
- nucleus of the "Gun Club." In a single month after its formation
- it numbered 1,833 effective members and 30,565 corresponding members.
-
- One condition was imposed as a _sine qua non_ upon every
- candidate for admission into the association, and that was the
- condition of having designed, or (more or less) perfected a
- cannon; or, in default of a cannon, at least a firearm of
- some description. It may, however, be mentioned that mere
- inventors of revolvers, fire-shooting carbines, and similar
- small arms, met with little consideration. Artillerists always
- commanded the chief place of favor.
-
- The estimation in which these gentlemen were held, according to
- one of the most scientific exponents of the Gun Club, was
- "proportional to the masses of their guns, and in the direct
- ratio of the square of the distances attained by their projectiles."
-
- The Gun Club once founded, it is easy to conceive the result of
- the inventive genius of the Americans. Their military weapons
- attained colossal proportions, and their projectiles, exceeding
- the prescribed limits, unfortunately occasionally cut in two
- some unoffending pedestrians. These inventions, in fact, left
- far in the rear the timid instruments of European artillery.
-
- It is but fair to add that these Yankees, brave as they have
- ever proved themselves to be, did not confine themselves to
- theories and formulae, but that they paid heavily, _in propria
- persona_, for their inventions. Among them were to be counted
- officers of all ranks, from lieutenants to generals; military
- men of every age, from those who were just making their _debut_
- in the profession of arms up to those who had grown old in the
- gun-carriage. Many had found their rest on the field of battle
- whose names figured in the "Book of Honor" of the Gun Club; and
- of those who made good their return the greater proportion bore
- the marks of their indisputable valor. Crutches, wooden legs,
- artificial arms, steel hooks, caoutchouc jaws, silver craniums,
- platinum noses, were all to be found in the collection; and it
- was calculated by the great statistician Pitcairn that throughout
- the Gun Club there was not quite one arm between four persons
- and two legs between six.
-
- Nevertheless, these valiant artillerists took no particular
- account of these little facts, and felt justly proud when the
- despatches of a battle returned the number of victims at
- ten-fold the quantity of projectiles expended.
-
- One day, however-- sad and melancholy day!-- peace was signed
- between the survivors of the war; the thunder of the guns
- gradually ceased, the mortars were silent, the howitzers were
- muzzled for an indefinite period, the cannon, with muzzles
- depressed, were returned into the arsenal, the shot were
- repiled, all bloody reminiscences were effaced; the
- cotton-plants grew luxuriantly in the well-manured fields, all
- mourning garments were laid aside, together with grief; and the
- Gun Club was relegated to profound inactivity.
-
- Some few of the more advanced and inveterate theorists set
- themselves again to work upon calculations regarding the laws
- of projectiles. They reverted invariably to gigantic shells
- and howitzers of unparalleled caliber. Still in default of
- practical experience what was the value of mere theories?
- Consequently, the clubrooms became deserted, the servants dozed
- in the antechambers, the newspapers grew mouldy on the tables,
- sounds of snoring came from dark corners, and the members of the
- Gun Club, erstwhile so noisy in their seances, were reduced to
- silence by this disastrous peace and gave themselves up wholly
- to dreams of a Platonic kind of artillery.
-
- "This is horrible!" said Tom Hunter one evening, while rapidly
- carbonizing his wooden legs in the fireplace of the
- smoking-room; "nothing to do! nothing to look forward to! what
- a loathsome existence! When again shall the guns arouse us in
- the morning with their delightful reports?"
-
- "Those days are gone by," said jolly Bilsby, trying to extend
- his missing arms. "It was delightful once upon a time!
- One invented a gun, and hardly was it cast, when one hastened
- to try it in the face of the enemy! Then one returned to camp
- with a word of encouragement from Sherman or a friendly shake
- of the hand from McClellan. But now the generals are gone
- back to their counters; and in place of projectiles, they
- despatch bales of cotton. By Jove, the future of gunnery in
- America is lost!"
-
- "Ay! and no war in prospect!" continued the famous James T.
- Maston, scratching with his steel hook his gutta-percha cranium.
- "Not a cloud on the horizon! and that too at such a critical
- period in the progress of the science of artillery! Yes, gentlemen!
- I who address you have myself this very morning perfected a
- model (plan, section, elevation, etc.) of a mortar destined to
- change all the conditions of warfare!"
-
- "No! is it possible?" replied Tom Hunter, his thoughts reverting
- involuntarily to a former invention of the Hon. J. T. Maston, by
- which, at its first trial, he had succeeded in killing three
- hundred and thirty-seven people.
-
- "Fact!" replied he. "Still, what is the use of so many studies
- worked out, so many difficulties vanquished? It's mere waste
- of time! The New World seems to have made up its mind to live in
- peace; and our bellicose _Tribune_ predicts some approaching
- catastrophes arising out of this scandalous increase of population."
-
- "Nevertheless," replied Colonel Blomsberry, "they are always
- struggling in Europe to maintain the principle of nationalities."
-
- "Well?"
-
- "Well, there might be some field for enterprise down there; and
- if they would accept our services----"
-
- "What are you dreaming of?" screamed Bilsby; "work at gunnery
- for the benefit of foreigners?"
-
- "That would be better than doing nothing here," returned the colonel.
-
- "Quite so," said J. T. Matson; "but still we need not dream of
- that expedient."
-
- "And why not?" demanded the colonel.
-
- "Because their ideas of progress in the Old World are contrary
- to our American habits of thought. Those fellows believe that
- one can't become a general without having served first as an
- ensign; which is as much as to say that one can't point a gun
- without having first cast it oneself!"
-
- "Ridiculous!" replied Tom Hunter, whittling with his bowie-knife
- the arms of his easy chair; "but if that be the case there, all
- that is left for us is to plant tobacco and distill whale-oil."
-
- "What!" roared J. T. Maston, "shall we not employ these
- remaining years of our life in perfecting firearms? Shall there
- never be a fresh opportunity of trying the ranges of projectiles?
- Shall the air never again be lighted with the glare of our guns?
- No international difficulty ever arise to enable us to declare
- war against some transatlantic power? Shall not the French sink
- one of our steamers, or the English, in defiance of the rights
- of nations, hang a few of our countrymen?"
-
- "No such luck," replied Colonel Blomsberry; "nothing of the kind
- is likely to happen; and even if it did, we should not profit by it.
- American susceptibility is fast declining, and we are all going
- to the dogs."
-
- "It is too true," replied J. T. Maston, with fresh violence;
- "there are a thousand grounds for fighting, and yet we don't fight.
- We save up our arms and legs for the benefit of nations who don't
- know what to do with them! But stop-- without going out of one's
- way to find a cause for war-- did not North America once belong
- to the English?"
-
- "Undoubtedly," replied Tom Hunter, stamping his crutch with fury.
-
- "Well, then," replied J. T. Maston, "why should not England in
- her turn belong to the Americans?"
-
- "It would be but just and fair," returned Colonel Blomsberry.
-
- "Go and propose it to the President of the United States," cried
- J. T. Maston, "and see how he will receive you."
-
- "Bah!" growled Bilsby between the four teeth which the war had
- left him; "that will never do!"
-
- "By Jove!" cried J. T. Maston, "he mustn't count on my vote at
- the next election!"
-
- "Nor on ours," replied unanimously all the bellicose invalids.
-
- "Meanwhile," replied J. T. Maston, "allow me to say that, if I
- cannot get an opportunity to try my new mortars on a real field
- of battle, I shall say good-by to the members of the Gun Club,
- and go and bury myself in the prairies of Arkansas!"
-
- "In that case we will accompany you," cried the others.
-
- Matters were in this unfortunate condition, and the club was
- threatened with approaching dissolution, when an unexpected
- circumstance occurred to prevent so deplorable a catastrophe.
-
- On the morrow after this conversation every member of the
- association received a sealed circular couched in the
- following terms:
-
-
- BALTIMORE, October 3.
- The president of the Gun Club has the honor to inform his colleagues
- that, at the meeting of the 5th instant, he will bring before
- them a communication of an extremely interesting nature. He requests,
- therefore, that they will make it convenient to attend in
- accordance with the present invitation. Very cordially,
- IMPEY BARBICANE, P.G.C.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER II
-
-
- PRESIDENT BARBICANE'S COMMUNICATION
-
-
- On the 5th of October, at eight p.m., a dense crowd pressed
- toward the saloons of the Gun Club at No. 21 Union Square.
- All the members of the association resident in Baltimore attended
- the invitation of their president. As regards the corresponding
- members, notices were delivered by hundreds throughout the streets
- of the city, and, large as was the great hall, it was quite
- inadequate to accommodate the crowd of _savants_. They overflowed
- into the adjoining rooms, down the narrow passages, into the
- outer courtyards. There they ran against the vulgar herd who
- pressed up to the doors, each struggling to reach the front ranks,
- all eager to learn the nature of the important communication of
- President Barbicane; all pushing, squeezing, crushing with that
- perfect freedom of action which is so peculiar to the masses when
- educated in ideas of "self-government."
-
- On that evening a stranger who might have chanced to be in
- Baltimore could not have gained admission for love or money into
- the great hall. That was reserved exclusively for resident or
- corresponding members; no one else could possibly have obtained
- a place; and the city magnates, municipal councilors, and
- "select men" were compelled to mingle with the mere townspeople
- in order to catch stray bits of news from the interior.
-
- Nevertheless the vast hall presented a curious spectacle.
- Its immense area was singularly adapted to the purpose.
- Lofty pillars formed of cannon, superposed upon huge mortars as a
- base, supported the fine ironwork of the arches, a perfect piece
- of cast-iron lacework. Trophies of blunderbuses, matchlocks,
- arquebuses, carbines, all kinds of firearms, ancient and modern,
- were picturesquely interlaced against the walls. The gas lit
- up in full glare myriads of revolvers grouped in the form of
- lustres, while groups of pistols, and candelabra formed of
- muskets bound together, completed this magnificent display
- of brilliance. Models of cannon, bronze castings, sights covered
- with dents, plates battered by the shots of the Gun Club,
- assortments of rammers and sponges, chaplets of shells, wreaths
- of projectiles, garlands of howitzers-- in short, all the
- apparatus of the artillerist, enchanted the eye by this
- wonderful arrangement and induced a kind of belief that their
- real purpose was ornamental rather than deadly.
-
- At the further end of the saloon the president, assisted by four
- secretaries, occupied a large platform. His chair, supported by
- a carved gun-carriage, was modeled upon the ponderous proportions
- of a 32-inch mortar. It was pointed at an angle of ninety degrees,
- and suspended upon truncheons, so that the president could balance
- himself upon it as upon a rocking-chair, a very agreeable fact in
- the very hot weather. Upon the table (a huge iron plate supported
- upon six carronades) stood an inkstand of exquisite elegance, made
- of a beautifully chased Spanish piece, and a sonnette, which, when
- required, could give forth a report equal to that of a revolver.
- During violent debates this novel kind of bell scarcely sufficed
- to drown the clamor of these excitable artillerists.
-
- In front of the table benches arranged in zigzag form, like the
- circumvallations of a retrenchment, formed a succession of
- bastions and curtains set apart for the use of the members of
- the club; and on this especial evening one might say, "All the
- world was on the ramparts." The president was sufficiently well
- known, however, for all to be assured that he would not put his
- colleagues to discomfort without some very strong motive.
-
- Impey Barbicane was a man of forty years of age, calm, cold,
- austere; of a singularly serious and self-contained demeanor,
- punctual as a chronometer, of imperturbable temper and immovable
- character; by no means chivalrous, yet adventurous withal, and
- always bringing practical ideas to bear upon the very rashest
- enterprises; an essentially New Englander, a Northern colonist,
- a descendant of the old anti-Stuart Roundheads, and the
- implacable enemy of the gentlemen of the South, those ancient
- cavaliers of the mother country. In a word, he was a Yankee to
- the backbone.
-
- Barbicane had made a large fortune as a timber merchant.
- Being nominated director of artillery during the war, he proved
- himself fertile in invention. Bold in his conceptions, he
- contributed powerfully to the progress of that arm and gave an
- immense impetus to experimental researches.
-
- He was personage of the middle height, having, by a rare
- exception in the Gun Club, all his limbs complete. His strongly
- marked features seemed drawn by square and rule; and if it be
- true that, in order to judge a man's character one must look at
- his profile, Barbicane, so examined, exhibited the most certain
- indications of energy, audacity, and _sang-froid_.
-
- At this moment he was sitting in his armchair, silent, absorbed,
- lost in reflection, sheltered under his high-crowned hat-- a
- kind of black cylinder which always seems firmly screwed upon
- the head of an American.
-
- Just when the deep-toned clock in the great hall struck eight,
- Barbicane, as if he had been set in motion by a spring, raised
- himself up. A profound silence ensued, and the speaker, in a
- somewhat emphatic tone of voice, commenced as follows:
-
- "My brave, colleagues, too long already a paralyzing peace has
- plunged the members of the Gun Club in deplorable inactivity.
- After a period of years full of incidents we have been compelled
- to abandon our labors, and to stop short on the road of progress.
- I do not hesitate to state, baldly, that any war which would
- recall us to arms would be welcome!" (Tremendous applause!)
- "But war, gentlemen, is impossible under existing circumstances;
- and, however we may desire it, many years may elapse before our
- cannon shall again thunder in the field of battle. We must make
- up our minds, then, to seek in another train of ideas some field
- for the activity which we all pine for."
-
- The meeting felt that the president was now approaching the
- critical point, and redoubled their attention accordingly.
-
- "For some months past, my brave colleagues," continued
- Barbicane, "I have been asking myself whether, while confining
- ourselves to our own particular objects, we could not enter upon
- some grand experiment worthy of the nineteenth century; and
- whether the progress of artillery science would not enable us to
- carry it out to a successful issue. I have been considering,
- working, calculating; and the result of my studies is the conviction
- that we are safe to succeed in an enterprise which to any other
- country would appear wholly impracticable. This project, the result
- of long elaboration, is the object of my present communication.
- It is worthy of yourselves, worthy of the antecedents of the Gun
- Club; and it cannot fail to make some noise in the world."
-
- A thrill of excitement ran through the meeting.
-
- Barbicane, having by a rapid movement firmly fixed his hat upon
- his head, calmly continued his harangue:
-
- "There is no one among you, my brave colleagues, who has not
- seen the Moon, or, at least, heard speak of it. Don't be
- surprised if I am about to discourse to you regarding the Queen
- of the Night. It is perhaps reserved for us to become the
- Columbuses of this unknown world. Only enter into my plans, and
- second me with all your power, and I will lead you to its
- conquest, and its name shall be added to those of the thirty-six
- states which compose this Great Union."
-
- "Three cheers for the Moon!" roared the Gun Club, with one voice.
-
- "The moon, gentlemen, has been carefully studied," continued
- Barbicane; "her mass, density, and weight; her constitution,
- motions, distance, as well as her place in the solar system,
- have all been exactly determined. Selenographic charts have
- been constructed with a perfection which equals, if it does not
- even surpass, that of our terrestrial maps. Photography has
- given us proofs of the incomparable beauty of our satellite; all
- is known regarding the moon which mathematical science,
- astronomy, geology, and optics can learn about her. But up to
- the present moment no direct communication has been established
- with her."
-
- A violent movement of interest and surprise here greeted this
- remark of the speaker.
-
- "Permit me," he continued, "to recount to you briefly how
- certain ardent spirits, starting on imaginary journeys, have
- penetrated the secrets of our satellite. In the seventeenth
- century a certain David Fabricius boasted of having seen with
- his own eyes the inhabitants of the moon. In 1649 a Frenchman,
- one Jean Baudoin, published a `Journey performed from the Earth
- to the Moon by Domingo Gonzalez,' a Spanish adventurer. At the
- same period Cyrano de Bergerac published that celebrated
- `Journeys in the Moon' which met with such success in France.
- Somewhat later another Frenchman, named Fontenelle, wrote `The
- Plurality of Worlds,' a _chef-d'oeuvre_ of its time. About 1835
- a small treatise, translated from the New York _American_, related
- how Sir John Herschel, having been despatched to the Cape of
- Good Hope for the purpose of making there some astronomical
- calculations, had, by means of a telescope brought to perfection
- by means of internal lighting, reduced the apparent distance of
- the moon to eighty yards! He then distinctly perceived caverns
- frequented by hippopotami, green mountains bordered by golden
- lace-work, sheep with horns of ivory, a white species of deer
- and inhabitants with membranous wings, like bats. This _brochure_,
- the work of an American named Locke, had a great sale. But, to
- bring this rapid sketch to a close, I will only add that a
- certain Hans Pfaal, of Rotterdam, launching himself in a balloon
- filled with a gas extracted from nitrogen, thirty-seven times
- lighter than hydrogen, reached the moon after a passage of
- nineteen hours. This journey, like all previous ones, was purely
- imaginary; still, it was the work of a popular American author--
- I mean Edgar Poe!"
-
- "Cheers for Edgar Poe!" roared the assemblage, electrified by
- their president's words.
-
- "I have now enumerated," said Barbicane, "the experiments which
- I call purely paper ones, and wholly insufficient to establish
- serious relations with the Queen of the Night. Nevertheless, I
- am bound to add that some practical geniuses have attempted to
- establish actual communication with her. Thus, a few days ago,
- a German geometrician proposed to send a scientific expedition
- to the steppes of Siberia. There, on those vast plains, they
- were to describe enormous geometric figures, drawn in characters
- of reflecting luminosity, among which was the proposition
- regarding the `square of the hypothenuse,' commonly called the
- `Ass's Bridge' by the French. `Every intelligent being,' said
- the geometrician, `must understand the scientific meaning of
- that figure. The Selenites, do they exist, will respond by a
- similar figure; and, a communication being thus once
- established, it will be easy to form an alphabet which shall
- enable us to converse with the inhabitants of the moon.' So
- spoke the German geometrician; but his project was never put
- into practice, and up to the present day there is no bond
- in existence between the Earth and her satellite. It is
- reserved for the practical genius of Americans to establish a
- communication with the sidereal world. The means of arriving
- thither are simple, easy, certain, infallible-- and that is the
- purpose of my present proposal."
-
- A storm of acclamations greeted these words. There was not a
- single person in the whole audience who was not overcome,
- carried away, lifted out of himself by the speaker's words!
-
- Long-continued applause resounded from all sides.
-
- As soon as the excitement had partially subsided, Barbicane
- resumed his speech in a somewhat graver voice.
-
- "You know," said he, "what progress artillery science has made
- during the last few years, and what a degree of perfection
- firearms of every kind have reached. Moreover, you are well
- aware that, in general terms, the resisting power of cannon and
- the expansive force of gunpowder are practically unlimited.
- Well! starting from this principle, I ask myself whether,
- supposing sufficient apparatus could be obtained constructed
- upon the conditions of ascertained resistance, it might not be
- possible to project a shot up to the moon?"
-
- At these words a murmur of amazement escaped from a thousand
- panting chests; then succeeded a moment of perfect silence,
- resembling that profound stillness which precedes the bursting
- of a thunderstorm. In point of fact, a thunderstorm did peal
- forth, but it was the thunder of applause, or cries, and of
- uproar which made the very hall tremble. The president
- attempted to speak, but could not. It was fully ten minutes
- before he could make himself heard.
-
- "Suffer me to finish," he calmly continued. "I have looked at
- the question in all its bearings, I have resolutely attacked it,
- and by incontrovertible calculations I find that a projectile
- endowed with an initial velocity of 12,000 yards per second, and
- aimed at the moon, must necessarily reach it. I have the honor,
- my brave colleagues, to propose a trial of this little experiment."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER III
-
-
- EFFECT OF THE PRESIDENT'S COMMUNICATION
-
-
- It is impossible to describe the effect produced by the last
- words of the honorable president-- the cries, the shouts, the
- succession of roars, hurrahs, and all the varied vociferations
- which the American language is capable of supplying. It was a
- scene of indescribable confusion and uproar. They shouted, they
- clapped, they stamped on the floor of the hall. All the weapons
- in the museum discharged at once could not have more violently set
- in motion the waves of sound. One need not be surprised at this.
- There are some cannoneers nearly as noisy as their own guns.
-
- Barbicane remained calm in the midst of this enthusiastic
- clamor; perhaps he was desirous of addressing a few more words
- to his colleagues, for by his gestures he demanded silence,
- and his powerful alarum was worn out by its violent reports.
- No attention, however, was paid to his request. He was presently
- torn from his seat and passed from the hands of his faithful
- colleagues into the arms of a no less excited crowd.
-
- Nothing can astound an American. It has often been asserted
- that the word "impossible" in not a French one. People have
- evidently been deceived by the dictionary. In America, all is
- easy, all is simple; and as for mechanical difficulties, they
- are overcome before they arise. Between Barbicane's proposition
- and its realization no true Yankee would have allowed even the
- semblance of a difficulty to be possible. A thing with them is
- no sooner said than done.
-
- The triumphal progress of the president continued throughout
- the evening. It was a regular torchlight procession. Irish, Germans,
- French, Scotch, all the heterogeneous units which make up the
- population of Maryland shouted in their respective vernaculars;
- and the "vivas," "hurrahs," and "bravos" were intermingled in
- inexpressible enthusiasm.
-
- Just at this crisis, as though she comprehended all this
- agitation regarding herself, the moon shone forth with
- serene splendor, eclipsing by her intense illumination all the
- surrounding lights. The Yankees all turned their gaze toward
- her resplendent orb, kissed their hands, called her by all kinds
- of endearing names. Between eight o'clock and midnight one
- optician in Jones'-Fall Street made his fortune by the sale of
- opera-glasses.
-
- Midnight arrived, and the enthusiasm showed no signs of diminution.
- It spread equally among all classes of citizens-- men of science,
- shopkeepers, merchants, porters, chair-men, as well as "greenhorns,"
- were stirred in their innermost fibres. A national enterprise was
- at stake. The whole city, high and low, the quays bordering the
- Patapsco, the ships lying in the basins, disgorged a crowd drunk
- with joy, gin, and whisky. Every one chattered, argued, discussed,
- disputed, applauded, from the gentleman lounging upon the barroom
- settee with his tumbler of sherry-cobbler before him down to the
- waterman who got drunk upon his "knock-me-down" in the dingy taverns
- of Fell Point.
-
- About two A.M., however, the excitement began to subside.
- President Barbicane reached his house, bruised, crushed, and
- squeezed almost to a mummy. Hercules could not have resisted a
- similar outbreak of enthusiasm. The crowd gradually deserted
- the squares and streets. The four railways from Philadelphia
- and Washington, Harrisburg and Wheeling, which converge at
- Baltimore, whirled away the heterogeneous population to the four
- corners of the United States, and the city subsided into
- comparative tranquility.
-
- On the following day, thanks to the telegraphic wires, five
- hundred newspapers and journals, daily, weekly, monthly, or
- bi-monthly, all took up the question. They examined it under
- all its different aspects, physical, meteorological, economical,
- or moral, up to its bearings on politics or civilization.
- They debated whether the moon was a finished world, or whether
- it was destined to undergo any further transformation. Did it
- resemble the earth at the period when the latter was destitute
- as yet of an atmosphere? What kind of spectacle would its hidden
- hemisphere present to our terrestrial spheroid? Granting that
- the question at present was simply that of sending a projectile
- up to the moon, every one must see that that involved the
- commencement of a series of experiments. All must hope that
- some day America would penetrate the deepest secrets of that
- mysterious orb; and some even seemed to fear lest its conquest
- should not sensibly derange the equilibrium of Europe.
-
- The project once under discussion, not a single paragraph
- suggested a doubt of its realization. All the papers,
- pamphlets, reports-- all the journals published by the
- scientific, literary, and religious societies enlarged upon its
- advantages; and the Society of Natural History of Boston, the
- Society of Science and Art of Albany, the Geographical and
- Statistical Society of New York, the Philosophical Society of
- Philadelphia, and the Smithsonian of Washington sent innumerable
- letters of congratulation to the Gun Club, together with offers
- of immediate assistance and money.
-
- From that day forward Impey Barbicane became one of the greatest
- citizens of the United States, a kind of Washington of science.
- A single trait of feeling, taken from many others, will serve to
- show the point which this homage of a whole people to a single
- individual attained.
-
- Some few days after this memorable meeting of the Gun Club, the
- manager of an English company announced, at the Baltimore
- theatre, the production of "Much ado about Nothing." But the
- populace, seeing in that title an allusion damaging to
- Barbicane's project, broke into the auditorium, smashed the
- benches, and compelled the unlucky director to alter his playbill.
- Being a sensible man, he bowed to the public will and replaced
- the offending comedy by "As you like it"; and for many weeks he
- realized fabulous profits.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IV
-
-
- REPLY FROM THE OBSERVATORY OF CAMBRIDGE
-
-
- Barbicane, however, lost not one moment amid all the enthusiasm
- of which he had become the object. His first care was to
- reassemble his colleagues in the board-room of the Gun Club.
- There, after some discussion, it was agreed to consult the
- astronomers regarding the astronomical part of the enterprise.
- Their reply once ascertained, they could then discuss the
- mechanical means, and nothing should be wanting to ensure the
- success of this great experiment.
-
- A note couched in precise terms, containing special
- interrogatories, was then drawn up and addressed to the
- Observatory of Cambridge in Massachusetts. This city, where the
- first university of the United States was founded, is justly
- celebrated for its astronomical staff. There are to be found
- assembled all the most eminent men of science. Here is to be
- seen at work that powerful telescope which enabled Bond to
- resolve the nebula of Andromeda, and Clarke to discover the
- satellite of Sirius. This celebrated institution fully justified
- on all points the confidence reposed in it by the Gun Club.
- So, after two days, the reply so impatiently awaited was placed
- in the hands of President Barbicane.
-
- It was couched in the following terms:
-
- _The Director of the Cambridge Observatory to the President
- of the Gun Club at Baltimore._
-
-
- CAMBRIDGE, October 7.
- On the receipt of your favor of the 6th instant, addressed to
- the Observatory of Cambridge in the name of the members of the
- Baltimore Gun Club, our staff was immediately called together,
- and it was judged expedient to reply as follows:
-
- The questions which have been proposed to it are these--
-
- "1. Is it possible to transmit a projectile up to the moon?
-
- "2. What is the exact distance which separates the earth from
- its satellite?
-
- "3. What will be the period of transit of the projectile when
- endowed with sufficient initial velocity? and, consequently, at
- what moment ought it to be discharged in order that it may touch
- the moon at a particular point?
-
- "4. At what precise moment will the moon present herself in the
- most favorable position to be reached by the projectile?
-
- "5. What point in the heavens ought the cannon to be aimed at
- which is intended to discharge the projectile?
-
- "6. What place will the moon occupy in the heavens at the moment
- of the projectile's departure?"
-
- Regarding the _first_ question, "Is it possible to transmit a
- projectile up to the moon?"
-
- _Answer._-- Yes; provided it possess an initial velocity of
- 1,200 yards per second; calculations prove that to be sufficient.
- In proportion as we recede from the earth the action of gravitation
- diminishes in the inverse ratio of the square of the distance;
- that is to say, _at three times a given distance the action is
- nine times less._ Consequently, the weight of a shot will decrease,
- and will become reduced to _zero_ at the instant that the attraction
- of the moon exactly counterpoises that of the earth; that is to say
- at 47/52 of its passage. At that instant the projectile will
- have no weight whatever; and, if it passes that point, it will
- fall into the moon by the sole effect of the lunar attraction.
- The _theoretical possibility_ of the experiment is therefore
- absolutely demonstrated; its _success_ must depend upon the power
- of the engine employed.
-
- As to the _second_ question, "What is the exact distance which
- separates the earth from its satellite?"
-
- _Answer._-- The moon does not describe a _circle_ round the
- earth, but rather an _ellipse_, of which our earth occupies one
- of the _foci_; the consequence, therefore, is, that at certain
- times it approaches nearer to, and at others it recedes farther
- from, the earth; in astronomical language, it is at one time in
- _apogee_, at another in _perigee_. Now the difference between
- its greatest and its least distance is too considerable to be
- left out of consideration. In point of fact, in its apogee the
- moon is 247,552 miles, and in its perigee, 218,657 miles only
- distant; a fact which makes a difference of 28,895 miles, or
- more than one-ninth of the entire distance. The perigee
- distance, therefore, is that which ought to serve as the basis
- of all calculations.
-
- To the _third_ question.
-
- _Answer._-- If the shot should preserve continuously its initial
- velocity of 12,000 yards per second, it would require little
- more than nine hours to reach its destination; but, inasmuch as
- that initial velocity will be continually decreasing, it will
- occupy 300,000 seconds, that is 83hrs. 20m. in reaching the
- point where the attraction of the earth and moon will be _in
- equilibrio_. From this point it will fall into the moon in
- 50,000 seconds, or 13hrs. 53m. 20sec. It will be desirable,
- therefore, to discharge it 97hrs. 13m. 20sec. before the arrival
- of the moon at the point aimed at.
-
- Regarding question _four_, "At what precise moment will the moon
- present herself in the most favorable position, etc.?"
-
- _Answer._-- After what has been said above, it will be
- necessary, first of all, to choose the period when the moon will
- be in perigee, and _also_ the moment when she will be crossing
- the zenith, which latter event will further diminish the entire
- distance by a length equal to the radius of the earth, _i. e._
- 3,919 miles; the result of which will be that the final passage
- remaining to be accomplished will be 214,976 miles. But although
- the moon passes her perigee every month, she does not reach the
- zenith always _at exactly the same moment_. She does not appear
- under these two conditions simultaneously, except at long
- intervals of time. It will be necessary, therefore, to wait for
- the moment when her passage in perigee shall coincide with that
- in the zenith. Now, by a fortunate circumstance, on the 4th of
- December in the ensuing year the moon _will_ present these
- two conditions. At midnight she will be in perigee, that is,
- at her shortest distance from the earth, and at the same moment
- she will be crossing the zenith.
-
- On the _fifth_ question, "At what point in the heavens ought the
- cannon to be aimed?"
-
- _Answer._-- The preceding remarks being admitted, the cannon
- ought to be pointed to the zenith of the place. Its fire,
- therefore, will be perpendicular to the plane of the horizon;
- and the projectile will soonest pass beyond the range of the
- terrestrial attraction. But, in order that the moon should
- reach the zenith of a given place, it is necessary that the
- place should not exceed in latitude the declination of the
- luminary; in other words, it must be comprised within the
- degrees 0@ and 28@ of lat. N. or S. In every other spot the fire
- must necessarily be oblique, which would seriously militate
- against the success of the experiment.
-
- As to the _sixth_ question, "What place will the moon occupy in
- the heavens at the moment of the projectile's departure?"
-
- _Answer._-- At the moment when the projectile shall be discharged
- into space, the moon, which travels daily forward 13@ 10' 35'',
- will be distant from the zenith point by four times that quantity,
- _i. e._ by 52@ 41' 20'', a space which corresponds to the path
- which she will describe during the entire journey of the projectile.
- But, inasmuch as it is equally necessary to take into account the
- deviation which the rotary motion of the earth will impart to the
- shot, and as the shot cannot reach the moon until after a deviation
- equal to 16 radii of the earth, which, calculated upon the moon's
- orbit, are equal to about eleven degrees, it becomes necessary to
- add these eleven degrees to those which express the retardation of
- the moon just mentioned: that is to say, in round numbers, about
- sixty-four degrees. Consequently, at the moment of firing the
- visual radius applied to the moon will describe, with the vertical
- line of the place, an angle of sixty-four degrees.
-
- These are our answers to the questions proposed to the
- Observatory of Cambridge by the members of the Gun Club:
-
- To sum up--
-
- 1st. The cannon ought to be planted in a country situated
- between 0@ and 28@ of N. or S. lat.
-
- 2nd. It ought to be pointed directly toward the zenith of the place.
-
- 3rd. The projectile ought to be propelled with an initial
- velocity of 12,000 yards per second.
-
- 4th. It ought to be discharged at 10hrs. 46m. 40sec. of the 1st
- of December of the ensuing year.
-
- 5th. It will meet the moon four days after its discharge,
- precisely at midnight on the 4th of December, at the moment of
- its transit across the zenith.
-
- The members of the Gun Club ought, therefore, without delay, to
- commence the works necessary for such an experiment, and to be
- prepared to set to work at the moment determined upon; for, if
- they should suffer this 4th of December to go by, they will not
- find the moon again under the same conditions of perigee and of
- zenith until eighteen years and eleven days afterward.
-
- The staff of the Cambridge Observatory place themselves entirely
- at their disposal in respect of all questions of theoretical
- astronomy; and herewith add their congratulations to those of
- all the rest of America.
- For the Astronomical Staff,
- J. M. BELFAST,
- _Director of the Observatory of Cambridge._
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER V
-
-
- THE ROMANCE OF THE MOON
-
-
- An observer endued with an infinite range of vision, and placed
- in that unknown center around which the entire world revolves,
- might have beheld myriads of atoms filling all space during the
- chaotic epoch of the universe. Little by little, as ages went
- on, a change took place; a general law of attraction manifested
- itself, to which the hitherto errant atoms became obedient:
- these atoms combined together chemically according to their
- affinities, formed themselves into molecules, and composed those
- nebulous masses with which the depths of the heavens are strewed.
- These masses became immediately endued with a rotary motion
- around their own central point. This center, formed of
- indefinite molecules, began to revolve around its own axis
- during its gradual condensation; then, following the immutable
- laws of mechanics, in proportion as its bulk diminished by
- condensation, its rotary motion became accelerated, and these
- two effects continuing, the result was the formation of one
- principal star, the center of the nebulous mass.
-
- By attentively watching, the observer would then have perceived
- the other molecules of the mass, following the example of this
- central star, become likewise condensed by gradually accelerated
- rotation, and gravitating round it in the shape of innumerable stars.
- Thus was formed the _Nebulae_, of which astronomers have reckoned
- up nearly 5,000.
-
- Among these 5,000 nebulae there is one which has received the
- name of the Milky Way, and which contains eighteen millions of
- stars, each of which has become the center of a solar world.
-
- If the observer had then specially directed his attention to one
- of the more humble and less brilliant of these stellar bodies,
- a star of the fourth class, that which is arrogantly called the
- Sun, all the phenomena to which the formation of the Universe is to
- be ascribed would have been successively fulfilled before his eyes.
- In fact, he would have perceived this sun, as yet in the gaseous
- state, and composed of moving molecules, revolving round its axis
- in order to accomplish its work of concentration. This motion,
- faithful to the laws of mechanics, would have been accelerated
- with the diminution of its volume; and a moment would have arrived
- when the centrifugal force would have overpowered the centripetal,
- which causes the molecules all to tend toward the center.
-
- Another phenomenon would now have passed before the observer's
- eye, and the molecules situated on the plane of the equator,
- escaping like a stone from a sling of which the cord had
- suddenly snapped, would have formed around the sun sundry
- concentric rings resembling that of Saturn. In their turn,
- again, these rings of cosmical matter, excited by a rotary
- motion about the central mass, would have been broken up and
- decomposed into secondary nebulosities, that is to say,
- into planets. Similarly he would have observed these planets
- throw off one or more rings each, which became the origin of the
- secondary bodies which we call satellites.
-
- Thus, then, advancing from atom to molecule, from molecule to
- nebulous mass, from that to principal star, from star to sun,
- from sun to planet, and hence to satellite, we have the whole
- series of transformations undergone by the heavenly bodies
- during the first days of the world.
-
- Now, of those attendant bodies which the sun maintains in their
- elliptical orbits by the great law of gravitation, some few in
- turn possess satellites. Uranus has eight, Saturn eight, Jupiter
- four, Neptune possibly three, and the Earth one. This last, one
- of the least important of the entire solar system, we call the
- Moon; and it is she whom the daring genius of the Americans
- professed their intention of conquering.
-
- The moon, by her comparative proximity, and the constantly
- varying appearances produced by her several phases, has always
- occupied a considerable share of the attention of the
- inhabitants of the earth.
-
- From the time of Thales of Miletus, in the fifth century B.C.,
- down to that of Copernicus in the fifteenth and Tycho Brahe in
- the sixteenth century A.D., observations have been from time to
- time carried on with more or less correctness, until in the
- present day the altitudes of the lunar mountains have been
- determined with exactitude. Galileo explained the phenomena of
- the lunar light produced during certain of her phases by the
- existence of mountains, to which he assigned a mean altitude of
- 27,000 feet. After him Hevelius, an astronomer of Dantzic,
- reduced the highest elevations to 15,000 feet; but the
- calculations of Riccioli brought them up again to 21,000 feet.
-
- At the close of the eighteenth century Herschel, armed with a powerful
- telescope, considerably reduced the preceding measurements.
- He assigned a height of 11,400 feet to the maximum elevations,
- and reduced the mean of the different altitudes to little more
- than 2,400 feet. But Herschel's calculations were in their turn
- corrected by the observations of Halley, Nasmyth, Bianchini,
- Gruithuysen, and others; but it was reserved for the labors of
- Boeer and Maedler finally to solve the question. They succeeded
- in measuring 1,905 different elevations, of which six exceed
- 15,000 feet, and twenty-two exceed 14,400 feet. The highest
- summit of all towers to a height of 22,606 feet above the surface
- of the lunar disc. At the same period the examination of the moon
- was completed. She appeared completely riddled with craters, and
- her essentially volcanic character was apparent at each observation.
- By the absence of refraction in the rays of the planets occulted
- by her we conclude that she is absolutely devoid of an atmosphere.
- The absence of air entails the absence of water. It became,
- therefore, manifest that the Selenites, to support life under
- such conditions, must possess a special organization of their
- own, must differ remarkably from the inhabitants of the earth.
-
- At length, thanks to modern art, instruments of still higher
- perfection searched the moon without intermission, not leaving
- a single point of her surface unexplored; and notwithstanding
- that her diameter measures 2,150 miles, her surface equals the
- one-fifteenth part of that of our globe, and her bulk the
- one-forty-ninth part of that of the terrestrial spheroid-- not
- one of her secrets was able to escape the eyes of the
- astronomers; and these skillful men of science carried to an
- even greater degree their prodigious observations.
-
- Thus they remarked that, during full moon, the disc appeared
- scored in certain parts with white lines; and, during the
- phases, with black. On prosecuting the study of these with
- still greater precision, they succeeded in obtaining an exact
- account of the nature of these lines. They were long and narrow
- furrows sunk between parallel ridges, bordering generally upon
- the edges of the craters. Their length varied between ten and 100
- miles, and their width was about 1,600 yards. Astronomers called
- them chasms, but they could not get any further. Whether these
- chasms were the dried-up beds of ancient rivers or not they were
- unable thoroughly to ascertain.
-
- The Americans, among others, hoped one day or other to
- determine this geological question. They also undertook to
- examine the true nature of that system of parallel ramparts
- discovered on the moon's surface by Gruithuysen, a learned
- professor of Munich, who considered them to be "a system of
- fortifications thrown up by the Selenitic engineers." These two
- points, yet obscure, as well as others, no doubt, could not be
- definitely settled except by direct communication with the moon.
-
- Regarding the degree of intensity of its light, there was
- nothing more to learn on this point. It was known that it is
- 300,000 times weaker than that of the sun, and that its heat has
- no appreciable effect upon the thermometer. As to the
- phenomenon known as the "ashy light," it is explained naturally
- by the effect of the transmission of the solar rays from the
- earth to the moon, which give the appearance of completeness to
- the lunar disc, while it presents itself under the crescent form
- during its first and last phases.
-
- Such was the state of knowledge acquired regarding the earth's
- satellite, which the Gun Club undertook to perfect in all its
- aspects, cosmographic, geological, political, and moral.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VI
-
-
- PERMISSIVE LIMITS OF IGNORANCE AND BELIEF IN THE UNITED STATES
-
-
- The immediate result of Barbicane's proposition was to place upon
- the orders of the day all the astronomical facts relative to the
- Queen of the Night. Everybody set to work to study assiduously.
- One would have thought that the moon had just appeared for the
- first time, and that no one had ever before caught a glimpse of
- her in the heavens. The papers revived all the old anecdotes in
- which the "sun of the wolves" played a part; they recalled the
- influences which the ignorance of past ages ascribed to her; in
- short, all America was seized with selenomania, or had become moon-mad.
-
- The scientific journals, for their part, dealt more especially with
- the questions which touched upon the enterprise of the Gun Club.
- The letter of the Observatory of Cambridge was published by them,
- and commented upon with unreserved approval.
-
- Until that time most people had been ignorant of the mode in which
- the distance which separates the moon from the earth is calculated.
- They took advantage of this fact to explain to them that this
- distance was obtained by measuring the parallax of the moon.
- The term parallax proving "caviare to the general," they further
- explained that it meant the angle formed by the inclination of two
- straight lines drawn from either extremity of the earth's radius
- to the moon. On doubts being expressed as to the correctness of
- this method, they immediately proved that not only was the mean
- distance 234,347 miles, but that astronomers could not possibly
- be in error in their estimate by more than seventy miles either way.
-
- To those who were not familiar with the motions of the moon,
- they demonstrated that she possesses two distinct motions, the
- first being that of rotation upon her axis, the second being
- that of revolution round the earth, accomplishing both together
- in an equal period of time, that is to say, in twenty-seven and
- one-third days.
-
- The motion of rotation is that which produces day and night on
- the surface of the moon; save that there is only one day and one
- night in the lunar month, each lasting three hundred and
- fifty-four and one-third hours. But, happily for her, the face
- turned toward the terrestrial globe is illuminated by it with an
- intensity equal to that of fourteen moons. As to the other
- face, always invisible to us, it has of necessity three hundred
- and fifty-four hours of absolute night, tempered only by that
- "pale glimmer which falls upon it from the stars."
-
- Some well-intentioned, but rather obstinate persons, could not
- at first comprehend how, if the moon displays invariably the
- same face to the earth during her revolution, she can describe
- one turn round herself. To such they answered, "Go into your
- dining-room, and walk round the table in such a way as to always
- keep your face turned toward the center; by the time you will
- have achieved one complete round you will have completed one
- turn around yourself, since your eye will have traversed
- successively every point of the room. Well, then, the room is
- the heavens, the table is the earth, and the moon is yourself."
- And they would go away delighted.
-
- So, then the moon displays invariably the same face to the
- earth; nevertheless, to be quite exact, it is necessary to add
- that, in consequence of certain fluctuations of north and south,
- and of west and east, termed her libration, she permits rather
- more than half, that is to say, five-sevenths, to be seen.
-
- As soon as the ignoramuses came to understand as much as the
- director of the observatory himself knew, they began to worry
- themselves regarding her revolution round the earth, whereupon
- twenty scientific reviews immediately came to the rescue.
- They pointed out to them that the firmament, with its infinitude
- of stars, may be considered as one vast dial-plate, upon which the
- moon travels, indicating the true time to all the inhabitants of
- the earth; that it is during this movement that the Queen of
- Night exhibits her different phases; that the moon is _full_
- when she is in _opposition_ with the sun, that is when the three
- bodies are on the same straight line, the earth occupying the
- center; that she is _new_ when she is in _conjunction_ with the
- sun, that is, when she is between it and the earth; and, lastly
- that she is in her _first_ or _last_ quarter, when she makes
- with the sun and the earth an angle of which she herself occupies
- the apex.
-
- Regarding the altitude which the moon attains above the horizon,
- the letter of the Cambridge Observatory had said all that was to
- be said in this respect. Every one knew that this altitude
- varies according to the latitude of the observer. But the only
- zones of the globe in which the moon passes the zenith, that is,
- the point directly over the head of the spectator, are of
- necessity comprised between the twenty-eighth parallels and
- the equator. Hence the importance of the advice to try the
- experiment upon some point of that part of the globe, in order
- that the projectile might be discharged perpendicularly, and so
- the soonest escape the action of gravitation. This was an
- essential condition to the success of the enterprise, and
- continued actively to engage the public attention.
-
- Regarding the path described by the moon in her revolution round
- the earth, the Cambridge Observatory had demonstrated that this
- path is a re-entering curve, not a perfect circle, but an
- ellipse, of which the earth occupies one of the _foci_. It was
- also well understood that it is farthest removed from the earth
- during its _apogee_, and approaches most nearly to it at its _perigee_.
-
- Such was then the extent of knowledge possessed by every
- American on the subject, and of which no one could decently
- profess ignorance. Still, while these principles were being
- rapidly disseminated many errors and illusory fears proved less
- easy to eradicate.
-
- For instance, some worthy persons maintained that the moon was
- an ancient comet which, in describing its elongated orbit round
- the sun, happened to pass near the earth, and became confined
- within her circle of attraction. These drawing-room astronomers
- professed to explain the charred aspect of the moon-- a disaster
- which they attributed to the intensity of the solar heat; only,
- on being reminded that comets have an atmosphere, and that the
- moon has little or none, they were fairly at a loss for a reply.
-
- Others again, belonging to the doubting class, expressed certain
- fears as to the position of the moon. They had heard it said
- that, according to observations made in the time of the Caliphs,
- her revolution had become accelerated in a certain degree.
- Hence they concluded, logically enough, that an acceleration of
- motion ought to be accompanied by a corresponding diminution in
- the distance separating the two bodies; and that, supposing the
- double effect to be continued to infinity, the moon would end by
- one day falling into the earth. However, they became reassured
- as to the fate of future generations on being apprised that,
- according to the calculations of Laplace, this acceleration of
- motion is confined within very restricted limits, and that a
- proportional diminution of speed will be certain to succeed it.
- So, then, the stability of the solar system would not be deranged
- in ages to come.
-
- There remains but the third class, the superstitious.
- These worthies were not content merely to rest in ignorance;
- they must know all about things which had no existence whatever,
- and as to the moon, they had long known all about her. One set
- regarded her disc as a polished mirror, by means of which people
- could see each other from different points of the earth and
- interchange their thoughts. Another set pretended that out of
- one thousand new moons that had been observed, nine hundred and
- fifty had been attended with remarkable disturbances, such as
- cataclysms, revolutions, earthquakes, the deluge, etc. Then they
- believed in some mysterious influence exercised by her over human
- destinies-- that every Selenite was attached to some inhabitant
- of the earth by a tie of sympathy; they maintained that the
- entire vital system is subject to her control, etc. But in time
- the majority renounced these vulgar errors, and espoused the true
- side of the question. As for the Yankees, they had no other
- ambition than to take possession of this new continent of the sky,
- and to plant upon the summit of its highest elevation the star-
- spangled banner of the United States of America.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VII
-
-
- THE HYMN OF THE CANNON-BALL
-
-
- The Observatory of Cambridge in its memorable letter had treated the
- question from a purely astronomical point of view. The mechanical
- part still remained.
-
- President Barbicane had, without loss of time, nominated a
- working committee of the Gun Club. The duty of this committee
- was to resolve the three grand questions of the cannon, the
- projectile, and the powder. It was composed of four members of
- great technical knowledge, Barbicane (with a casting vote in
- case of equality), General Morgan, Major Elphinstone, and J. T.
- Maston, to whom were confided the functions of secretary. On the
- 8th of October the committee met at the house of President
- Barbicane, 3 Republican Street. The meeting was opened by the
- president himself.
-
- "Gentlemen," said he, "we have to resolve one of the most
- important problems in the whole of the noble science of gunnery.
- It might appear, perhaps, the most logical course to devote our
- first meeting to the discussion of the engine to be employed.
- Nevertheless, after mature consideration, it has appeared to me
- that the question of the projectile must take precedence of that
- of the cannon, and that the dimensions of the latter must
- necessarily depend on those of the former."
-
- "Suffer me to say a word," here broke in J. T. Maston.
- Permission having been granted, "Gentlemen," said he with an
- inspired accent, "our president is right in placing the question
- of the projectile above all others. The ball we are about to
- discharge at the moon is our ambassador to her, and I wish to
- consider it from a moral point of view. The cannon-ball,
- gentlemen, to my mind, is the most magnificent manifestation of
- human power. If Providence has created the stars and the planets,
- man has called the cannon-ball into existence. Let Providence
- claim the swiftness of electricity and of light, of the stars,
- the comets, and the planets, of wind and sound-- we claim to
- have invented the swiftness of the cannon-ball, a hundred times
- superior to that of the swiftest horses or railway train.
- How glorious will be the moment when, infinitely exceeding all
- hitherto attained velocities, we shall launch our new projectile
- with the rapidity of seven miles a second! Shall it not,
- gentlemen-- shall it not be received up there with the honors
- due to a terrestrial ambassador?"
-
- Overcome with emotion the orator sat down and applied himself to
- a huge plate of sandwiches before him.
-
- "And now," said Barbicane, "let us quit the domain of poetry and
- come direct to the question."
-
- "By all means," replied the members, each with his mouth full
- of sandwich.
-
- "The problem before us," continued the president, "is how to
- communicate to a projectile a velocity of 12,000 yards per second.
- Let us at present examine the velocities hitherto attained.
- General Morgan will be able to enlighten us on this point."
-
- "And the more easily," replied the general, "that during the war
- I was a member of the committee of experiments. I may say,
- then, that the 100-pounder Dahlgrens, which carried a distance
- of 5,000 yards, impressed upon their projectile an initial
- velocity of 500 yards a second. The Rodman Columbiad threw a
- shot weighing half a ton a distance of six miles, with a
- velocity of 800 yards per second-- a result which Armstrong and
- Palisser have never obtained in England."
-
- "This," replied Barbicane, "is, I believe, the maximum velocity
- ever attained?"
-
- "It is so," replied the general.
-
- "Ah!" groaned J. T. Maston, "if my mortar had not burst----"
-
- "Yes," quietly replied Barbicane, "but it did burst. We must
- take, then, for our starting point, this velocity of 800 yards.
- We must increase it twenty-fold. Now, reserving for another
- discussion the means of producing this velocity, I will call
- your attention to the dimensions which it will be proper to
- assign to the shot. You understand that we have nothing to do
- here with projectiles weighing at most but half a ton."
-
- "Why not?" demanded the major.
-
- "Because the shot," quickly replied J. T. Maston, "must be big
- enough to attract the attention of the inhabitants of the moon,
- if there are any?"
-
- "Yes," replied Barbicane, "and for another reason more important still."
-
- "What mean you?" asked the major.
-
- "I mean that it is not enough to discharge a projectile, and
- then take no further notice of it; we must follow it throughout
- its course, up to the moment when it shall reach its goal."
-
- "What?" shouted the general and the major in great surprise.
-
- "Undoubtedly," replied Barbicane composedly, "or our experiment
- would produce no result."
-
- "But then," replied the major, "you will have to give this
- projectile enormous dimensions."
-
- "No! Be so good as to listen. You know that optical
- instruments have acquired great perfection; with certain
- instruments we have succeeded in obtaining enlargements of 6,000
- times and reducing the moon to within forty miles' distance.
- Now, at this distance, any objects sixty feet square would be
- perfectly visible.
-
- "If, then, the penetrative power of telescopes has not been
- further increased, it is because that power detracts from their
- light; and the moon, which is but a reflecting mirror, does not
- give back sufficient light to enable us to perceive objects of
- lesser magnitude."
-
- "Well, then, what do you propose to do?" asked the general.
- "Would you give your projectile a diameter of sixty feet?"
-
- "Not so."
-
- "Do you intend, then, to increase the luminous power of the moon?"
-
- "Exactly so. If I can succeed in diminishing the density of the
- atmosphere through which the moon's light has to travel I shall
- have rendered her light more intense. To effect that object it
- will be enough to establish a telescope on some elevated mountain.
- That is what we will do."
-
- "I give it up," answered the major. "You have such a way of
- simplifying things. And what enlargement do you expect to
- obtain in this way?"
-
- "One of 48,000 times, which should bring the moon within an
- apparent distance of five miles; and, in order to be visible,
- objects need not have a diameter of more than nine feet."
-
- "So, then," cried J. T. Maston, "our projectile need not be more
- than nine feet in diameter."
-
- "Let me observe, however," interrupted Major Elphinstone, "this
- will involve a weight such as----"
-
- "My dear major," replied Barbicane, "before discussing its
- weight permit me to enumerate some of the marvels which our
- ancestors have achieved in this respect. I don't mean to
- pretend that the science of gunnery has not advanced, but it
- is as well to bear in mind that during the middle ages they
- obtained results more surprising, I will venture to say, than ours.
- For instance, during the siege of Constantinople by Mahomet II.,
- in 1453, stone shot of 1,900 pounds weight were employed. At Malta,
- in the time of the knights, there was a gun of the fortress of St.
- Elmo which threw a projectile weighing 2,500 pounds. And, now,
- what is the extent of what we have seen ourselves? Armstrong guns
- discharging shot of 500 pounds, and the Rodman guns projectiles
- of half a ton! It seems, then, that if projectiles have gained
- in range, they have lost far more in weight. Now, if we turn our
- efforts in that direction, we ought to arrive, with the progress
- on science, at ten times the weight of the shot of Mahomet II.
- and the Knights of Malta."
-
- "Clearly," replied the major; "but what metal do you calculate
- upon employing?"
-
- "Simply cast iron," said General Morgan.
-
- "But," interrupted the major, "since the weight of a shot is
- proportionate to its volume, an iron ball of nine feet in
- diameter would be of tremendous weight."
-
- "Yes, if it were solid, not if it were hollow."
-
- "Hollow? then it would be a shell?"
-
- "Yes, a shell," replied Barbicane; "decidely it must be. A solid
- shot of 108 inches would weigh more than 200,000 pounds, a weight
- evidently far too great. Still, as we must reserve a certain
- stability for our projectile, I propose to give it a weight of
- 20,000 pounds."
-
- "What, then, will be the thickness of the sides?" asked the major.
-
- "If we follow the usual proportion," replied Morgan, "a diameter
- of 108 inches would require sides of two feet thickness, or less."
-
- "That would be too much," replied Barbicane; "for you will
- observe that the question is not that of a shot intended to
- pierce an iron plate; it will suffice to give it sides strong
- enough to resist the pressure of the gas. The problem,
- therefore, is this-- What thickness ought a cast-iron shell to
- have in order not to weight more than 20,000 pounds? Our clever
- secretary will soon enlighten us upon this point."
-
- "Nothing easier." replied the worthy secretary of the committee;
- and, rapidly tracing a few algebraical formulae upon paper,
- among which _n_^2 and _x_^2 frequently appeared, he presently said:
-
- "The sides will require a thickness of less than two inches."
-
- "Will that be enough?" asked the major doubtfully.
-
- "Clearly not!" replied the president.
-
- "What is to be done, then?" said Elphinstone, with a puzzled air.
-
- "Employ another metal instead of iron."
-
- "Copper?" said Morgan.
-
- "No! that would be too heavy. I have better than that to offer."
-
- "What then?" asked the major.
-
- "Aluminum!" replied Barbicane.
-
- "Aluminum?" cried his three colleagues in chorus.
-
- "Unquestionably, my friends. This valuable metal possesses the
- whiteness of silver, the indestructibility of gold, the tenacity
- of iron, the fusibility of copper, the lightness of glass. It is
- easily wrought, is very widely distributed, forming the base of
- most of the rocks, is three times lighter than iron, and seems to
- have been created for the express purpose of furnishing us with
- the material for our projectile."
-
- "But, my dear president," said the major, "is not the cost price
- of aluminum extremely high?"
-
- "It was so at its first discovery, but it has fallen now to nine
- dollars a pound."
-
- "But still, nine dollars a pound!" replied the major, who was
- not willing readily to give in; "even that is an enormous price."
-
- "Undoubtedly, my dear major; but not beyond our reach."
-
- "What will the projectile weigh then?" asked Morgan.
-
- "Here is the result of my calculations," replied Barbicane.
- "A shot of 108 inches in diameter, and twelve inches in
- thickness, would weigh, in cast-iron, 67,440 pounds; cast in
- aluminum, its weight will be reduced to 19,250 pounds."
-
- "Capital!" cried the major; "but do you know that, at nine
- dollars a pound, this projectile will cost----"
-
- "One hundred and seventy-three thousand and fifty dollars ($173,050).
- I know it quite well. But fear not, my friends; the money will not
- be wanting for our enterprise. I will answer for it. Now what say
- you to aluminum, gentlemen?"
-
- "Adopted!" replied the three members of the committee. So ended
- the first meeting. The question of the projectile was
- definitely settled.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VII
-
-
- HISTORY OF THE CANNON
-
-
- The resolutions passed at the last meeting produced a great
- effect out of doors. Timid people took fright at the idea of
- a shot weighing 20,000 pounds being launched into space; they
- asked what cannon could ever transmit a sufficient velocity to
- such a mighty mass. The minutes of the second meeting were
- destined triumphantly to answer such questions. The following
- evening the discussion was renewed.
-
- "My dear colleagues," said Barbicane, without further preamble,
- "the subject now before us is the construction of the engine,
- its length, its composition, and its weight. It is probable
- that we shall end by giving it gigantic dimensions; but however
- great may be the difficulties in the way, our mechanical genius
- will readily surmount them. Be good enough, then, to give me
- your attention, and do not hesitate to make objections at the close.
- I have no fear of them. The problem before us is how to communicate
- an initial force of 12,000 yards per second to a shell of 108
- inches in diameter, weighing 20,000 pounds. Now when a projectile
- is launched into space, what happens to it? It is acted upon by
- three independent forces: the resistance of the air, the attraction
- of the earth, and the force of impulsion with which it is endowed.
- Let us examine these three forces. The resistance of the air is of
- little importance. The atmosphere of the earth does not exceed
- forty miles. Now, with the given rapidity, the projectile will
- have traversed this in five seconds, and the period is too brief
- for the resistance of the medium to be regarded otherwise than
- as insignificant. Proceding, then, to the attraction of the earth,
- that is, the weight of the shell, we know that this weight will
- diminish in the inverse ratio of the square of the distance.
- When a body left to itself falls to the surface of the earth, it
- falls five feet in the first second; and if the same body were
- removed 257,542 miles further off, in other words, to the distance
- of the moon, its fall would be reduced to about half a line in the
- first second. That is almost equivalent to a state of perfect rest.
- Our business, then, is to overcome progressively this action
- of gravitation. The mode of accomplishing that is by the force
- of impulsion."
-
- "There's the difficulty," broke in the major.
-
- "True," replied the president; "but we will overcome that, for
- the force of impulsion will depend on the length of the engine
- and the powder employed, the latter being limited only by the
- resisting power of the former. Our business, then, to-day is
- with the dimensions of the cannon."
-
- "Now, up to the present time," said Barbicane, "our longest guns
- have not exceeded twenty-five feet in length. We shall
- therefore astonish the world by the dimensions we shall be
- obliged to adopt. It must evidently be, then, a gun of great
- range, since the length of the piece will increase the detention
- of the gas accumulated behind the projectile; but there is no
- advantage in passing certain limits."
-
- "Quite so," said the major. "What is the rule in such a case?"
-
- "Ordinarily the length of a gun is twenty to twenty-five times
- the diameter of the shot, and its weight two hundred and
- thirty-five to two hundred and forty times that of the shot."
-
- "That is not enough," cried J. T. Maston impetuously.
-
- "I agree with you, my good friend; and, in fact, following this
- proportion for a projectile nine feet in diameter, weighing 30,000
- pounds, the gun would only have a length of two hundred and twenty-
- five feet, and a weight of 7,200,000 pounds."
-
- "Ridiculous!" rejoined Maston. "As well take a pistol."
-
- "I think so too," replied Barbicane; "that is why I propose to
- quadruple that length, and to construct a gun of nine hundred feet."
-
- The general and the major offered some objections; nevertheless,
- the proposition, actively supported by the secretary, was
- definitely adopted.
-
- "But," said Elphinstone, "what thickness must we give it?"
-
- "A thickness of six feet," replied Barbicane.
-
- "You surely don't think of mounting a mass like that upon a
- carriage?" asked the major.
-
- "It would be a superb idea, though," said Maston.
-
- "But impracticable," replied Barbicane. "No, I think of sinking
- this engine in the earth alone, binding it with hoops of wrought
- iron, and finally surrounding it with a thick mass of masonry of
- stone and cement. The piece once cast, it must be bored with
- great precision, so as to preclude any possible windage. So there
- will be no loss whatever of gas, and all the expansive force of
- the powder will be employed in the propulsion."
-
- "One simple question," said Elphinstone: "is our gun to be rifled?"
-
- "No, certainly not," replied Barbicane; "we require an enormous
- initial velocity; and you are well aware that a shot quits a
- rifled gun less rapidly than it does a smooth-bore."
-
- "True," rejoined the major.
-
- The committee here adjourned for a few minutes to tea and sandwiches.
-
- On the discussion being renewed, "Gentlemen," said Barbicane,
- "we must now take into consideration the metal to be employed.
- Our cannon must be possessed of great tenacity, great hardness,
- be infusible by heat, indissoluble, and inoxidable by the
- corrosive action of acids."
-
- "There is no doubt about that," replied the major; "and as we
- shall have to employ an immense quantity of metal, we shall not
- be at a loss for choice."
-
- "Well, then," said Morgan, "I propose the best alloy hitherto
- known, which consists of one hundred parts of copper, twelve of
- tin, and six of brass."
-
- "I admit," replied the president, "that this composition has
- yielded excellent results, but in the present case it would be
- too expensive, and very difficult to work. I think, then, that
- we ought to adopt a material excellent in its way and of low
- price, such as cast iron. What is your advice, major?"
-
- "I quite agree with you," replied Elphinstone.
-
- "In fact," continued Barbicane, "cast iron costs ten times less
- than bronze; it is easy to cast, it runs readily from the moulds
- of sand, it is easy of manipulation, it is at once economical of
- money and of time. In addition, it is excellent as a material,
- and I well remember that during the war, at the siege of
- Atlanta, some iron guns fired one thousand rounds at intervals
- of twenty minutes without injury."
-
- "Cast iron is very brittle, though," replied Morgan.
-
- "Yes, but it possesses great resistance. I will now ask our
- worthy secretary to calculate the weight of a cast-iron gun with
- a bore of nine feet and a thickness of six feet of metal."
-
- "In a moment," replied Maston. Then, dashing off some
- algebraical formulae with marvelous facility, in a minute or two
- he declared the following result:
-
- "The cannon will weigh 68,040 tons. And, at two cents a pound,
- it will cost----"
-
- "Two million five hundred and ten thousand seven hundred and
- one dollars."
-
- Maston, the major, and the general regarded Barbicane with
- uneasy looks.
-
- "Well, gentlemen," replied the president, "I repeat what I
- said yesterday. Make yourselves easy; the millions will not
- be wanting."
-
- With this assurance of their president the committee separated,
- after having fixed their third meeting for the following evening.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IX
-
-
- THE QUESTION OF THE POWDERS
-
-
- There remained for consideration merely the question of powders.
- The public awaited with interest its final decision. The size
- of the projectile, the length of the cannon being settled, what
- would be the quantity of powder necessary to produce impulsion?
-
- It is generally asserted that gunpowder was invented in the
- fourteenth century by the monk Schwartz, who paid for his grand
- discovery with his life. It is, however, pretty well proved
- that this story ought to be ranked among the legends of the
- middle ages. Gunpowder was not invented by any one; it was the
- lineal successor of the Greek fire, which, like itself, was
- composed of sulfur and saltpeter. Few persons are acquainted
- with the mechanical power of gunpowder. Now this is precisely
- what is necessary to be understood in order to comprehend the
- importance of the question submitted to the committee.
-
- A litre of gunpowder weighs about two pounds; during combustion
- it produces 400 litres of gas. This gas, on being liberated and
- acted upon by temperature raised to 2,400 degrees, occupies a
- space of 4,000 litres: consequently the volume of powder is to
- the volume of gas produced by its combustion as 1 to 4,000.
- One may judge, therefore, of the tremendous pressure on this
- gas when compressed within a space 4,000 times too confined.
- All this was, of course, well known to the members of the committee
- when they met on the following evening.
-
- The first speaker on this occasion was Major Elphinstone, who
- had been the director of the gunpowder factories during the war.
-
- "Gentlemen," said this distinguished chemist, "I begin with
- some figures which will serve as the basis of our calculation.
- The old 24-pounder shot required for its discharge sixteen pounds
- of powder."
-
- "You are certain of this amount?" broke in Barbicane.
-
- "Quite certain," replied the major. "The Armstrong cannon
- employs only seventy-five pounds of powder for a projectile
- of eight hundred pounds, and the Rodman Columbiad uses only one
- hundred and sixty pounds of powder to send its half ton shot a
- distance of six miles. These facts cannot be called in question,
- for I myself raised the point during the depositions taken before
- the committee of artillery."
-
- "Quite true," said the general.
-
- "Well," replied the major, "these figures go to prove that the
- quantity of powder is not increased with the weight of the shot;
- that is to say, if a 24-pounder shot requires sixteen pounds of
- powder;-- in other words, if in ordinary guns we employ a
- quantity of powder equal to two-thirds of the weight of the
- projectile, this proportion is not constant. Calculate, and you
- will see that in place of three hundred and thirty-three pounds
- of powder, the quantity is reduced to no more than one hundred
- and sixty pounds."
-
- "What are you aiming at?" asked the president.
-
- "If you push your theory to extremes, my dear major," said J. T.
- Maston, "you will get to this, that as soon as your shot becomes
- sufficiently heavy you will not require any powder at all."
-
- "Our friend Maston is always at his jokes, even in serious
- matters," cried the major; "but let him make his mind easy, I am
- going presently to propose gunpowder enough to satisfy his
- artillerist's propensities. I only keep to statistical facts
- when I say that, during the war, and for the very largest guns,
- the weight of the powder was reduced, as the result of
- experience, to a tenth part of the weight of the shot."
-
- "Perfectly correct," said Morgan; "but before deciding the
- quantity of powder necessary to give the impulse, I think it
- would be as well----"
-
- "We shall have to employ a large-grained powder," continued the
- major; "its combustion is more rapid than that of the small."
-
- "No doubt about that," replied Morgan; "but it is very
- destructive, and ends by enlarging the bore of the pieces."
-
- "Granted; but that which is injurious to a gun destined to
- perform long service is not so to our Columbiad. We shall
- run no danger of an explosion; and it is necessary that our
- powder should take fire instantaneously in order that its
- mechanical effect may be complete."
-
- "We must have," said Maston, "several touch-holes, so as to fire
- it at different points at the same time."
-
- "Certainly," replied Elphinstone; "but that will render the
- working of the piece more difficult. I return then to my
- large-grained powder, which removes those difficulties.
- In his Columbiad charges Rodman employed a powder as large
- as chestnuts, made of willow charcoal, simply dried in cast-
- iron pans. This powder was hard and glittering, left no trace
- upon the hand, contained hydrogen and oxygen in large proportion,
- took fire instantaneously, and, though very destructive, did not
- sensibly injure the mouth-piece."
-
- Up to this point Barbicane had kept aloof from the discussion;
- he left the others to speak while he himself listened; he had
- evidently got an idea. He now simply said, "Well, my friends,
- what quantity of powder do you propose?"
-
- The three members looked at one another.
-
- "Two hundred thousand pounds." at last said Morgan.
-
- "Five hundred thousand," added the major.
-
- "Eight hundred thousand," screamed Maston.
-
- A moment of silence followed this triple proposal; it was at
- last broken by the president.
-
- "Gentlemen," he quietly said, "I start from this principle, that
- the resistance of a gun, constructed under the given conditions,
- is unlimited. I shall surprise our friend Maston, then, by
- stigmatizing his calculations as timid; and I propose to double
- his 800,000 pounds of powder."
-
- "Sixteen hundred thousand pounds?" shouted Maston, leaping from
- his seat.
-
- "Just so."
-
- "We shall have to come then to my ideal of a cannon half a mile
- long; for you see 1,600,000 pounds will occupy a space of about
- 20,000 cubic feet; and since the contents of your cannon do not
- exceed 54,000 cubic feet, it would be half full; and the bore
- will not be more than long enough for the gas to communicate to
- the projectile sufficient impulse."
-
- "Nevertheless," said the president, "I hold to that quantity
- of powder. Now, 1,600,000 pounds of powder will create
- 6,000,000,000 litres of gas. Six thousand millions!
- You quite understand?"
-
- "What is to be done then?" said the general.
-
- "The thing is very simple; we must reduce this enormous quantity
- of powder, while preserving to it its mechanical power."
-
- "Good; but by what means?"
-
- "I am going to tell you," replied Barbicane quietly.
-
- "Nothing is more easy than to reduce this mass to one quarter of
- its bulk. You know that curious cellular matter which
- constitutes the elementary tissues of vegetable? This substance
- is found quite pure in many bodies, especially in cotton, which
- is nothing more than the down of the seeds of the cotton plant.
- Now cotton, combined with cold nitric acid, become transformed
- into a substance eminently insoluble, combustible, and explosive.
- It was first discovered in 1832, by Braconnot, a French chemist,
- who called it xyloidine. In 1838 another Frenchman, Pelouze,
- investigated its different properties, and finally, in 1846,
- Schonbein, professor of chemistry at Bale, proposed its employment
- for purposes of war. This powder, now called pyroxyle, or
- fulminating cotton, is prepared with great facility by simply
- plunging cotton for fifteen minutes in nitric acid, then washing
- it in water, then drying it, and it is ready for use."
-
- "Nothing could be more simple," said Morgan.
-
- "Moreover, pyroxyle is unaltered by moisture-- a valuable
- property to us, inasmuch as it would take several days to charge
- the cannon. It ignites at 170 degrees in place of 240, and its
- combustion is so rapid that one may set light to it on the top
- of the ordinary powder, without the latter having time to ignite."
-
- "Perfect!" exclaimed the major.
-
- "Only it is more expensive."
-
- "What matter?" cried J. T. Maston.
-
- "Finally, it imparts to projectiles a velocity four times
- superior to that of gunpowder. I will even add, that if we mix
- it with one-eighth of its own weight of nitrate of potassium,
- its expansive force is again considerably augmented."
-
- "Will that be necessary?" asked the major.
-
- "I think not," replied Barbicane. "So, then, in place of
- 1,600,000 pounds of powder, we shall have but 400,000 pounds of
- fulminating cotton; and since we can, without danger, compress
- 500 pounds of cotton into twenty-seven cubic feet, the whole
- quantity will not occupy a height of more than 180 feet within
- the bore of the Columbiad. In this way the shot will have more
- than 700 feet of bore to traverse under a force of 6,000,000,000
- litres of gas before taking its flight toward the moon."
-
- At this juncture J. T. Maston could not repress his emotion; he
- flung himself into the arms of his friend with the violence of
- a projectile, and Barbicane would have been stove in if he had
- not been boom-proof.
-
- This incident terminated the third meeting of the committee.
-
- Barbicane and his bold colleagues, to whom nothing seemed
- impossible, had succeeding in solving the complex problems of
- projectile, cannon, and powder. Their plan was drawn up, and it
- only remained to put it into execution.
-
- "A mere matter of detail, a bagatelle," said J. T. Maston.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER X
-
-
- ONE ENEMY _v._ TWENTY-FIVE MILLIONS OF FRIENDS
-
-
- The American public took a lively interest in the smallest
- details of the enterprise of the Gun Club. It followed day by
- day the discussion of the committee. The most simple
- preparations for the great experiment, the questions of figures
- which it involved, the mechanical difficulties to be resolved--
- in one word, the entire plan of work-- roused the popular
- excitement to the highest pitch.
-
- The purely scientific attraction was suddenly intensified by the
- following incident:
-
- We have seen what legions of admirers and friends Barbicane's
- project had rallied round its author. There was, however,
- one single individual alone in all the States of the Union who
- protested against the attempt of the Gun Club. He attacked it
- furiously on every opportunity, and human nature is such that
- Barbicane felt more keenly the opposition of that one man than
- he did the applause of all the others. He was well aware of the
- motive of this antipathy, the origin of this solitary enmity,
- the cause of its personality and old standing, and in what
- rivalry of self-love it had its rise.
-
- This persevering enemy the president of the Gun Club had never seen.
- Fortunate that it was so, for a meeting between the two men would
- certainly have been attended with serious consequences. This rival
- was a man of science, like Barbicane himself, of a fiery, daring,
- and violent disposition; a pure Yankee. His name was Captain
- Nicholl; he lived at Philadelphia.
-
- Most people are aware of the curious struggle which arose during
- the Federal war between the guns and armor of iron-plated ships.
- The result was the entire reconstruction of the navy of both the
- continents; as the one grew heavier, the other became thicker
- in proportion. The Merrimac, the Monitor, the Tennessee, the
- Weehawken discharged enormous projectiles themselves, after
- having been armor-clad against the projectiles of others. In fact
- they did to others that which they would not they should do to them--
- that grand principle of immortality upon which rests the whole art
- of war.
-
- Now if Barbicane was a great founder of shot, Nicholl was a
- great forger of plates; the one cast night and day at Baltimore,
- the other forged day and night at Philadelphia. As soon as ever
- Barbicane invented a new shot, Nicholl invented a new plate;
- each followed a current of ideas essentially opposed to the other.
- Happily for these citizens, so useful to their country, a distance
- of from fifty to sixty miles separated them from one another, and
- they had never yet met. Which of these two inventors had the
- advantage over the other it was difficult to decide from the
- results obtained. By last accounts, however, it would seem that
- the armor-plate would in the end have to give way to the shot;
- nevertheless, there were competent judges who had their doubts
- on the point.
-
- At the last experiment the cylindro-conical projectiles of
- Barbicane stuck like so many pins in the Nicholl plates.
- On that day the Philadelphia iron-forger then believed himself
- victorious, and could not evince contempt enough for his rival;
- but when the other afterward substituted for conical shot simple
- 600-pound shells, at very moderate velocity, the captain was
- obliged to give in. In fact, these projectiles knocked his best
- metal plate to shivers.
-
- Matters were at this stage, and victory seemed to rest with the
- shot, when the war came to an end on the very day when Nicholl
- had completed a new armor-plate of wrought steel. It was a
- masterpiece of its kind, and bid defiance to all the projectiles
- of the world. The captain had it conveyed to the Polygon at
- Washington, challenging the president of the Gun Club to break it.
- Barbicane, peace having been declared, declined to try the experiment.
-
- Nicholl, now furious, offered to expose his plate to the shock
- of any shot, solid, hollow, round, or conical. Refused by the
- president, who did not choose to compromise his last success.
-
- Nicholl, disgusted by this obstinacy, tried to tempt Barbicane
- by offering him every chance. He proposed to fix the plate
- within two hundred yards of the gun. Barbicane still obstinate
- in refusal. A hundred yards? Not even seventy-five!
-
- "At fifty then!" roared the captain through the newspapers.
- "At twenty-five yards! and I'll stand behind!"
-
- Barbicane returned for answer that, even if Captain Nicholl
- would be so good as to stand in front, he would not fire any more.
-
- Nicholl could not contain himself at this reply; threw out hints
- of cowardice; that a man who refused to fire a cannon-shot was
- pretty near being afraid of it; that artillerists who fight at
- six miles distance are substituting mathematical formulae for
- individual courage.
-
- To these insinuations Barbicane returned no answer; perhaps he
- never heard of them, so absorbed was he in the calculations for
- his great enterprise.
-
- When his famous communication was made to the Gun Club, the
- captain's wrath passed all bounds; with his intense jealousy was
- mingled a feeling of absolute impotence. How was he to invent
- anything to beat this 900-feet Columbiad? What armor-plate
- could ever resist a projectile of 30,000 pounds weight?
- Overwhelmed at first under this violent shock, he by and by
- recovered himself, and resolved to crush the proposal by weight
- of his arguments.
-
- He then violently attacked the labors of the Gun Club, published
- a number of letters in the newspapers, endeavored to prove Barbicane
- ignorant of the first principles of gunnery. He maintained that
- it was absolutely impossible to impress upon any body whatever
- a velocity of 12,000 yards per second; that even with such a
- velocity a projectile of such a weight could not transcend the
- limits of the earth's atmosphere. Further still, even regarding
- the velocity to be acquired, and granting it to be sufficient,
- the shell could not resist the pressure of the gas developed by
- the ignition of 1,600,000 pounds of powder; and supposing it to
- resist that pressure, it would be less able to support that
- temperature; it would melt on quitting the Columbiad, and fall
- back in a red-hot shower upon the heads of the imprudent spectators.
-
- Barbicane continued his work without regarding these attacks.
-
- Nicholl then took up the question in its other aspects. Without
- touching upon its uselessness in all points of view, he regarded
- the experiment as fraught with extreme danger, both to the
- citizens, who might sanction by their presence so reprehensible
- a spectacle, and also to the towns in the neighborhood of this
- deplorable cannon. He also observed that if the projectile did
- not succeed in reaching its destination (a result absolutely
- impossible), it must inevitably fall back upon the earth, and
- that the shock of such a mass, multiplied by the square of its
- velocity, would seriously endanger every point of the globe.
- Under the circumstances, therefore, and without interfering with
- the rights of free citizens, it was a case for the intervention
- of Government, which ought not to endanger the safety of all for
- the pleasure of one individual.
-
- In spite of all his arguments, however, Captain Nicholl
- remained alone in his opinion. Nobody listened to him, and he
- did not succeed in alienating a single admirer from the
- president of the Gun Club. The latter did not even take the
- pains to refute the arguments of his rival.
-
- Nicholl, driven into his last entrenchments, and not able to
- fight personally in the cause, resolved to fight with money.
- He published, therefore, in the Richmond _Inquirer_ a series of
- wagers, conceived in these terms, and on an increasing scale:
-
- No. 1 ($1,000).-- That the necessary funds for the experiment
- of the Gun Club will not be forthcoming.
-
- No. 2 ($2,000).-- That the operation of casting a cannon of 900
- feet is impracticable, and cannot possibly succeed.
-
- No. 3 ($3,000).-- That is it impossible to load the Columbiad,
- and that the pyroxyle will take fire spontaneously under the
- pressure of the projectile.
-
- No. 4 ($4,000).-- That the Columbiad will burst at the first fire.
-
- No. 5 ($5,000).-- That the shot will not travel farther than six miles,
- and that it will fall back again a few seconds after its discharge.
-
- It was an important sum, therefore, which the captain risked in
- his invincible obstinacy. He had no less than $15,000 at stake.
-
- Notwithstanding the importance of the challenge, on the 19th of
- May he received a sealed packet containing the following
- superbly laconic reply:
- "BALTIMORE, October 19.
- "Done.
- "BARBICANE."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XI
-
-
- FLORIDA AND TEXAS
-
-
- One question remained yet to be decided; it was necessary to
- choose a favorable spot for the experiment. According to the
- advice of the Observatory of Cambridge, the gun must be fired
- perpendicularly to the plane of the horizon, that is to say,
- toward the zenith. Now the moon does not traverse the zenith,
- except in places situated between 0@ and 28@ of latitude. It
- became, then, necessary to determine exactly that spot on the
- globe where the immense Columbiad should be cast.
-
- On the 20th of October, at a general meeting of the Gun Club,
- Barbicane produced a magnificent map of the United States.
- "Gentlemen," said he, in opening the discussion, "I presume that
- we are all agreed that this experiment cannot and ought not to
- be tried anywhere but within the limits of the soil of the Union.
- Now, by good fortune, certain frontiers of the United States
- extend downward as far as the 28th parallel of the north latitude.
- If you will cast your eye over this map, you will see that we have at
- our disposal the whole of the southern portion of Texas and Florida."
-
- It was finally agreed, then, that the Columbiad must be cast on
- the soil of either Texas or Florida. The result, however, of
- this decision was to create a rivalry entirely without precedent
- between the different towns of these two States.
-
- The 28th parallel, on reaching the American coast, traverses the
- peninsula of Florida, dividing it into two nearly equal portions.
- Then, plunging into the Gulf of Mexico, it subtends the arc
- formed by the coast of Alabama, Mississippi, and Louisiana;
- then skirting Texas, off which it cuts an angle, it continues
- its course over Mexico, crosses the Sonora, Old California,
- and loses itself in the Pacific Ocean. It was, therefore,
- only those portions of Texas and Florida which were situated
- below this parallel which came within the prescribed conditions
- of latitude.
-
- Florida, in its southern part, reckons no cities of importance;
- it is simply studded with forts raised against the roving Indians.
- One solitary town, Tampa Town, was able to put in a claim in favor
- of its situation.
-
- In Texas, on the contrary, the towns are much more numerous
- and important. Corpus Christi, in the county of Nueces, and all
- the cities situated on the Rio Bravo, Laredo, Comalites, San
- Ignacio on the Web, Rio Grande City on the Starr, Edinburgh in
- the Hidalgo, Santa Rita, Elpanda, Brownsville in the Cameron,
- formed an imposing league against the pretensions of Florida.
- So, scarcely was the decision known, when the Texan and Floridan
- deputies arrived at Baltimore in an incredibly short space of time.
- From that very moment President Barbicane and the influential
- members of the Gun Club were besieged day and night by
- formidable claims. If seven cities of Greece contended for
- the honor of having given birth to a Homer, here were two entire
- States threatening to come to blows about the question of a cannon.
-
- The rival parties promenaded the streets with arms in their hands;
- and at every occasion of their meeting a collision was to be
- apprehended which might have been attended with disastrous results.
- Happily the prudence and address of President Barbicane averted
- the danger. These personal demonstrations found a division in
- the newspapers of the different States. The New York _Herald_ and
- the _Tribune_ supported Texas, while the _Times_ and the _American
- Review_ espoused the cause of the Floridan deputies. The members
- of the Gun Club could not decide to which to give the preference.
-
- Texas produced its array of twenty-six counties; Florida replied
- that twelve counties were better than twenty-six in a country
- only one-sixth part of the size.
-
- Texas plumed itself upon its 330,000 natives; Florida, with a
- far smaller territory, boasted of being much more densely
- populated with 56,000.
-
- The Texans, through the columns of the _Herald_ claimed that
- some regard should be had to a State which grew the best cotton
- in all America, produced the best green oak for the service of
- the navy, and contained the finest oil, besides iron mines, in
- which the yield was fifty per cent. of pure metal.
-
- To this the _American Review_ replied that the soil of Florida,
- although not equally rich, afforded the best conditions for the
- moulding and casting of the Columbiad, consisting as it did of
- sand and argillaceous earth.
-
- "That may be all very well," replied the Texans; "but you must
- first get to this country. Now the communications with Florida
- are difficult, while the coast of Texas offers the bay of
- Galveston, which possesses a circumference of fourteen leagues,
- and is capable of containing the navies of the entire world!"
-
- "A pretty notion truly," replied the papers in the interest of
- Florida, "that of Galveston bay _below the 29th parallel!_
- Have we not got the bay of Espiritu Santo, opening precisely upon
- _the 28th degree_, and by which ships can reach Tampa Town by
- direct route?"
-
- "A fine bay; half choked with sand!"
-
- "Choked yourselves!" returned the others.
-
- Thus the war went on for several days, when Florida endeavored
- to draw her adversary away on to fresh ground; and one morning
- the _Times_ hinted that, the enterprise being essentially
- American, it ought not to be attempted upon other than purely
- American territory.
-
- To these words Texas retorted, "American! are we not as much so
- as you? Were not Texas and Florida both incorporated into the
- Union in 1845?"
-
- "Undoubtedly," replied the _Times_; "but we have belonged to the
- Americans ever since 1820."
-
- "Yes!" returned the _Tribune_; "after having been Spaniards or
- English for two hundred years, you were sold to the United
- States for five million dollars!"
-
- "Well! and why need we blush for that? Was not Louisiana bought
- from Napoleon in 1803 at the price of sixteen million dollars?"
-
- "Scandalous!" roared the Texas deputies. "A wretched little
- strip of country like Florida to dare to compare itself to
- Texas, who, in place of selling herself, asserted her own
- independence, drove out the Mexicans in March 2, 1846, and
- declared herself a federal republic after the victory gained by
- Samuel Houston, on the banks of the San Jacinto, over the troops
- of Santa Anna!-- a country, in fine, which voluntarily annexed
- itself to the United States of America!"
-
- "Yes; because it was afraid of the Mexicans!" replied Florida.
-
- "Afraid!" From this moment the state of things became intolerable.
- A sanguinary encounter seemed daily imminent between the two
- parties in the streets of Baltimore. It became necessary to keep
- an eye upon the deputies.
-
- President Barbicane knew not which way to look. Notes, documents,
- letters full of menaces showered down upon his house. Which side
- ought he to take? As regarded the appropriation of the soil, the
- facility of communication, the rapidity of transport, the claims
- of both States were evenly balanced. As for political prepossessions,
- they had nothing to do with the question.
-
- This dead block had existed for some little time, when Barbicane
- resolved to get rid of it all at once. He called a meeting of
- his colleagues, and laid before them a proposition which, it will
- be seen, was profoundly sagacious.
-
- "On carefully considering," he said, "what is going on now
- between Florida and Texas, it is clear that the same
- difficulties will recur with all the towns of the favored State.
- The rivalry will descend from State to city, and so on downward.
- Now Texas possesses eleven towns within the prescribed
- conditions, which will further dispute the honor and create us
- new enemies, while Florida has only one. I go in, therefore,
- for Florida and Tampa Town."
-
- This decision, on being made known, utterly crushed the
- Texan deputies. Seized with an indescribable fury, they
- addressed threatening letters to the different members of the
- Gun Club by name. The magistrates had but one course to take,
- and they took it. They chartered a special train, forced the
- Texans into it whether they would or no; and they quitted the
- city with a speed of thirty miles an hour.
-
- Quickly, however, as they were despatched, they found time to
- hurl one last and bitter sarcasm at their adversaries.
-
- Alluding to the extent of Florida, a mere peninsula confined
- between two seas, they pretended that it could never sustain
- the shock of the discharge, and that it would "bust up" at the
- very first shot.
-
- "Very well, let it bust up!" replied the Floridans, with a
- brevity of the days of ancient Sparta.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XII
-
-
- URBI ET ORBI
-
-
- The astronomical, mechanical, and topographical difficulties
- resolved, finally came the question of finance. The sum
- required was far too great for any individual, or even any
- single State, to provide the requisite millions.
-
- President Barbicane undertook, despite of the matter being a
- purely American affair, to render it one of universal interest,
- and to request the financial co-operation of all peoples.
- It was, he maintained, the right and duty of the whole earth
- to interfere in the affairs of its satellite. The subscription
- opened at Baltimore extended properly to the whole world-- _Urbi
- et orbi_.
-
- This subscription was successful beyond all expectation;
- notwithstanding that it was a question not of lending but of
- giving the money. It was a purely disinterested operation in
- the strictest sense of the term, and offered not the slightest
- chance of profit.
-
- The effect, however, of Barbicane's communication was not
- confined to the frontiers of the United States; it crossed
- the Atlantic and Pacific, invading simultaneously Asia and
- Europe, Africa and Oceanica. The observatories of the Union
- placed themselves in immediate communication with those of
- foreign countries. Some, such as those of Paris, Petersburg,
- Berlin, Stockholm, Hamburg, Malta, Lisbon, Benares, Madras,
- and others, transmitted their good wishes; the rest maintained
- a prudent silence, quietly awaiting the result. As for the
- observatory at Greenwich, seconded as it was by the twenty-
- two astronomical establishments of Great Britain, it spoke
- plainly enough. It boldly denied the possibility of success,
- and pronounced in favor of the theories of Captain Nicholl.
- But this was nothing more than mere English jealousy.
-
- On the 8th of October President Barbicane published a manifesto
- full of enthusiasm, in which he made an appeal to "all persons
- of good will upon the face of the earth." This document,
- translated into all languages, met with immense success.
-
- Subscription lists were opened in all the principal cities of
- the Union, with a central office at the Baltimore Bank, 9
- Baltimore Street.
-
- In addition, subscriptions were received at the following banks
- in the different states of the two continents:
-
- At Vienna, with S. M. de Rothschild.
- At Petersburg, Stieglitz and Co.
- At Paris, The Credit Mobilier.
- At Stockholm, Tottie and Arfuredson.
- At London, N. M. Rothschild and Son.
- At Turin, Ardouin and Co.
- At Berlin, Mendelssohn.
- At Geneva, Lombard, Odier and Co.
- At Constantinople, The Ottoman Bank.
- At Brussels, J. Lambert.
- At Madrid, Daniel Weisweller.
- At Amsterdam, Netherlands Credit Co.
- At Rome, Torlonia and Co.
- At Lisbon, Lecesne.
- At Copenhagen, Private Bank.
- At Rio de Janeiro, Private Bank.
- At Montevideo, Private Bank.
- At Valparaiso and Lima, Thomas la Chambre and Co.
- At Mexico, Martin Daran and Co.
-
- Three days after the manifesto of President Barbicane $4,000,000
- were paid into the different towns of the Union. With such a
- balance the Gun Club might begin operations at once. But some
- days later advices were received to the effect that foreign
- subscriptions were being eagerly taken up. Certain countries
- distinguished themselves by their liberality; others untied
- their purse-strings with less facility--a matter of temperament.
- Figures are, however, more eloquent than words, and here is the
- official statement of the sums which were paid in to the credit
- of the Gun Club at the close of the subscription.
-
- Russia paid in as her contingent the enormous sum of 368,733 roubles.
- No one need be surprised at this, who bears in mind the scientific
- taste of the Russians, and the impetus which they have given to
- astronomical studies--thanks to their numerous observatories.
-
- France began by deriding the pretensions of the Americans.
- The moon served as a pretext for a thousand stale puns and
- a score of ballads, in which bad taste contested the palm
- with ignorance. But as formerly the French paid before singing,
- so now they paid after having had their laugh, and they subscribed
- for a sum of 1,253,930 francs. At that price they had a right
- to enjoy themselves a little.
-
- Austria showed herself generous in the midst of her financial crisis.
- Her public contributions amounted to the sum of 216,000 florins--
- a perfect godsend.
-
- Fifty-two thousand rix-dollars were the remittance of Sweden
- and Norway; the amount is large for the country, but it would
- undoubtedly have been considerably increased had the
- subscription been opened in Christiana simultaneously with that
- at Stockholm. For some reason or other the Norwegians do not
- like to send their money to Sweden.
-
- Prussia, by a remittance of 250,000 thalers, testified her high
- approval of the enterprise.
-
- Turkey behaved generously; but she had a personal interest in
- the matter. The moon, in fact, regulates the cycle of her years
- and her fast of Ramadan. She could not do less than give
- 1,372,640 piastres; and she gave them with an eagerness which
- denoted, however, some pressure on the part of the government.
-
- Belgium distinguished herself among the second-rate states by
- a grant of 513,000 francs-- about two centimes per head of
- her population.
-
- Holland and her colonies interested themselves to the extent of
- 110,000 florins, only demanding an allowance of five per cent.
- discount for paying ready money.
-
- Denmark, a little contracted in territory, gave nevertheless
- 9,000 ducats, proving her love for scientific experiments.
-
- The Germanic Confederation pledged itself to 34,285 florins.
- It was impossible to ask for more; besides, they would not have
- given it.
-
- Though very much crippled, Italy found 200,000 lire in the
- pockets of her people. If she had had Venetia she would have
- done better; but she had not.
-
- The States of the Church thought that they could not send less
- than 7,040 Roman crowns; and Portugal carried her devotion to
- science as far as 30,000 cruzados. It was the widow's mite--
- eighty-six piastres; but self-constituted empires are always
- rather short of money.
-
- Two hundred and fifty-seven francs, this was the modest
- contribution of Switzerland to the American work. One must
- freely admit that she did not see the practical side of
- the matter. It did not seem to her that the mere despatch of
- a shot to the moon could possibly establish any relation of
- affairs with her; and it did not seem prudent to her to embark
- her capital in so hazardous an enterprise. After all, perhaps
- she was right.
-
- As to Spain, she could not scrape together more than 110 reals.
- She gave as an excuse that she had her railways to finish.
- The truth is, that science is not favorably regarded in that
- country, it is still in a backward state; and moreover, certain
- Spaniards, not by any means the least educated, did not form a
- correct estimate of the bulk of the projectile compared with
- that of the moon. They feared that it would disturb the
- established order of things. In that case it were better to
- keep aloof; which they did to the tune of some reals.
-
- There remained but England; and we know the contemptuous
- antipathy with which she received Barbicane's proposition.
- The English have but one soul for the whole twenty-six millions
- of inhabitants which Great Britain contains. They hinted that
- the enterprise of the Gun Club was contrary to the "principle of
- non-intervention." And they did not subscribe a single farthing.
-
- At this intimation the Gun Club merely shrugged its shoulders
- and returned to its great work. When South America, that is to
- say, Peru, Chili, Brazil, the provinces of La Plata and Columbia,
- had poured forth their quota into their hands, the sum of $300,000,
- it found itself in possession of a considerable capital, of which
- the following is a statement:
-
- United States subscriptions, . . $4,000,000
- Foreign subscriptions . . . $1,446,675
- -----------
- Total, . . . . $5,446,675
-
-
- Such was the sum which the public poured into the treasury of
- the Gun Club.
-
- Let no one be surprised at the vastness of the amount. The work
- of casting, boring, masonry, the transport of workmen, their
- establishment in an almost uninhabited country, the construction
- of furnaces and workshops, the plant, the powder, the projectile,
- and incipient expenses, would, according to the estimates, absorb
- nearly the whole. Certain cannon-shots in the Federal war cost
- one thousand dollars apiece. This one of President Barbicane,
- unique in the annals of gunnery, might well cost five thousand
- times more.
-
- On the 20th of October a contract was entered into with the
- manufactory at Coldspring, near New York, which during the war
- had furnished the largest Parrott, cast-iron guns. It was
- stipulated between the contracting parties that the manufactory
- of Coldspring should engage to transport to Tampa Town,
- in southern Florida, the necessary materials for casting
- the Columbiad. The work was bound to be completed at latest
- by the 15th of October following, and the cannon delivered
- in good condition under penalty of a forfeit of one hundred
- dollars a day to the moment when the moon should again present
- herself under the same conditions-- that is to say, in eighteen
- years and eleven days.
-
- The engagement of the workmen, their pay, and all the necessary
- details of the work, devolved upon the Coldspring Company.
-
- This contract, executed in duplicate, was signed by Barbicane,
- president of the Gun Club, of the one part, and T. Murchison
- director of the Coldspring manufactory, of the other, who thus
- executed the deed on behalf of their respective principals.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIII
-
-
- STONES HILL
-
-
- When the decision was arrived at by the Gun Club, to the
- disparagement of Texas, every one in America, where reading is
- a universal acquirement, set to work to study the geography
- of Florida. Never before had there been such a sale for works
- like "Bertram's Travels in Florida," "Roman's Natural History of
- East and West Florida," "William's Territory of Florida," and
- "Cleland on the Cultivation of the Sugar-Cane in Florida."
- It became necessary to issue fresh editions of these works.
-
- Barbicane had something better to do than to read. He desired
- to see things with his own eyes, and to mark the exact position
- of the proposed gun. So, without a moment's loss of time, he
- placed at the disposal of the Cambridge Observatory the funds
- necessary for the construction of a telescope, and entered into
- negotiations with the house of Breadwill and Co., of Albany, for
- the construction of an aluminum projectile of the required size.
- He then quitted Baltimore, accompanied by J. T. Maston, Major
- Elphinstone, and the manager of the Coldspring factory.
-
- On the following day, the four fellow-travelers arrived at
- New Orleans. There they immediately embarked on board the
- _Tampico_, a despatch-boat belonging to the Federal navy, which
- the government had placed at their disposal; and, getting up
- steam, the banks of Louisiana speedily disappeared from sight.
-
- The passage was not long. Two days after starting, the _Tampico_,
- having made four hundred and eighty miles, came in sight of the
- coast of Florida. On a nearer approach Barbicane found himself
- in view of a low, flat country of somewhat barren aspect.
- After coasting along a series of creeks abounding in lobsters
- and oysters, the _Tampico_ entered the bay of Espiritu Santo,
- where she finally anchored in a small natural harbor, formed by
- the _embouchure_ of the River Hillisborough, at seven P.M., on
- the 22d of October.
-
- Our four passengers disembarked at once. "Gentlemen," said
- Barbicane, "we have no time to lose; tomorrow we must obtain
- horses, and proceed to reconnoiter the country."
-
- Barbicane had scarcely set his foot on shore when three thousand
- of the inhabitants of Tampa Town came forth to meet him, an
- honor due to the president who had signalized their country by
- his choice.
-
- Declining, however, every kind of ovation, Barbicane ensconced
- himself in a room of the Franklin Hotel.
-
- On the morrow some of the small horses of the Spanish breed,
- full of vigor and of fire, stood snorting under his windows;
- but instead of four steeds, here were fifty, together with
- their riders. Barbicane descended with his three fellow-
- travelers; and much astonished were they all to find themselves
- in the midst of such a cavalcade. He remarked that every
- horseman carried a carbine slung across his shoulders and
- pistols in his holsters.
-
- On expressing his surprise at these preparations, he was
- speedily enlightened by a young Floridan, who quietly said:
-
- "Sir, there are Seminoles there."
-
- "What do you mean by Seminoles?"
-
- "Savages who scour the prairies. We thought it best, therefore,
- to escort you on your road."
-
- "Pooh!" cried J. T. Maston, mounting his steed.
-
- "All right," said the Floridan; "but it is true enough, nevertheless."
-
- "Gentlemen," answered Barbicane, "I thank you for your kind
- attention; but it is time to be off."
-
- It was five A.M. when Barbicane and his party, quitting Tampa Town,
- made their way along the coast in the direction of Alifia Creek.
- This little river falls into Hillisborough Bay twelve miles above
- Tampa Town. Barbicane and his escort coasted along its right bank
- to the eastward. Soon the waves of the bay disappeared behind a
- bend of rising ground, and the Floridan "champagne" alone offered
- itself to view.
-
- Florida, discovered on Palm Sunday, in 1512, by Juan Ponce de
- Leon, was originally named _Pascha Florida_. It little deserved
- that designation, with its dry and parched coasts. But after
- some few miles of tract the nature of the soil gradually changes
- and the country shows itself worthy of the name. Cultivated plains
- soon appear, where are united all the productions of the northern
- and tropical floras, terminating in prairies abounding with
- pineapples and yams, tobacco, rice, cotton-plants, and sugar-canes,
- which extend beyond reach of sight, flinging their riches broadcast
- with careless prodigality.
-
- Barbicane appeared highly pleased on observing the progressive
- elevation of the land; and in answer to a question of J. T.
- Maston, replied:
-
- "My worthy friend, we cannot do better than sink our Columbiad
- in these high grounds."
-
- "To get nearer the moon, perhaps?" said the secretary of the Gun Club.
-
- "Not exactly," replied Barbicane, smiling; "do you not see that
- among these elevated plateaus we shall have a much easier work
- of it? No struggles with the water-springs, which will save us
- long expensive tubings; and we shall be working in daylight
- instead of down a deep and narrow well. Our business, then, is
- to open our trenches upon ground some hundreds of yards above
- the level of the sea."
-
- "You are right, sir," struck in Murchison, the engineer; "and, if I
- mistake not, we shall ere long find a suitable spot for our purpose."
-
- "I wish we were at the first stroke of the pickaxe," said the president.
-
- "And I wish we were at the _last_," cried J. T. Maston.
-
- About ten A.M. the little band had crossed a dozen miles.
- To fertile plains succeeded a region of forests. There perfumes
- of the most varied kinds mingled together in tropical profusion.
- These almost impenetrable forests were composed of pomegranates,
- orange-trees, citrons, figs, olives, apricots, bananas, huge vines,
- whose blossoms and fruits rivaled each other in color and perfume.
- Beneath the odorous shade of these magnificent trees fluttered and
- warbled a little world of brilliantly plumaged birds.
-
- J. T. Maston and the major could not repress their admiration on
- finding themselves in the presence of the glorious beauties of
- this wealth of nature. President Barbicane, however, less
- sensitive to these wonders, was in haste to press forward;
- the very luxuriance of the country was displeasing to him.
- They hastened onward, therefore, and were compelled to ford
- several rivers, not without danger, for they were infested
- with huge alligators from fifteen to eighteen feet long.
- Maston courageously menaced them with his steel hook, but he
- only succeeded in frightening some pelicans and teal, while
- tall flamingos stared stupidly at the party.
-
- At length these denizens of the swamps disappeared in their
- turn; smaller trees became thinly scattered among less dense
- thickets-- a few isolated groups detached in the midst of
- endless plains over which ranged herds of startled deer.
-
- "At last," cried Barbicane, rising in his stirrups, "here we are
- at the region of pines!"
-
- "Yes! and of savages too," replied the major.
-
- In fact, some Seminoles had just came in sight upon the horizon;
- they rode violently backward and forward on their fleet horses,
- brandishing their spears or discharging their guns with a dull report.
- These hostile demonstrations, however, had no effect upon Barbicane
- and his companions.
-
- They were then occupying the center of a rocky plain, which the
- sun scorched with its parching rays. This was formed by a
- considerable elevation of the soil, which seemed to offer to the
- members of the Gun Club all the conditions requisite for the
- construction of their Columbiad.
-
- "Halt!" said Barbicane, reining up. "Has this place any
- local appellation?"
-
- "It is called Stones Hill," replied one of the Floridans.
-
- Barbicane, without saying a word, dismounted, seized his instruments,
- and began to note his position with extreme exactness. The little
- band, drawn up in the rear, watched his proceedings in profound silence.
-
- At this moment the sun passed the meridian. Barbicane, after a
- few moments, rapidly wrote down the result of his observations,
- and said:
-
- "This spot is situated eighteen hundred feet above the level of
- the sea, in 27@ 7' N. lat. and 5@ 7' W. long. of the meridian
- of Washington. It appears to me by its rocky and barren character
- to offer all the conditions requisite for our experiment. On that
- plain will be raised our magazines, workshops, furnaces, and
- workmen's huts; and here, from this very spot," said he, stamping
- his foot on the summit of Stones Hill, "hence shall our projectile
- take its flight into the regions of the Solar World."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIV
-
-
- PICKAXE AND TROWEL
-
-
- The same evening Barbicane and his companions returned to Tampa
- Town; and Murchison, the engineer, re-embarked on board the
- Tampico for New Orleans. His object was to enlist an army of
- workmen, and to collect together the greater part of the materials.
- The members of the Gun Club remained at Tampa Town, for the
- purpose of setting on foot the preliminary works by the aid of
- the people of the country.
-
- Eight days after its departure, the Tampico returned into the
- bay of Espiritu Santo, with a whole flotilla of steamboats.
- Murchison had succeeded in assembling together fifteen
- hundred artisans. Attracted by the high pay and considerable
- bounties offered by the Gun Club, he had enlisted a choice
- legion of stokers, iron-founders, lime-burners, miners,
- brickmakers, and artisans of every trade, without distinction
- of color. As many of these people brought their families with
- them, their departure resembled a perfect emigration.
-
- On the 31st of October, at ten o'clock in the morning, the troop
- disembarked on the quays of Tampa Town; and one may imagine the
- activity which pervaded that little town, whose population was
- thus doubled in a single day.
-
- During the first few days they were busy discharging the cargo
- brought by the flotilla, the machines, and the rations, as well
- as a large number of huts constructed of iron plates, separately
- pieced and numbered. At the same period Barbicane laid the
- first sleepers of a railway fifteen miles in length, intended to
- unite Stones Hill with Tampa Town. On the first of November
- Barbicane quitted Tampa Town with a detachment of workmen; and
- on the following day the whole town of huts was erected round
- Stones Hill. This they enclosed with palisades; and in respect
- of energy and activity, it might have been mistaken for one of
- the great cities of the Union. Everything was placed under a
- complete system of discipline, and the works were commenced in
- most perfect order.
-
- The nature of the soil having been carefully examined, by means
- of repeated borings, the work of excavation was fixed for the
- 4th of November.
-
- On that day Barbicane called together his foremen and addressed
- them as follows: "You are well aware, my friends, of the
- object with which I have assembled you together in this wild
- part of Florida. Our business is to construct a cannon measuring
- nine feet in its interior diameter, six feet thick, and with a
- stone revetment of nineteen and a half feet in thickness. We have,
- therefore, a well of sixty feet in diameter to dig down to a
- depth of nine hundred feet. This great work must be completed
- within eight months, so that you have 2,543,400 cubic feet of
- earth to excavate in 255 days; that is to say, in round numbers,
- 2,000 cubic feet per day. That which would present no difficulty
- to a thousand navvies working in open country will be of course
- more troublesome in a comparatively confined space. However, the
- thing must be done, and I reckon for its accomplishment upon your
- courage as much as upon your skill."
-
- At eight o'clock the next morning the first stroke of the
- pickaxe was struck upon the soil of Florida; and from that
- moment that prince of tools was never inactive for one moment
- in the hands of the excavators. The gangs relieved each other
- every three hours.
-
- On the 4th of November fifty workmen commenced digging, in the
- very center of the enclosed space on the summit of Stones Hill,
- a circular hole sixty feet in diameter. The pickaxe first
- struck upon a kind of black earth, six inches in thickness,
- which was speedily disposed of. To this earth succeeded two
- feet of fine sand, which was carefully laid aside as being
- valuable for serving the casting of the inner mould. After the
- sand appeared some compact white clay, resembling the chalk of
- Great Britain, which extended down to a depth of four feet.
- Then the iron of the picks struck upon the hard bed of the soil;
- a kind of rock formed of petrified shells, very dry, very solid,
- and which the picks could with difficulty penetrate. At this
- point the excavation exhibited a depth of six and a half feet
- and the work of the masonry was begun.
-
- At the bottom of the excavation they constructed a wheel of oak,
- a kind of circle strongly bolted together, and of immense strength.
- The center of this wooden disc was hollowed out to a diameter
- equal to the exterior diameter of the Columbiad. Upon this wheel
- rested the first layers of the masonry, the stones of which were
- bound together by hydraulic cement, with irresistible tenacity.
- The workmen, after laying the stones from the circumference to
- the center, were thus enclosed within a kind of well twenty-one
- feet in diameter. When this work was accomplished, the miners
- resumed their picks and cut away the rock from underneath the wheel
- itself, taking care to support it as they advanced upon blocks of
- great thickness. At every two feet which the hole gained in depth
- they successively withdrew the blocks. The wheel then sank little
- by little, and with it the massive ring of masonry, on the upper
- bed of which the masons labored incessantly, always reserving some
- vent holes to permit the escape of gas during the operation of
- the casting.
-
- This kind of work required on the part of the workmen extreme
- nicety and minute attention. More than one, in digging
- underneath the wheel, was dangerously injured by the splinters
- of stone. But their ardor never relaxed, night or day. By day
- they worked under the rays of the scorching sun; by night, under
- the gleam of the electric light. The sounds of the picks against
- the rock, the bursting of mines, the grinding of the machines,
- the wreaths of smoke scattered through the air, traced around
- Stones Hill a circle of terror which the herds of buffaloes and
- the war parties of the Seminoles never ventured to pass.
- Nevertheless, the works advanced regularly, as the steam-cranes
- actively removed the rubbish. Of unexpected obstacles there was
- little account; and with regard to foreseen difficulties, they
- were speedily disposed of.
-
- At the expiration of the first month the well had attained the
- depth assigned for that lapse of time, namely, 112 feet. This depth
- was doubled in December, and trebled in January.
-
- During the month of February the workmen had to contend with a
- sheet of water which made its way right across the outer soil.
- It became necessary to employ very powerful pumps and
- compressed-air engines to drain it off, so as to close up the
- orifice from whence it issued; just as one stops a leak on
- board ship. They at last succeeded in getting the upper hand of
- these untoward streams; only, in consequence of the loosening of
- the soil, the wheel partly gave way, and a slight partial
- settlement ensued. This accident cost the life of several workmen.
-
- No fresh occurrence thenceforward arrested the progress of the
- operation; and on the tenth of June, twenty days before the
- expiration of the period fixed by Barbicane, the well, lined
- throughout with its facing of stone, had attained the depth of
- 900 feet. At the bottom the masonry rested upon a massive block
- measuring thirty feet in thickness, while on the upper portion
- it was level with the surrounding soil.
-
- President Barbicane and the members of the Gun Club warmly
- congratulated their engineer Murchison; the cyclopean work had
- been accomplished with extraordinary rapidity.
-
- During these eight months Barbicane never quitted Stones Hill
- for a single instant. Keeping ever close by the work of
- excavation, he busied himself incessantly with the welfare
- and health of his workpeople, and was singularly fortunate
- in warding off the epidemics common to large communities of
- men, and so disastrous in those regions of the globe which
- are exposed to the influences of tropical climates.
-
- Many workmen, it is true, paid with their lives for the rashness
- inherent in these dangerous labors; but these mishaps are impossible
- to be avoided, and they are classed among the details with which
- the Americans trouble themselves but little. They have in fact
- more regard for human nature in general than for the individual
- in particular.
-
- Nevertheless, Barbicane professed opposite principles to these,
- and put them in force at every opportunity. So, thanks to his
- care, his intelligence, his useful intervention in all
- difficulties, his prodigious and humane sagacity, the average of
- accidents did not exceed that of transatlantic countries, noted
- for their excessive precautions-- France, for instance, among
- others, where they reckon about one accident for every two
- hundred thousand francs of work.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XV
-
-
- THE FETE OF THE CASTING
-
-
- During the eight months which were employed in the work of
- excavation the preparatory works of the casting had been carried
- on simultaneously with extreme rapidity. A stranger arriving at
- Stones Hill would have been surprised at the spectacle offered
- to his view.
-
- At 600 yards from the well, and circularly arranged around it as
- a central point, rose 1,200 reverberating ovens, each six feet
- in diameter, and separated from each other by an interval of
- three feet. The circumference occupied by these 1,200 ovens
- presented a length of two miles. Being all constructed on the
- same plan, each with its high quadrangular chimney, they
- produced a most singular effect.
-
- It will be remembered that on their third meeting the committee
- had decided to use cast iron for the Columbiad, and in particular
- the white description. This metal, in fact, is the most
- tenacious, the most ductile, and the most malleable, and
- consequently suitable for all moulding operations; and when
- smelted with pit coal, is of superior quality for all
- engineering works requiring great resisting power, such as
- cannon, steam boilers, hydraulic presses, and the like.
-
- Cast iron, however, if subjected to only one single fusion,
- is rarely sufficiently homogeneous; and it requires a second
- fusion completely to refine it by dispossessing it of its last
- earthly deposits. So long before being forwarded to Tampa Town,
- the iron ore, molten in the great furnaces of Coldspring, and
- brought into contact with coal and silicium heated to a high
- temperature, was carburized and transformed into cast iron.
- After this first operation, the metal was sent on to Stones Hill.
- They had, however, to deal with 136,000,000 pounds of iron, a
- quantity far too costly to send by railway. The cost of
- transport would have been double that of material. It appeared
- preferable to freight vessels at New York, and to load them with
- the iron in bars. This, however, required not less than sixty-
- eight vessels of 1,000 tons, a veritable fleet, which, quitting
- New York on the 3rd of May, on the 10th of the same month ascended
- the Bay of Espiritu Santo, and discharged their cargoes, without
- dues, in the port at Tampa Town. Thence the iron was transported
- by rail to Stones Hill, and about the middle of January this
- enormous mass of metal was delivered at its destination.
-
- It will easily be understood that 1,200 furnaces were not too
- many to melt simultaneously these 60,000 tons of iron. Each of
- these furnaces contained nearly 140,000 pounds weight of metal.
- They were all built after the model of those which served for
- the casting of the Rodman gun; they were trapezoidal in shape,
- with a high elliptical arch. These furnaces, constructed of
- fireproof brick, were especially adapted for burning pit coal,
- with a flat bottom upon which the iron bars were laid. This bottom,
- inclined at an angle of 25 degrees, allowed the metal to flow into
- the receiving troughs; and the 1,200 converging trenches carried
- the molten metal down to the central well.
-
- The day following that on which the works of the masonry and
- boring had been completed, Barbicane set to work upon the
- central mould. His object now was to raise within the center of
- the well, and with a coincident axis, a cylinder 900 feet high,
- and nine feet in diameter, which should exactly fill up the
- space reserved for the bore of the Columbiad. This cylinder was
- composed of a mixture of clay and sand, with the addition of a
- little hay and straw. The space left between the mould and the
- masonry was intended to be filled up by the molten metal, which
- would thus form the walls six feet in thickness. This cylinder,
- in order to maintain its equilibrium, had to be bound by iron
- bands, and firmly fixed at certain intervals by cross-clamps
- fastened into the stone lining; after the castings these would
- be buried in the block of metal, leaving no external projection.
-
- This operation was completed on the 8th of July, and the run of
- the metal was fixed for the following day.
-
- "This _fete_ of the casting will be a grand ceremony," said J.
- T. Maston to his friend Barbicane.
-
- "Undoubtedly," said Barbicane; "but it will not be a public _fete_"
-
- "What! will you not open the gates of the enclosure to all comers?"
-
- "I must be very careful, Maston. The casting of the Columbiad
- is an extremely delicate, not to say a dangerous operation, and
- I should prefer its being done privately. At the discharge of
- the projectile, a _fete_ if you like-- till then, no!"
-
- The president was right. The operation involved unforeseen
- dangers, which a great influx of spectators would have hindered
- him from averting. It was necessary to preserve complete
- freedom of movement. No one was admitted within the enclosure
- except a delegation of members of the Gun Club, who had made the
- voyage to Tampa Town. Among these was the brisk Bilsby, Tom
- Hunter, Colonel Blomsberry, Major Elphinstone, General Morgan,
- and the rest of the lot to whom the casting of the Columbiad was
- a matter of personal interest. J. T. Maston became their cicerone.
- He omitted no point of detail; he conducted them throughout the
- magazines, workshops, through the midst of the engines, and
- compelled them to visit the whole 1,200 furnaces one after
- the other. At the end of the twelve-hundredth visit they were
- pretty well knocked up.
-
- The casting was to take place at twelve o'clock precisely.
- The previous evening each furnace had been charged with 114,000
- pounds weight of metal in bars disposed cross-ways to each other,
- so as to allow the hot air to circulate freely between them.
- At daybreak the 1,200 chimneys vomited their torrents of flame
- into the air, and the ground was agitated with dull tremblings.
- As many pounds of metal as there were to cast, so many pounds of
- coal were there to burn. Thus there were 68,000 tons of coal
- which projected in the face of the sun a thick curtain of smoke.
- The heat soon became insupportable within the circle of furnaces,
- the rumbling of which resembled the rolling of thunder. The powerful
- ventilators added their continuous blasts and saturated with
- oxygen the glowing plates. The operation, to be successful,
- required to be conducted with great rapidity. On a signal given
- by a cannon-shot each furnace was to give vent to the molten
- iron and completely to empty itself. These arrangements made,
- foremen and workmen waited the preconcerted moment with an
- impatience mingled with a certain amount of emotion. Not a soul
- remained within the enclosure. Each superintendent took his
- post by the aperture of the run.
-
- Barbicane and his colleagues, perched on a neighboring eminence,
- assisted at the operation. In front of them was a piece of
- artillery ready to give fire on the signal from the engineer.
- Some minutes before midday the first driblets of metal began to
- flow; the reservoirs filled little by little; and, by the time
- that the whole melting was completely accomplished, it was kept
- in abeyance for a few minutes in order to facilitate the
- separation of foreign substances.
-
- Twelve o'clock struck! A gunshot suddenly pealed forth and shot
- its flame into the air. Twelve hundred melting-troughs were
- simultaneously opened and twelve hundred fiery serpents crept
- toward the central well, unrolling their incandescent curves.
- There, down they plunged with a terrific noise into a depth of
- 900 feet. It was an exciting and a magnificent spectacle.
- The ground trembled, while these molten waves, launching into the
- sky their wreaths of smoke, evaporated the moisture of the mould
- and hurled it upward through the vent-holes of the stone lining
- in the form of dense vapor-clouds. These artificial clouds
- unrolled their thick spirals to a height of 1,000 yards into
- the air. A savage, wandering somewhere beyond the limits of the
- horizon, might have believed that some new crater was forming in
- the bosom of Florida, although there was neither any eruption,
- nor typhoon, nor storm, nor struggle of the elements, nor any of
- those terrible phenomena which nature is capable of producing.
- No, it was man alone who had produced these reddish vapors,
- these gigantic flames worthy of a volcano itself, these
- tremendous vibrations resembling the shock of an earthquake,
- these reverberations rivaling those of hurricanes and storms;
- and it was his hand which precipitated into an abyss, dug by
- himself, a whole Niagara of molten metal!
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVI
-
-
- THE COLUMBIAD
-
-
- Had the casting succeeded? They were reduced to mere conjecture.
- There was indeed every reason to expect success, since the mould
- has absorbed the entire mass of the molten metal; still some
- considerable time must elapse before they could arrive at any
- certainty upon the matter.
-
- The patience of the members of the Gun Club was sorely tried during
- this period of time. But they could do nothing. J. T. Maston
- escaped roasting by a miracle. Fifteen days after the casting
- an immense column of smoke was still rising in the open sky and
- the ground burned the soles of the feet within a radius of two
- hundred feet round the summit of Stones Hill. It was impossible
- to approach nearer. All they could do was to wait with what
- patience they might.
-
- "Here we are at the 10th of August," exclaimed J. T. Maston one
- morning, "only four months to the 1st of December! We shall
- never be ready in time!" Barbicane said nothing, but his
- silence covered serious irritation.
-
- However, daily observations revealed a certain change going on
- in the state of the ground. About the 15th of August the vapors
- ejected had sensibly diminished in intensity and thickness.
- Some days afterward the earth exhaled only a slight puff of
- smoke, the last breath of the monster enclosed within its circle
- of stone. Little by little the belt of heat contracted, until
- on the 22nd of August, Barbicane, his colleagues, and the
- engineer were enabled to set foot on the iron sheet which lay
- level upon the summit of Stones Hill.
-
- "At last!" exclaimed the president of the Gun Club, with an
- immense sigh of relief.
-
- The work was resumed the same day. They proceeded at once to
- extract the interior mould, for the purpose of clearing out the
- boring of the piece. Pickaxes and boring irons were set to work
- without intermission. The clayey and sandy soils had acquired
- extreme hardness under the action of the heat; but, by the aid
- of the machines, the rubbish on being dug out was rapidly carted
- away on railway wagons; and such was the ardor of the work, so
- persuasive the arguments of Barbicane's dollars, that by the 3rd
- of September all traces of the mould had entirely disappeared.
-
- Immediately the operation of boring was commenced; and by the
- aid of powerful machines, a few weeks later, the inner surface
- of the immense tube had been rendered perfectly cylindrical, and
- the bore of the piece had acquired a thorough polish.
-
- At length, on the 22d of September, less than a twelvemonth
- after Barbicane's original proposition, the enormous weapon,
- accurately bored, and exactly vertically pointed, was ready
- for work. There was only the moon now to wait for; and they
- were pretty sure that she would not fail in the rendezvous.
-
- The ecstasy of J. T. Maston knew no bounds, and he narrowly
- escaped a frightful fall while staring down the tube. But for
- the strong hand of Colonel Blomsberry, the worthy secretary,
- like a modern Erostratus, would have found his death in the
- depths of the Columbiad.
-
- The cannon was then finished; there was no possible doubt as to
- its perfect completion. So, on the 6th of October, Captain
- Nicholl opened an account between himself and President Barbicane,
- in which he debited himself to the latter in the sum of two
- thousand dollars. One may believe that the captain's wrath was
- increased to its highest point, and must have made him seriously ill.
- However, he had still three bets of three, four, and five
- thousand dollars, respectively; and if he gained two out of these,
- his position would not be very bad. But the money question did
- not enter into his calculations; it was the success of his rival
- in casting a cannon against which iron plates sixty feet thick
- would have been ineffectual, that dealt him a terrible blow.
-
- After the 23rd of September the enclosure of Stones hill was
- thrown open to the public; and it will be easily imagined what
- was the concourse of visitors to this spot! There was an
- incessant flow of people to and from Tampa Town and the place,
- which resembled a procession, or rather, in fact, a pilgrimage.
-
- It was already clear to be seen that, on the day of the
- experiment itself, the aggregate of spectators would be counted
- by millions; for they were already arriving from all parts of
- the earth upon this narrow strip of promontory. Europe was
- emigrating to America.
-
- Up to that time, however, it must be confessed, the curiosity
- of the numerous comers was but scantily gratified. Most had
- counted upon witnessing the spectacle of the casting, and they
- were treated to nothing but smoke. This was sorry food for
- hungry eyes; but Barbicane would admit no one to that operation.
- Then ensued grumbling, discontent, murmurs; they blamed the
- president, taxed him with dictatorial conduct. His proceedings
- were declared "un-American." There was very nearly a riot round
- Stones Hill; but Barbicane remained inflexible. When, however,
- the Columbiad was entirely finished, this state of closed doors
- could no longer be maintained; besides it would have been bad
- taste, and even imprudence, to affront the public feeling.
- Barbicane, therefore, opened the enclosure to all comers; but,
- true to his practical disposition, he determined to coin money
- out of the public curiosity.
-
- It was something, indeed, to be enabled to contemplate this
- immense Columbiad; but to descend into its depths, this seemed
- to the Americans the _ne plus ultra_ of earthly felicity.
- Consequently, there was not one curious spectator who was not
- willing to give himself the treat of visiting the interior of
- this great metallic abyss. Baskets suspended from steam-cranes
- permitted them to satisfy their curiosity. There was a
- perfect mania. Women, children, old men, all made it a point
- of duty to penetrate the mysteries of the colossal gun.
- The fare for the descent was fixed at five dollars per head;
- and despite this high charge, during the two months which
- preceded the experiment, the influx of visitors enabled the
- Gun Club to pocket nearly five hundred thousand dollars!
-
- It is needless to say that the first visitors of the Columbiad
- were the members of the Gun Club. This privilege was justly
- reserved for that illustrious body. The ceremony took place on
- the 25th of September. A basket of honor took down the
- president, J. T. Maston, Major Elphinstone, General Morgan,
- Colonel Blomsberry, and other members of the club, to the number
- of ten in all. How hot it was at the bottom of that long tube
- of metal! They were half suffocated. But what delight!
- What ecstasy! A table had been laid with six covers on the
- massive stone which formed the bottom of the Columbiad, and
- lighted by a jet of electric light resembling that of day itself.
- Numerous exquisite dishes, which seemed to descend from heaven,
- were placed successively before the guests, and the richest wines
- of France flowed in profusion during this splendid repast, served
- nine hundred feet beneath the surface of the earth!
-
- The festival was animated, not to say somewhat noisy. Toasts flew
- backward and forward. They drank to the earth and to her satellite,
- to the Gun Club, the Union, the Moon, Diana, Phoebe, Selene, the
- "peaceful courier of the night!" All the hurrahs, carried upward
- upon the sonorous waves of the immense acoustic tube, arrived with
- the sound of thunder at its mouth; and the multitude ranged round
- Stones Hill heartily united their shouts with those of the ten
- revelers hidden from view at the bottom of the gigantic Columbiad.
-
- J. T. Maston was no longer master of himself. Whether he
- shouted or gesticulated, ate or drank most, would be a difficult
- matter to determine. At all events, he would not have given his
- place up for an empire, "not even if the cannon-- loaded,
- primed, and fired at that very moment--were to blow him in
- pieces into the planetary world."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVII
-
-
- A TELEGRAPHIC DISPATCH
-
-
- The great works undertaken by the Gun Club had now virtually
- come to an end; and two months still remained before the day for
- the discharge of the shot to the moon. To the general impatience
- these two months appeared as long as years! Hitherto the smallest
- details of the operation had been daily chronicled by the journals,
- which the public devoured with eager eyes.
-
- Just at this moment a circumstance, the most unexpected, the
- most extraordinary and incredible, occurred to rouse afresh
- their panting spirits, and to throw every mind into a state of
- the most violent excitement.
-
- One day, the 30th of September, at 3:47 P.M., a telegram,
- transmitted by cable from Valentia (Ireland) to Newfoundland and
- the American Mainland, arrived at the address of President Barbicane.
-
- The president tore open the envelope, read the dispatch, and,
- despite his remarkable powers of self-control, his lips turned
- pale and his eyes grew dim, on reading the twenty words of
- this telegram.
-
- Here is the text of the dispatch, which figures now in the
- archives of the Gun Club:
-
- FRANCE, PARIS,
- 30 September, 4 A.M.
- Barbicane, Tampa Town, Florida, United States.
-
- Substitute for your spherical shell a cylindro-conical projectile.
- I shall go inside. Shall arrive by steamer Atlanta.
- MICHEL ARDAN.
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVIII
-
-
- THE PASSENGER OF THE ATLANTA
-
-
-
- If this astounding news, instead of flying through the electric
- wires, had simply arrived by post in the ordinary sealed envelope,
- Barbicane would not have hesitated a moment. He would have held
- his tongue about it, both as a measure of prudence, and in order
- not to have to reconsider his plans. This telegram might be a
- cover for some jest, especially as it came from a Frenchman.
- What human being would ever have conceived the idea of such
- a journey? and, if such a person really existed, he must be an
- idiot, whom one would shut up in a lunatic ward, rather than
- within the walls of the projectile.
-
- The contents of the dispatch, however, speedily became known;
- for the telegraphic officials possessed but little discretion,
- and Michel Ardan's proposition ran at once throughout the
- several States of the Union. Barbicane, had, therefore, no
- further motives for keeping silence. Consequently, he called
- together such of his colleagues as were at the moment in Tampa
- Town, and without any expression of his own opinions simply read
- to them the laconic text itself. It was received with every
- possible variety of expressions of doubt, incredulity, and
- derision from every one, with the exception of J. T. Maston, who
- exclaimed, "It is a grand idea, however!"
-
- When Barbicane originally proposed to send a shot to the moon
- every one looked upon the enterprise as simple and practicable
- enough-- a mere question of gunnery; but when a person,
- professing to be a reasonable being, offered to take passage
- within the projectile, the whole thing became a farce, or, in
- plainer language a humbug.
-
- One question, however, remained. Did such a being exist?
- This telegram flashed across the depths of the Atlantic, the
- designation of the vessel on board which he was to take his
- passage, the date assigned for his speedy arrival, all combined
- to impart a certain character of reality to the proposal.
- They must get some clearer notion of the matter. Scattered groups
- of inquirers at length condensed themselves into a compact crowd,
- which made straight for the residence of President Barbicane.
- That worthy individual was keeping quiet with the intention of
- watching events as they arose. But he had forgotten to take
- into account the public impatience; and it was with no pleasant
- countenance that he watched the population of Tampa Town
- gathering under his windows. The murmurs and vociferations
- below presently obliged him to appear. He came forward,
- therefore, and on silence being procured, a citizen put
- point-blank to him the following question: "Is the person
- mentioned in the telegram, under the name of Michel Ardan, on
- his way here? Yes or no."
-
- "Gentlemen," replied Barbicane, "I know no more than you do."
-
- "We must know," roared the impatient voices.
-
- "Time will show," calmly replied the president.
-
- "Time has no business to keep a whole country in suspense,"
- replied the orator. "Have you altered the plans of the
- projectile according to the request of the telegram?"
-
- "Not yet, gentlemen; but you are right! we must have better
- information to go by. The telegraph must complete its information."
-
- "To the telegraph!" roared the crowd.
-
- Barbicane descended; and heading the immense assemblage, led the
- way to the telegraph office. A few minutes later a telegram was
- dispatched to the secretary of the underwriters at Liverpool,
- requesting answers to the following queries:
-
- "About the ship Atlanta-- when did she leave Europe? Had she on
- board a Frenchman named Michel Ardan?"
-
- Two hours afterward Barbicane received information too exact to
- leave room for the smallest remaining doubt.
-
- "The steamer Atlanta from Liverpool put to sea on the 2nd of
- October, bound for Tampa Town, having on board a Frenchman borne
- on the list of passengers by the name of Michel Ardan."
-
- That very evening he wrote to the house of Breadwill and Co.,
- requesting them to suspend the casting of the projectile until
- the receipt of further orders. On the 10th of October, at nine
- A.M., the semaphores of the Bahama Canal signaled a thick smoke
- on the horizon. Two hours later a large steamer exchanged
- signals with them. the name of the Atlanta flew at once over
- Tampa Town. At four o'clock the English vessel entered the Bay
- of Espiritu Santo. At five it crossed the passage of
- Hillisborough Bay at full steam. At six she cast anchor at
- Port Tampa. The anchor had scarcely caught the sandy bottom when
- five hundred boats surrounded the Atlanta, and the steamer was
- taken by assault. Barbicane was the first to set foot on deck,
- and in a voice of which he vainly tried to conceal the emotion,
- called "Michel Ardan."
-
- "Here!" replied an individual perched on the poop.
-
- Barbicane, with arms crossed, looked fixedly at the passenger of
- the Atlanta.
-
- He was a man of about forty-two years of age, of large build,
- but slightly round-shouldered. His massive head momentarily
- shook a shock of reddish hair, which resembled a lion's mane.
- His face was short with a broad forehead, and furnished with a
- moustache as bristly as a cat's, and little patches of yellowish
- whiskers upon full cheeks. Round, wildish eyes, slightly
- near-sighted, completed a physiognomy essentially feline.
- His nose was firmly shaped, his mouth particularly sweet in
- expression, high forehead, intelligent and furrowed with
- wrinkles like a newly-plowed field. The body was powerfully
- developed and firmly fixed upon long legs. Muscular arms,
- and a general air of decision gave him the appearance of a hardy,
- jolly, companion. He was dressed in a suit of ample dimensions,
- loose neckerchief, open shirtcollar, disclosing a robust neck;
- his cuffs were invariably unbuttoned, through which appeared
- a pair of red hands.
-
- On the bridge of the steamer, in the midst of the crowd, he
- bustled to and fro, never still for a moment, "dragging his
- anchors," as the sailors say, gesticulating, making free with
- everybody, biting his nails with nervous avidity. He was one of
- those originals which nature sometimes invents in the freak of
- a moment, and of which she then breaks the mould.
-
- Among other peculiarities, this curiosity gave himself out for
- a sublime ignoramus, "like Shakespeare," and professed supreme
- contempt for all scientific men. Those "fellows," as he called
- them, "are only fit to mark the points, while we play the game."
- He was, in fact, a thorough Bohemian, adventurous, but not an
- adventurer; a hare-brained fellow, a kind of Icarus, only
- possessing relays of wings. For the rest, he was ever in
- scrapes, ending invariably by falling on his feet, like those
- little figures which they sell for children's toys. In a few
- words, his motto was "I have my opinions," and the love of the
- impossible constituted his ruling passion.
-
- Such was the passenger of the Atlanta, always excitable, as if
- boiling under the action of some internal fire by the character
- of his physical organization. If ever two individuals offered
- a striking contrast to each other, these were certainly Michel
- Ardan and the Yankee Barbicane; both, moreover, being equally
- enterprising and daring, each in his own way.
-
- The scrutiny which the president of the Gun Club had instituted
- regarding this new rival was quickly interrupted by the shouts
- and hurrahs of the crowd. The cries became at last so
- uproarious, and the popular enthusiasm assumed so personal a
- form, that Michel Ardan, after having shaken hands some
- thousands of times, at the imminent risk of leaving his fingers
- behind him, was fain at last to make a bolt for his cabin.
-
- Barbicane followed him without uttering a word.
-
- "You are Barbicane, I suppose?" said Michel Ardan, in a tone
- of voice in which he would have addressed a friend of twenty
- years' standing.
-
- "Yes," replied the president of the Gun Club.
-
- "All right! how d'ye do, Barbicane? how are you getting on--
- pretty well? that's right."
-
- "So," said Barbicane without further preliminary, "you are quite
- determined to go."
-
- "Quite decided."
-
- "Nothing will stop you?"
-
- "Nothing. Have you modified your projectile according to my telegram."
-
- "I waited for your arrival. But," asked Barbicane again, "have
- you carefully reflected?"
-
- "Reflected? have I any time to spare? I find an opportunity of
- making a tour in the moon, and I mean to profit by it. There is
- the whole gist of the matter."
-
- Barbicane looked hard at this man who spoke so lightly of his
- project with such complete absence of anxiety. "But, at least,"
- said he, "you have some plans, some means of carrying your
- project into execution?"
-
- "Excellent, my dear Barbicane; only permit me to offer one remark:
- My wish is to tell my story once for all, to everybody, and then
- have done with it; then there will be no need for recapitulation.
- So, if you have no objection, assemble your friends, colleagues,
- the whole town, all Florida, all America if you like, and
- to-morrow I shall be ready to explain my plans and answer any
- objections whatever that may be advanced. You may rest assured
- I shall wait without stirring. Will that suit you?"
-
- "All right," replied Barbicane.
-
- So saying, the president left the cabin and informed the crowd of
- the proposal of Michel Ardan. His words were received with clappings
- of hands and shouts of joy. They had removed all difficulties.
- To-morrow every one would contemplate at his ease this European hero.
- However, some of the spectators, more infatuated than the rest,
- would not leave the deck of the Atlanta. They passed the night
- on board. Among others J. T. Maston got his hook fixed in the
- combing of the poop, and it pretty nearly required the capstan to
- get it out again.
-
- "He is a hero! a hero!" he cried, a theme of which he was never
- tired of ringing the changes; "and we are only like weak, silly
- women, compared with this European!"
-
- As to the president, after having suggested to the visitors it
- was time to retire, he re-entered the passenger's cabin, and
- remained there till the bell of the steamer made it midnight.
-
- But then the two rivals in popularity shook hands heartily and
- parted on terms of intimate friendship.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIX
-
-
- A MONSTER MEETING
-
-
- On the following day Barbicane, fearing that indiscreet
- questions might be put to Michel Ardan, was desirous of reducing
- the number of the audience to a few of the initiated, his own
- colleagues for instance. He might as well have tried to
- check the Falls of Niagara! he was compelled, therefore, to
- give up the idea, and let his new friend run the chances of a
- public conference. The place chosen for this monster meeting
- was a vast plain situated in the rear of the town. In a few
- hours, thanks to the help of the shipping in port, an immense
- roofing of canvas was stretched over the parched prairie, and
- protected it from the burning rays of the sun. There three
- hundred thousand people braved for many hours the stifling heat
- while awaiting the arrival of the Frenchman. Of this crowd of
- spectators a first set could both see and hear; a second set saw
- badly and heard nothing at all; and as for the third, it could
- neither see nor hear anything at all. At three o'clock Michel
- Ardan made his appearance, accompanied by the principal members
- of the Gun Club. He was supported on his right by President
- Barbicane, and on his left by J. T. Maston, more radiant than
- the midday sun, and nearly as ruddy. Ardan mounted a platform,
- from the top of which his view extended over a sea of black hats.
-
- He exhibited not the slightest embarrassment; he was just as
- gay, familiar, and pleasant as if he were at home. To the
- hurrahs which greeted him he replied by a graceful bow; then,
- waving his hands to request silence, he spoke in perfectly
- correct English as follows:
-
- "Gentlemen, despite the very hot weather I request your patience
- for a short time while I offer some explanations regarding the
- projects which seem to have so interested you. I am neither an
- orator nor a man of science, and I had no idea of addressing you
- in public; but my friend Barbicane has told me that you would
- like to hear me, and I am quite at your service. Listen to me,
- therefore, with your six hundred thousand ears, and please
- excuse the faults of the speaker. Now pray do not forget that
- you see before you a perfect ignoramus whose ignorance goes so
- far that he cannot even understand the difficulties! It seemed
- to him that it was a matter quite simple, natural, and easy
- to take one's place in a projectile and start for the moon!
- That journey must be undertaken sooner or later; and, as for the
- mode of locomotion adopted, it follows simply the law of progress.
- Man began by walking on all-fours; then, one fine day, on two
- feet; then in a carriage; then in a stage-coach; and lastly
- by railway. Well, the projectile is the vehicle of the future,
- and the planets themselves are nothing else! Now some of you,
- gentlemen, may imagine that the velocity we propose to impart to
- it is extravagant. It is nothing of the kind. All the stars
- exceed it in rapidity, and the earth herself is at this moment
- carrying us round the sun at three times as rapid a rate, and
- yet she is a mere lounger on the way compared with many others
- of the planets! And her velocity is constantly decreasing.
- Is it not evident, then, I ask you, that there will some day appear
- velocities far greater than these, of which light or electricity
- will probably be the mechanical agent?
-
- "Yes, gentlemen," continued the orator, "in spite of the
- opinions of certain narrow-minded people, who would shut up the
- human race upon this globe, as within some magic circle which it
- must never outstep, we shall one day travel to the moon, the
- planets, and the stars, with the same facility, rapidity, and
- certainty as we now make the voyage from Liverpool to New York!
- Distance is but a relative expression, and must end by being
- reduced to zero."
-
- The assembly, strongly predisposed as they were in favor of the
- French hero, were slightly staggered at this bold theory.
- Michel Ardan perceived the fact.
-
- "Gentlemen," he continued with a pleasant smile, "you do not
- seem quite convinced. Very good! Let us reason the matter out.
- Do you know how long it would take for an express train to reach
- the moon? Three hundred days; no more! And what is that?
- The distance is no more than nine times the circumference of
- the earth; and there are no sailors or travelers, of even
- moderate activity, who have not made longer journeys than that
- in their lifetime. And now consider that I shall be only ninety-
- seven hours on my journey. Ah! I see you are reckoning that the
- moon is a long way off from the earth, and that one must think
- twice before making the experiment. What would you say, then,
- if we were talking of going to Neptune, which revolves at a
- distance of more than two thousand seven hundred and twenty
- millions of miles from the sun! And yet what is that compared
- with the distance of the fixed stars, some of which, such as Arcturus,
- are billions of miles distant from us? And then you talk of the
- distance which separates the planets from the sun! And there
- are people who affirm that such a thing as distance exists.
- Absurdity, folly, idiotic nonsense! Would you know what I think
- of our own solar universe? Shall I tell you my theory? It is
- very simple! In my opinion the solar system is a solid
- homogeneous body; the planets which compose it are in actual
- contact with each other; and whatever space exists between them
- is nothing more than the space which separates the molecules of
- the densest metal, such as silver, iron, or platinum! I have
- the right, therefore, to affirm, and I repeat, with the
- conviction which must penetrate all your minds, `Distance is
- but an empty name; distance does not really exist!'"
-
- "Hurrah!" cried one voice (need it be said it was that of
- J. T. Maston). "Distance does not exist!" And overcome by the
- energy of his movements, he nearly fell from the platform to
- the ground. He just escaped a severe fall, which would have
- proved to him that distance was by no means an empty name.
-
- "Gentlemen," resumed the orator, "I repeat that the distance
- between the earth and her satellite is a mere trifle, and
- undeserving of serious consideration. I am convinced that
- before twenty years are over one-half of our earth will have
- paid a visit to the moon. Now, my worthy friends, if you have
- any question to put to me, you will, I fear, sadly embarrass a
- poor man like myself; still I will do my best to answer you."
-
- Up to this point the president of the Gun Club had been
- satisfied with the turn which the discussion had assumed.
- It became now, however, desirable to divert Ardan from
- questions of a practical nature, with which he was doubtless
- far less conversant. Barbicane, therefore, hastened to get in
- a word, and began by asking his new friend whether he thought
- that the moon and the planets were inhabited.
-
- "You put before me a great problem, my worthy president,"
- replied the orator, smiling. "Still, men of great intelligence,
- such as Plutarch, Swedenborg, Bernardin de St. Pierre, and
- others have, if I mistake not, pronounced in the affirmative.
- Looking at the question from the natural philosopher's point of
- view, I should say that nothing useless existed in the world;
- and, replying to your question by another, I should venture to
- assert, that if these worlds are habitable, they either are,
- have been, or will be inhabited."
-
- "No one could answer more logically or fairly," replied the
- president. "The question then reverts to this: Are these
- worlds habitable? For my own part I believe they are."
-
- "For myself, I feel certain of it," said Michel Ardan.
-
- "Nevertheless," retorted one of the audience, "there are many
- arguments against the habitability of the worlds. The conditions
- of life must evidently be greatly modified upon the majority
- of them. To mention only the planets, we should be either
- broiled alive in some, or frozen to death in others, according
- as they are more or less removed from the sun."
-
- "I regret," replied Michel Ardan, "that I have not the honor of
- personally knowing my contradictor, for I would have attempted
- to answer him. His objection has its merits, I admit; but I
- think we may successfully combat it, as well as all others which
- affect the habitability of other worlds. If I were a natural
- philosopher, I would tell him that if less of caloric were set
- in motion upon the planets which are nearest to the sun, and
- more, on the contrary, upon those which are farthest removed
- from it, this simple fact would alone suffice to equalize the
- heat, and to render the temperature of those worlds supportable
- by beings organized like ourselves. If I were a naturalist,
- I would tell him that, according to some illustrious men of
- science, nature has furnished us with instances upon the earth
- of animals existing under very varying conditions of life;
- that fish respire in a medium fatal to other animals; that
- amphibious creatures possess a double existence very difficult
- of explanation; that certain denizens of the seas maintain life
- at enormous depths, and there support a pressure equal to that
- of fifty or sixty atmospheres without being crushed; that
- several aquatic insects, insensible to temperature, are met with
- equally among boiling springs and in the frozen plains of the
- Polar Sea; in fine, that we cannot help recognizing in nature a
- diversity of means of operation oftentimes incomprehensible, but
- not the less real. If I were a chemist, I would tell him that
- the aerolites, bodies evidently formed exteriorly of our
- terrestrial globe, have, upon analysis, revealed indisputable
- traces of carbon, a substance which owes its origin solely to
- organized beings, and which, according to the experiments of
- Reichenbach, must necessarily itself have been endued with
- animation. And lastly, were I a theologian, I would tell him
- that the scheme of the Divine Redemption, according to St. Paul,
- seems to be applicable, not merely to the earth, but to all the
- celestial worlds. But, unfortunately, I am neither theologian,
- nor chemist, nor naturalist, nor philosopher; therefore, in my
- absolute ignorance of the great laws which govern the universe,
- I confine myself to saying in reply, `I do not know whether the
- worlds are inhabited or not: and since I do not know, I am going
- to see!'"
-
- Whether Michel Ardan's antagonist hazarded any further arguments
- or not it is impossible to say, for the uproarious shouts of the
- crowd would not allow any expression of opinion to gain a hearing.
- On silence being restored, the triumphant orator contented himself
- with adding the following remarks:
-
- "Gentlemen, you will observe that I have but slightly touched
- upon this great question. There is another altogether different
- line of argument in favor of the habitability of the stars,
- which I omit for the present. I only desire to call attention
- to one point. To those who maintain that the planets are _not_
- inhabited one may reply: You might be perfectly in the right,
- if you could only show that the earth is the best possible
- world, in spite of what Voltaire has said. She has but _one_
- satellite, while Jupiter, Uranus, Saturn, Neptune have each
- several, an advantage by no means to be despised. But that
- which renders our own globe so uncomfortable is the inclination
- of its axis to the plane of its orbit. Hence the inequality of
- days and nights; hence the disagreeable diversity of the seasons.
- On the surface of our unhappy spheroid we are always either too
- hot or too cold; we are frozen in winter, broiled in summer;
- it is the planet of rheumatism, coughs, bronchitis; while on the
- surface of Jupiter, for example, where the axis is but slightly
- inclined, the inhabitants may enjoy uniform temperatures.
- It possesses zones of perpetual springs, summers, autumns, and
- winters; every Jovian may choose for himself what climate he
- likes, and there spend the whole of his life in security from
- all variations of temperature. You will, I am sure, readily
- admit this superiority of Jupiter over our own planet, to say
- nothing of his years, which each equal twelve of ours!
- Under such auspices and such marvelous conditions of existence,
- it appears to me that the inhabitants of so fortunate a world
- must be in every respect superior to ourselves. All we require,
- in order to attain such perfection, is the mere trifle of having
- an axis of rotation less inclined to the plane of its orbit!"
-
- "Hurrah!" roared an energetic voice, "let us unite our efforts,
- invent the necessary machines, and rectify the earth's axis!"
-
- A thunder of applause followed this proposal, the author of
- which was, of course, no other than J. T. Maston. And, in all
- probability, if the truth must be told, if the Yankees could
- only have found a point of application for it, they would have
- constructed a lever capable of raising the earth and rectifying
- its axis. It was just this deficiency which baffled these
- daring mechanicians.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XX
-
-
- ATTACK AND RIPOSTE
-
-
- As soon as the excitement had subsided, the following words were
- heard uttered in a strong and determined voice:
-
- "Now that the speaker has favored us with so much imagination,
- would he be so good as to return to his subject, and give us a
- little practical view of the question?"
-
- All eyes were directed toward the person who spoke. He was a
- little dried-up man, of an active figure, with an American
- "goatee" beard. Profiting by the different movements in the crowd,
- he had managed by degrees to gain the front row of spectators.
- There, with arms crossed and stern gaze, he watched the hero of
- the meeting. After having put his question he remained silent,
- and appeared to take no notice of the thousands of looks directed
- toward himself, nor of the murmur of disapprobation excited by
- his words. Meeting at first with no reply, he repeated his
- question with marked emphasis, adding, "We are here to talk about
- the _moon_ and not about the _earth_."
-
- "You are right, sir," replied Michel Ardan; "the discussion has
- become irregular. We will return to the moon."
-
- "Sir," said the unknown, "you pretend that our satellite is inhabited.
- Very good, but if Selenites do exist, that race of beings assuredly
- must live without breathing, for-- I warn you for your own sake--
- there is not the smallest particle of air on the surface of the moon."
-
- At this remark Ardan pushed up his shock of red hair; he saw
- that he was on the point of being involved in a struggle with
- this person upon the very gist of the whole question. He looked
- sternly at him in his turn and said:
-
- "Oh! so there is no air in the moon? And pray, if you are so
- good, who ventures to affirm that?
-
- "The men of science."
-
- "Really?"
-
- "Really."
-
- "Sir," replied Michel, "pleasantry apart, I have a profound
- respect for men of science who do possess science, but a
- profound contempt for men of science who do not."
-
- "Do you know any who belong to the latter category?"
-
- "Decidedly. In France there are some who maintain that,
- mathematically, a bird cannot possibly fly; and others who
- demonstrate theoretically that fishes were never made to
- live in water."
-
- "I have nothing to do with persons of that description, and I
- can quote, in support of my statement, names which you cannot
- refuse deference to."
-
- "Then, sir, you will sadly embarrass a poor ignorant, who,
- besides, asks nothing better than to learn."
-
- "Why, then, do you introduce scientific questions if you have
- never studied them?" asked the unknown somewhat coarsely.
-
- "For the reason that `he is always brave who never suspects danger.'
- I know nothing, it is true; but it is precisely my very weakness
- which constitutes my strength."
-
- "Your weakness amounts to folly," retorted the unknown in a passion.
-
- "All the better," replied our Frenchman, "if it carries me up to
- the moon."
-
- Barbicane and his colleagues devoured with their eyes the intruder
- who had so boldly placed himself in antagonism to their enterprise.
- Nobody knew him, and the president, uneasy as to the result of so
- free a discussion, watched his new friend with some anxiety.
- The meeting began to be somewhat fidgety also, for the contest
- directed their attention to the dangers, if not the actual
- impossibilities, of the proposed expedition.
-
- "Sir," replied Ardan's antagonist, "there are many and
- incontrovertible reasons which prove the absence of an
- atmosphere in the moon. I might say that, _a priori_, if one
- ever did exist, it must have been absorbed by the earth; but I
- prefer to bring forward indisputable facts."
-
- "Bring them forward then, sir, as many as you please."
-
- "You know," said the stranger, "that when any luminous rays
- cross a medium such as the air, they are deflected out of the
- straight line; in other words, they undergo refraction. Well!
- When stars are occulted by the moon, their rays, on grazing the
- edge of her disc, exhibit not the least deviation, nor offer the
- slightest indication of refraction. It follows, therefore, that
- the moon cannot be surrounded by an atmosphere.
-
- "In point of fact," replied Ardan, "this is your chief, if not
- your _only_ argument; and a really scientific man might be
- puzzled to answer it. For myself, I will simply say that it is
- defective, because it assumes that the angular diameter of the
- moon has been completely determined, which is not the case.
- But let us proceed. Tell me, my dear sir, do you admit the
- existence of volcanoes on the moon's surface?"
-
- "Extinct, yes! In activity, no!"
-
- "These volcanoes, however, were at one time in a state of activity?"
-
- "True, but, as they furnish themselves the oxygen necessary for
- combustion, the mere fact of their eruption does not prove the
- presence of an atmosphere."
-
- "Proceed again, then; and let us set aside this class of
- arguments in order to come to direct observations. In 1715 the
- astronomers Louville and Halley, watching the eclipse of the
- 3rd of May, remarked some very extraordinary scintillations.
- These jets of light, rapid in nature, and of frequent recurrence,
- they attributed to thunderstorms generated in the lunar atmosphere."
-
- "In 1715," replied the unknown, "the astronomers Louville and
- Halley mistook for lunar phenomena some which were purely
- terrestrial, such as meteoric or other bodies which are
- generated in our own atmosphere. This was the scientific
- explanation at the time of the facts; and that is my answer now."
-
- "On again, then," replied Ardan; "Herschel, in 1787, observed a
- great number of luminous points on the moon's surface, did he not?"
-
- "Yes! but without offering any solution of them. Herschel himself
- never inferred from them the necessity of a lunar atmosphere.
- And I may add that Baeer and Maedler, the two great authorities
- upon the moon, are quite agreed as to the entire absence of air
- on its surface."
-
- A movement was here manifest among the assemblage, who appeared
- to be growing excited by the arguments of this singular personage.
-
- "Let us proceed," replied Ardan, with perfect coolness, "and
- come to one important fact. A skillful French astronomer, M.
- Laussedat, in watching the eclipse of July 18, 1860, probed that
- the horns of the lunar crescent were rounded and truncated.
- Now, this appearance could only have been produced by a
- deviation of the solar rays in traversing the atmosphere of
- the moon. There is no other possible explanation of the facts."
-
- "But is this established as a fact?"
-
- "Absolutely certain!"
-
- A counter-movement here took place in favor of the hero of the
- meeting, whose opponent was now reduced to silence. Ardan resumed
- the conversation; and without exhibiting any exultation at the
- advantage he had gained, simply said:
-
- "You see, then, my dear sir, we must not pronounce with absolute
- positiveness against the existence of an atmosphere in the moon.
- That atmosphere is, probably, of extreme rarity; nevertheless at
- the present day science generally admits that it exists."
-
- "Not in the mountains, at all events," returned the unknown,
- unwilling to give in.
-
- "No! but at the bottom of the valleys, and not exceeding a few
- hundred feet in height."
-
- "In any case you will do well to take every precaution, for the
- air will be terribly rarified."
-
- "My good sir, there will always be enough for a solitary
- individual; besides, once arrived up there, I shall do my best
- to economize, and not to breathe except on grand occasions!"
-
- A tremendous roar of laughter rang in the ears of the mysterious
- interlocutor, who glared fiercely round upon the assembly.
-
- "Then," continued Ardan, with a careless air, "since we are in
- accord regarding the presence of a certain atmosphere, we are
- forced to admit the presence of a certain quantity of water.
- This is a happy consequence for me. Moreover, my amiable
- contradictor, permit me to submit to you one further observation.
- We only know _one_ side of the moon's disc; and if there is but
- little air on the face presented to us, it is possible that there
- is plenty on the one turned away from us."
-
- "And for what reason?"
-
- "Because the moon, under the action of the earth's attraction,
- has assumed the form of an egg, which we look at from the
- smaller end. Hence it follows, by Hausen's calculations, that
- its center of gravity is situated in the other hemisphere.
- Hence it results that the great mass of air and water must have
- been drawn away to the other face of our satellite during the
- first days of its creation."
-
- "Pure fancies!" cried the unknown.
-
- "No! Pure theories! which are based upon the laws of mechanics,
- and it seems difficult to me to refute them. I appeal then to
- this meeting, and I put it to them whether life, such as exists
- upon the earth, is possible on the surface of the moon?"
-
- Three hundred thousand auditors at once applauded the proposition.
- Ardan's opponent tried to get in another word, but he could not
- obtain a hearing. Cries and menaces fell upon him like hail.
-
- "Enough! enough!" cried some.
-
- "Drive the intruder off!" shouted others.
-
- "Turn him out!" roared the exasperated crowd.
-
- But he, holding firmly on to the platform, did not budge an
- inch, and let the storm pass on, which would soon have assumed
- formidable proportions, if Michel Ardan had not quieted it by
- a gesture. He was too chivalrous to abandon his opponent in an
- apparent extremity.
-
- "You wished to say a few more words?" he asked, in a pleasant voice.
-
- "Yes, a thousand; or rather, no, only one! If you persevere in
- your enterprise, you must be a----"
-
- "Very rash person! How can you treat me as such? me, who have
- demanded a cylindro-conical projectile, in order to prevent
- turning round and round on my way like a squirrel?"
-
- "But, unhappy man, the dreadful recoil will smash you to pieces
- at your starting."
-
- "My dear contradictor, you have just put your finger upon the
- true and only difficulty; nevertheless, I have too good an
- opinion of the industrial genius of the Americans not to believe
- that they will succeed in overcoming it."
-
- "But the heat developed by the rapidity of the projectile in
- crossing the strata of air?"
-
- "Oh! the walls are thick, and I shall soon have crossed
- the atmosphere."
-
- "But victuals and water?"
-
- "I have calculated for a twelvemonth's supply, and I shall be
- only four days on the journey."
-
- "But for air to breathe on the road?"
-
- "I shall make it by a chemical process."
-
- "But your fall on the moon, supposing you ever reach it?"
-
- "It will be six times less dangerous than a sudden fall upon the
- earth, because the weight will be only one-sixth as great on the
- surface of the moon."
-
- "Still it will be enough to smash you like glass!"
-
- "What is to prevent my retarding the shock by means of rockets
- conveniently placed, and lighted at the right moment?"
-
- "But after all, supposing all difficulties surmounted, all
- obstacles removed, supposing everything combined to favor you,
- and granting that you may arrive safe and sound in the moon, how
- will you come back?"
-
- "I am not coming back!"
-
- At this reply, almost sublime in its very simplicity, the
- assembly became silent. But its silence was more eloquent than
- could have been its cries of enthusiasm. The unknown profited
- by the opportunity and once more protested:
-
- "You will inevitably kill yourself!" he cried; "and your death
- will be that of a madman, useless even to science!"
-
- "Go on, my dear unknown, for truly your prophecies are most agreeable!"
-
- "It really is too much!" cried Michel Ardan's adversary. "I do
- not know why I should continue so frivolous a discussion!
- Please yourself about this insane expedition! We need not
- trouble ourselves about you!"
-
- "Pray don't stand upon ceremony!"
-
- "No! another person is responsible for your act."
-
- "Who, may I ask?" demanded Michel Ardan in an imperious tone.
-
- "The ignoramus who organized this equally absurd and
- impossible experiment!"
-
- The attack was direct. Barbicane, ever since the interference
- of the unknown, had been making fearful efforts of self-control;
- now, however, seeing himself directly attacked, he could
- restrain himself no longer. He rose suddenly, and was rushing
- upon the enemy who thus braved him to the face, when all at once
- he found himself separated from him.
-
- The platform was lifted by a hundred strong arms, and the president
- of the Gun Club shared with Michel Ardan triumphal honors.
- The shield was heavy, but the bearers came in continuous relays,
- disputing, struggling, even fighting among themselves in their
- eagerness to lend their shoulders to this demonstration.
-
- However, the unknown had not profited by the tumult to quit
- his post. Besides he could not have done it in the midst of that
- compact crowd. There he held on in the front row with crossed
- arms, glaring at President Barbicane.
-
- The shouts of the immense crowd continued at their highest pitch
- throughout this triumphant march. Michel Ardan took it all with
- evident pleasure. His face gleamed with delight. Several times
- the platform seemed seized with pitching and rolling like a
- weatherbeaten ship. But the two heros of the meeting had good
- sea-legs. They never stumbled; and their vessel arrived without
- dues at the port of Tampa Town.
-
- Michel Ardan managed fortunately to escape from the last
- embraces of his vigorous admirers. He made for the Hotel
- Franklin, quickly gained his chamber, and slid under the
- bedclothes, while an army of a hundred thousand men kept watch
- under his windows.
-
- During this time a scene, short, grave, and decisive, took place
- between the mysterious personage and the president of the Gun Club.
-
- Barbicane, free at last, had gone straight at his adversary.
-
- "Come!" he said shortly.
-
- The other followed him on the quay; and the two presently found
- themselves alone at the entrance of an open wharf on Jones' Fall.
-
- The two enemies, still mutually unknown, gazed at each other.
-
- "Who are you?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Captain Nicholl!"
-
- "So I suspected. Hitherto chance has never thrown you in my way."
-
- "I am come for that purpose."
-
- "You have insulted me."
-
- "Publicly!"
-
- "And you will answer to me for this insult?"
-
- "At this very moment."
-
- "No! I desire that all that passes between us shall be secret.
- Their is a wood situated three miles from Tampa, the wood
- of Skersnaw. Do you know it?"
-
- "I know it."
-
- "Will you be so good as to enter it to-morrow morning at five
- o'clock, on one side?"
-
- "Yes! if you will enter at the other side at the same hour."
-
- "And you will not forget your rifle?" said Barbicane.
-
- "No more than you will forget yours?" replied Nicholl.
-
- These words having been coldly spoken, the president of the Gun
- Club and the captain parted. Barbicane returned to his lodging;
- but instead of snatching a few hours of repose, he passed the
- night in endeavoring to discover a means of evading the recoil
- of the projectile, and resolving the difficult problem proposed
- by Michel Ardan during the discussion at the meeting.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXI
-
-
- HOW A FRENCHMAN MANAGES AN AFFAIR
-
-
- While the contract of this duel was being discussed by the
- president and the captain-- this dreadful, savage duel, in which
- each adversary became a man-hunter-- Michel Ardan was resting
- from the fatigues of his triumph. Resting is hardly an
- appropriate expression, for American beds rival marble or
- granite tables for hardness.
-
- Ardan was sleeping, then, badly enough, tossing about between
- the cloths which served him for sheets, and he was dreaming of
- making a more comfortable couch in his projectile when a
- frightful noise disturbed his dreams. Thundering blows shook
- his door. They seemed to be caused by some iron instrument.
- A great deal of loud talking was distinguishable in this racket,
- which was rather too early in the morning. "Open the door,"
- some one shrieked, "for heaven's sake!" Ardan saw no reason
- for complying with a demand so roughly expressed. However, he
- got up and opened the door just as it was giving way before the
- blows of this determined visitor. The secretary of the Gun Club
- burst into the room. A bomb could not have made more noise or
- have entered the room with less ceremony.
-
- "Last night," cried J. T. Maston, _ex abrupto_, "our president
- was publicly insulted during the meeting. He provoked his
- adversary, who is none other than Captain Nicholl! They are
- fighting this morning in the wood of Skersnaw. I heard all the
- particulars from the mouth of Barbicane himself. If he is
- killed, then our scheme is at an end. We must prevent his duel;
- and one man alone has enough influence over Barbicane to stop
- him, and that man is Michel Ardan."
-
- While J. T. Maston was speaking, Michel Ardan, without
- interrupting him, had hastily put on his clothes; and, in less
- than two minutes, the two friends were making for the suburbs of
- Tampa Town with rapid strides.
-
- It was during this walk that Maston told Ardan the state of the
- case. He told him the real causes of the hostility between
- Barbicane and Nicholl; how it was of old date, and why, thanks
- to unknown friends, the president and the captain had, as yet,
- never met face to face. He added that it arose simply from
- a rivalry between iron plates and shot, and, finally, that the
- scene at the meeting was only the long-wished-for opportunity
- for Nicholl to pay off an old grudge.
-
- Nothing is more dreadful than private duels in America. The two
- adversaries attack each other like wild beasts. Then it is that
- they might well covet those wonderful properties of the Indians
- of the prairies-- their quick intelligence, their ingenious
- cunning, their scent of the enemy. A single mistake, a moment's
- hesitation, a single false step may cause death. On these
- occasions Yankees are often accompanied by their dogs, and keep
- up the struggle for hours.
-
- "What demons you are!" cried Michel Ardan, when his companion
- had depicted this scene to him with much energy.
-
- "Yes, we are," replied J. T. modestly; "but we had better make haste."
-
- Though Michel Ardan and he had crossed the plains still wet with
- dew, and had taken the shortest route over creeks and ricefields,
- they could not reach Skersnaw in under five hours and a half.
-
- Barbicane must have passed the border half an hour ago.
-
- There was an old bushman working there, occupied in selling
- fagots from trees that had been leveled by his axe.
-
- Maston ran toward him, saying, "Have you seen a man go into the
- wood, armed with a rifle? Barbicane, the president, my best friend?"
-
- The worthy secretary of the Gun Club thought that his president
- must be known by all the world. But the bushman did not seem to
- understand him.
-
- "A hunter?" said Ardan.
-
- "A hunter? Yes," replied the bushman.
-
- "Long ago?"
-
- "About an hour."
-
- "Too late!" cried Maston.
-
- "Have you heard any gunshots?" asked Ardan.
-
- "No!"
-
- "Not one?"
-
- "Not one! that hunter did not look as if he knew how to hunt!"
-
- "What is to be done?" said Maston.
-
- "We must go into the wood, at the risk of getting a ball which
- is not intended for us."
-
- "Ah!" cried Maston, in a tone which could not be mistaken, "I would
- rather have twenty balls in my own head than one in Barbicane's."
-
- "Forward, then," said Ardan, pressing his companion's hand.
-
- A few moments later the two friends had disappeared in the copse.
- It was a dense thicket, in which rose huge cypresses, sycamores,
- tulip-trees, olives, tamarinds, oaks, and magnolias.
- These different trees had interwoven their branches into an
- inextricable maze, through which the eye could not penetrate.
- Michel Ardan and Maston walked side by side in silence through
- the tall grass, cutting themselves a path through the strong
- creepers, casting curious glances on the bushes, and momentarily
- expecting to hear the sound of rifles. As for the traces which
- Barbicane ought to have left of his passage through the wood,
- there was not a vestige of them visible: so they followed the
- barely perceptible paths along which Indians had tracked some
- enemy, and which the dense foliage darkly overshadowed.
-
- After an hour spent in vain pursuit the two stopped in
- intensified anxiety.
-
- "It must be all over," said Maston, discouraged. "A man like
- Barbicane would not dodge with his enemy, or ensnare him, would
- not even maneuver! He is too open, too brave. He has gone
- straight ahead, right into the danger, and doubtless far enough
- from the bushman for the wind to prevent his hearing the report
- of the rifles."
-
- "But surely," replied Michel Ardan, "since we entered the wood
- we should have heard!"
-
- "And what if we came too late?" cried Maston in tones of despair.
-
- For once Ardan had no reply to make, he and Maston resuming
- their walk in silence. From time to time, indeed, they raised
- great shouts, calling alternately Barbicane and Nicholl, neither
- of whom, however, answered their cries. Only the birds,
- awakened by the sound, flew past them and disappeared among the
- branches, while some frightened deer fled precipitately before them.
-
- For another hour their search was continued. The greater part
- of the wood had been explored. There was nothing to reveal the
- presence of the combatants. The information of the bushman was
- after all doubtful, and Ardan was about to propose their
- abandoning this useless pursuit, when all at once Maston stopped.
-
- "Hush!" said he, "there is some one down there!"
-
- "Some one?" repeated Michel Ardan.
-
- "Yes; a man! He seems motionless. His rifle is not in his hands.
- What can he be doing?"
-
- "But can you recognize him?" asked Ardan, whose short sight was
- of little use to him in such circumstances.
-
- "Yes! yes! He is turning toward us," answered Maston.
-
- "And it is?"
-
- "Captain Nicholl!"
-
- "Nicholl?" cried Michel Ardan, feeling a terrible pang of grief.
-
- "Nicholl unarmed! He has, then, no longer any fear of his adversary!"
-
- "Let us go to him," said Michel Ardan, "and find out the truth."
-
- But he and his companion had barely taken fifty steps, when they
- paused to examine the captain more attentively. They expected
- to find a bloodthirsty man, happy in his revenge.
-
- On seeing him, they remained stupefied.
-
- A net, composed of very fine meshes, hung between two enormous
- tulip-trees, and in the midst of this snare, with its wings
- entangled, was a poor little bird, uttering pitiful cries, while
- it vainly struggled to escape. The bird-catcher who had laid
- this snare was no human being, but a venomous spider, peculiar
- to that country, as large as a pigeon's egg, and armed with
- enormous claws. The hideous creature, instead of rushing on its
- prey, had beaten a sudden retreat and taken refuge in the upper
- branches of the tulip-tree, for a formidable enemy menaced
- its stronghold.
-
- Here, then, was Nicholl, his gun on the ground, forgetful
- of danger, trying if possible to save the victim from its
- cobweb prison. At last it was accomplished, and the little
- bird flew joyfully away and disappeared.
-
- Nicholl lovingly watched its flight, when he heard these words
- pronounced by a voice full of emotion:
-
- "You are indeed a brave man."
-
- He turned. Michel Ardan was before him, repeating in a
- different tone:
-
- "And a kindhearted one!"
-
- "Michel Ardan!" cried the captain. "Why are you here?"
-
- "To press your hand, Nicholl, and to prevent you from either
- killing Barbicane or being killed by him."
-
- "Barbicane!" returned the captain. "I have been looking for him
- for the last two hours in vain. Where is he hiding?"
-
- "Nicholl!" said Michel Ardan, "this is not courteous! we ought
- always to treat an adversary with respect; rest assureed if
- Barbicane is still alive we shall find him all the more easily;
- because if he has not, like you, been amusing himself with
- freeing oppressed birds, he must be looking for _you_. When we
- have found him, Michel Ardan tells you this, there will be no
- duel between you."
-
- "Between President Barbicane and myself," gravely replied
- Nicholl, "there is a rivalry which the death of one of us----"
-
- "Pooh, pooh!" said Ardan. "Brave fellows like you indeed! you
- shall not fight!"
-
- "I will fight, sir!"
-
- "No!"
-
- "Captain," said J. T. Maston, with much feeling, "I am a friend
- of the president's, his _alter ego_, his second self; if you
- really must kill some one, _shoot me!_ it will do just as well!"
-
- "Sir," Nicholl replied, seizing his rifle convulsively, "these
- jokes----"
-
- "Our friend Maston is not joking," replied Ardan. "I fully
- understand his idea of being killed himself in order to save
- his friend. But neither he nor Barbicane will fall before the balls
- of Captain Nicholl. Indeed I have so attractive a proposal to
- make to the two rivals, that both will be eager to accept it."
-
- "What is it?" asked Nicholl with manifest incredulity.
-
- "Patience!" exclaimed Ardan. "I can only reveal it in the
- presence of Barbicane."
-
- "Let us go in search of him then!" cried the captain.
-
- The three men started off at once; the captain having discharged
- his rifle threw it over his shoulder, and advanced in silence.
- Another half hour passed, and the pursuit was still fruitless.
- Maston was oppressed by sinister forebodings. He looked fiercely
- at Nicholl, asking himself whether the captain's vengeance had
- already been satisfied, and the unfortunate Barbicane, shot, was
- perhaps lying dead on some bloody track. The same thought seemed
- to occur to Ardan; and both were casting inquiring glances on
- Nicholl, when suddenly Maston paused.
-
- The motionless figure of a man leaning against a gigantic
- catalpa twenty feet off appeared, half-veiled by the foliage.
-
- "It is he!" said Maston.
-
- Barbicane never moved. Ardan looked at the captain, but he did
- not wince. Ardan went forward crying:
-
- "Barbicane! Barbicane!"
-
- No answer! Ardan rushed toward his friend; but in the act of
- seizing his arms, he stopped short and uttered a cry of surprise.
-
- Barbicane, pencil in hand, was tracing geometrical figures in a
- memorandum book, while his unloaded rifle lay beside him on the ground.
-
- Absorbed in his studies, Barbicane, in his turn forgetful of the
- duel, had seen and heard nothing.
-
- When Ardan took his hand, he looked up and stared at his visitor
- in astonishment.
-
- "Ah, it is you!" he cried at last. "I have found it, my friend,
- I have found it!"
-
- "What?"
-
- "My plan!"
-
- "What plan?"
-
- "The plan for countering the effect of the shock at the
- departure of the projectile!"
-
- "Indeed?" said Michel Ardan, looking at the captain out of the
- corner of his eye.
-
- "Yes! water! simply water, which will act as a spring-- ah!
- Maston," cried Barbicane, "you here also?"
-
- "Himself," replied Ardan; "and permit me to introduce to you at
- the same time the worthy Captain Nicholl!"
-
- "Nicholl!" cried Barbicane, who jumped up at once. "Pardon me,
- captain, I had quite forgotten-- I am ready!"
-
- Michel Ardan interfered, without giving the two enemies time to
- say anything more.
-
- "Thank heaven!" said he. "It is a happy thing that brave men
- like you two did not meet sooner! we should now have been
- mourning for one or other of you. But, thanks to Providence,
- which has interfered, there is now no further cause for alarm.
- When one forgets one's anger in mechanics or in cobwebs, it is
- a sign that the anger is not dangerous."
-
- Michel Ardan then told the president how the captain had been
- found occupied.
-
- "I put it to you now," said he in conclusion, "are two such good
- fellows as you are made on purpose to smash each other's skulls
- with shot?"
-
- There was in "the situation" somewhat of the ridiculous,
- something quite unexpected; Michel Ardan saw this, and
- determined to effect a reconciliation.
-
- "My good friends," said he, with his most bewitching smile,
- "this is nothing but a misunderstanding. Nothing more! well! to
- prove that it is all over between you, accept frankly the
- proposal I am going to make to you."
-
- "Make it," said Nicholl.
-
- "Our friend Barbicane believes that his projectile will go
- straight to the moon?"
-
- "Yes, certainly," replied the president.
-
- "And our friend Nicholl is persuaded it will fall back upon the earth?"
-
- "I am certain of it," cried the captain.
-
- "Good!" said Ardan. "I cannot pretend to make you agree; but I
- suggest this: Go with me, and so see whether we are stopped on
- our journey."
-
- "What?" exclaimed J. T. Maston, stupefied.
-
- The two rivals, on this sudden proposal, looked steadily at
- each other. Barbicane waited for the captain's answer.
- Nicholl watched for the decision of the president.
-
- "Well?" said Michel. "There is now no fear of the shock!"
-
- "Done!" cried Barbicane.
-
- But quickly as he pronounced the word, he was not before Nicholl.
-
- "Hurrah! bravo! hip! hip! hurrah!" cried Michel, giving a hand
- to each of the late adversaries. "Now that it is all settled,
- my friends, allow me to treat you after French fashion. Let us
- be off to breakfast!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXII
-
-
- THE NEW CITIZEN OF THE UNITED STATES
-
-
- That same day all America heard of the affair of Captain Nicholl
- and President Barbicane, as well as its singular _denouement_.
- From that day forth, Michel Ardan had not one moment's rest.
- Deputations from all corners of the Union harassed him without
- cessation or intermission. He was compelled to receive them
- all, whether he would or no. How many hands he shook, how many
- people he was "hail-fellow-well-met" with, it is impossible
- to guess! Such a triumphal result would have intoxicated any
- other man; but he managed to keep himself in a state of delightful
- _semi_-tipsiness.
-
- Among the deputations of all kinds which assailed him, that of
- "The Lunatics" were careful not to forget what they owed to the
- future conqueror of the moon. One day, certain of these poor
- people, so numerous in America, came to call upon him, and
- requested permission to return with him to their native country.
-
- "Singular hallucination!" said he to Barbicane, after having
- dismissed the deputation with promises to convey numbers of
- messages to friends in the moon. "Do you believe in the
- influence of the moon upon distempers?"
-
- "Scarcely!"
-
- "No more do I, despite some remarkable recorded facts of history.
- For instance, during an epidemic in 1693, a large number of
- persons died at the very moment of an eclipse. The celebrated
- Bacon always fainted during an eclipse. Charles VI relapsed
- six times into madness during the year 1399, sometimes during
- the new, sometimes during the full moon. Gall observed that
- insane persons underwent an accession of their disorder twice
- in every month, at the epochs of new and full moon. In fact,
- numerous observations made upon fevers, somnambulisms, and other
- human maladies, seem to prove that the moon does exercise some
- mysterious influence upon man."
-
- "But the how and the wherefore?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Well, I can only give you the answer which Arago borrowed from
- Plutarch, which is nineteen centuries old. `Perhaps the stories
- are not true!'"
-
- In the height of his triumph, Michel Ardan had to encounter all
- the annoyances incidental to a man of celebrity. Managers of
- entertainments wanted to exhibit him. Barnum offered him a
- million dollars to make a tour of the United States in his show.
- As for his photographs, they were sold of all size, and his
- portrait taken in every imaginable posture. More than half a
- million copies were disposed of in an incredibly short space of time.
-
- But it was not only the men who paid him homage, but the women
- as well. He might have married well a hundred times over, if he
- had been willing to settle in life. The old maids, in
- particular, of forty years and upward, and dry in proportion,
- devoured his photographs day and night. They would have married
- him by hundreds, even if he had imposed upon them the condition
- of accompanying him into space. He had, however, no intention
- of transplanting a race of Franco-Americans upon the surface of
- the moon.
-
- He therefore declined all offers.
-
- As soon as he could withdraw from these somewhat embarrassing
- demonstrations, he went, accompanied by his friends, to pay a
- visit to the Columbiad. He was highly gratified by his
- inspection, and made the descent to the bottom of the tube of
- this gigantic machine which was presently to launch him to the
- regions of the moon. It is necessary here to mention a proposal
- of J. T. Maston's. When the secretary of the Gun Club found
- that Barbicane and Nicholl accepted the proposal of Michel
- Ardan, he determined to join them, and make one of a smug party
- of four. So one day he determined to be admitted as one of the
- travelers. Barbicane, pained at having to refuse him, gave him
- clearly to understand that the projectile could not possibly
- contain so many passengers. Maston, in despair, went in search
- of Michel Ardan, who counseled him to resign himself to the
- situation, adding one or two arguments _ad hominem_.
-
- "You see, old fellow," he said, "you must not take what I say in
- bad part; but really, between ourselves, you are in too
- incomplete a condition to appear in the moon!"
-
- "Incomplete?" shrieked the valiant invalid.
-
- "Yes, my dear fellow! imagine our meeting some of the
- inhabitants up there! Would you like to give them such a
- melancholy notion of what goes on down here? to teach them what
- war is, to inform them that we employ our time chiefly in
- devouring each other, in smashing arms and legs, and that too
- on a globe which is capable of supporting a hundred billions
- of inhabitants, and which actually does contain nearly two
- hundred millions? Why, my worthy friend, we should have to
- turn you out of doors!"
-
- "But still, if you arrive there in pieces, you will be as
- incomplete as I am."
-
- "Unquestionably," replied Michel Ardan; "but we shall not."
-
- In fact, a preparatory experiment, tried on the 18th of October,
- had yielded the best results and caused the most well-grounded
- hopes of success. Barbicane, desirous of obtaining some notion
- of the effect of the shock at the moment of the projectile's
- departure, had procured a 38-inch mortar from the arsenal
- of Pensacola. He had this placed on the bank of Hillisborough
- Roads, in order that the shell might fall back into the sea, and
- the shock be thereby destroyed. His object was to ascertain the
- extent of the shock of departure, and not that of the return.
-
- A hollow projectile had been prepared for this curious experiment.
- A thick padding fastened upon a kind of elastic network, made of
- the best steel, lined the inside of the walls. It was a veritable
- _nest_ most carefully wadded.
-
- "What a pity I can't find room in there," said J. T. Maston,
- regretting that his height did not allow of his trying the adventure.
-
- Within this shell were shut up a large cat, and a squirrel
- belonging to J. T. Maston, and of which he was particularly fond.
- They were desirous, however, of ascertaining how this little
- animal, least of all others subject to giddiness, would endure
- this experimental voyage.
-
- The mortar was charged with 160 pounds of powder, and the shell
- placed in the chamber. On being fired, the projectile rose with
- great velocity, described a majestic parabola, attained a height
- of about a thousand feet, and with a graceful curve descended in
- the midst of the vessels that lay there at anchor.
-
- Without a moment's loss of time a small boat put off in the
- direction of its fall; some divers plunged into the water
- and attached ropes to the handles of the shell, which was
- quickly dragged on board. Five minutes did not elapse between
- the moment of enclosing the animals and that of unscrewing the
- coverlid of their prison.
-
- Ardan, Barbicane, Maston, and Nicholl were present on board the
- boat, and assisted at the operation with an interest which may
- readily be comprehended. Hardly had the shell been opened when
- the cat leaped out, slightly bruised, but full of life, and
- exhibiting no signs whatever of having made an aerial expedition.
- No trace, however, of the squirrel could be discovered. The truth
- at last became apparent-- the cat had eaten its fellow-traveler!
-
- J. T. Maston grieved much for the loss of his poor squirrel, and
- proposed to add its case to that of other martyrs to science.
-
- After this experiment all hesitation, all fear disappeared.
- Besides, Barbicane's plans would ensure greater perfection for
- his projectile, and go far to annihilate altogether the effects
- of the shock. Nothing now remained but to go!
-
- Two days later Michel Ardan received a message from the
- President of the United States, an honor of which he showed
- himself especially sensible.
-
- After the example of his illustrious fellow-countryman, the
- Marquis de la Fayette, the government had decreed to him the
- title of "Citizen of the United States of America."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIII
-
-
- THE PROJECTILE-VEHICLE
-
-
- On the completion of the Columbiad the public interest centered
- in the projectile itself, the vehicle which was destined to
- carry the three hardy adventurers into space.
-
- The new plans had been sent to Breadwill and Co., of Albany,
- with the request for their speedy execution. The projectile was
- consequently cast on the 2nd of November, and immediately
- forwarded by the Eastern Railway to Stones Hill, which it
- reached without accident on the 10th of that month, where Michel
- Ardan, Barbicane, and Nicholl were waiting impatiently for it.
-
- The projectile had now to be filled to the depth of three feet
- with a bed of water, intended to support a water-tight wooden
- disc, which worked easily within the walls of the projectile.
- It was upon this kind of raft that the travelers were to take
- their place. This body of water was divided by horizontal
- partitions, which the shock of the departure would have to break
- in succession. Then each sheet of the water, from the lowest
- to the highest, running off into escape tubes toward the top of
- the projectile, constituted a kind of spring; and the wooden
- disc, supplied with extremely powerful plugs, could not strike
- the lowest plate except after breaking successively the
- different partitions. Undoubtedly the travelers would still
- have to encounter a violent recoil after the complete escapement
- of the water; but the first shock would be almost entirely
- destroyed by this powerful spring. The upper parts of the walls
- were lined with a thick padding of leather, fastened upon springs
- of the best steel, behind which the escape tubes were completely
- concealed; thus all imaginable precautions had been taken for
- averting the first shock; and if they did get crushed, they
- must, as Michel Ardan said, be made of very bad materials.
-
- The entrance into this metallic tower was by a narrow aperture
- contrived in the wall of the cone. This was hermetically closed
- by a plate of aluminum, fastened internally by powerful
- screw-pressure. The travelers could therefore quit their prison
- at pleasure, as soon as they should reach the moon.
-
- Light and view were given by means of four thick lenticular
- glass scuttles, two pierced in the circular wall itself, the
- third in the bottom, the fourth in the top. These scuttles then
- were protected against the shock of departure by plates let into
- solid grooves, which could easily be opened outward by
- unscrewing them from the inside. Reservoirs firmly fixed
- contained water and the necessary provisions; and fire
- and light were procurable by means of gas, contained in a
- special reservoir under a pressure of several atmospheres.
- They had only to turn a tap, and for six hours the gas would
- light and warm this comfortable vehicle.
-
- There now remained only the question of air; for allowing for
- the consumption of air by Barbicane, his two companions, and two
- dogs which he proposed taking with him, it was necessary to
- renew the air of the projectile. Now air consists principally
- of twenty-one parts of oxygen and seventy-nine of nitrogen.
- The lungs absorb the oxygen, which is indispensable for the support
- of life, and reject the nitrogen. The air expired loses nearly
- five per cent. of the former and contains nearly an equal volume
- of carbonic acid, produced by the combustion of the elements of
- the blood. In an air-tight enclosure, then, after a certain
- time, all the oxygen of the air will be replaced by the carbonic
- acid-- a gas fatal to life. There were two things to be done
- then-- first, to replace the absorbed oxygen; secondly, to
- destroy the expired carbonic acid; both easy enough to do, by
- means of chlorate of potassium and caustic potash. The former
- is a salt which appears under the form of white crystals; when
- raised to a temperature of 400 degrees it is transformed into
- chlorure of potassium, and the oxygen which it contains is
- entirely liberated. Now twenty-eight pounds of chlorate of
- potassium produces seven pounds of oxygen, or 2,400 litres-- the
- quantity necessary for the travelers during twenty-four hours.
-
- Caustic potash has a great affinity for carbonic acid; and it is
- sufficient to shake it in order for it to seize upon the acid
- and form bicarbonate of potassium. By these two means they
- would be enabled to restore to the vitiated air its life-
- supporting properties.
-
- It is necessary, however, to add that the experiments had
- hitherto been made _in anima vili_. Whatever its scientific
- accuracy was, they were at present ignorant how it would answer
- with human beings. The honor of putting it to the proof was
- energetically claimed by J. T. Maston.
-
- "Since I am not to go," said the brave artillerist, "I may at
- least live for a week in the projectile."
-
- It would have been hard to refuse him; so they consented to
- his wish. A sufficient quantity of chlorate of potassium and
- of caustic potash was placed at his disposal, together with
- provisions for eight days. And having shaken hands with his
- friends, on the 12th of November, at six o'clock A.M., after
- strictly informing them not to open his prison before the 20th,
- at six o'clock P.M., he slid down the projectile, the plate of
- which was at once hermetically sealed. What did he do with
- himself during that week? They could get no information.
- The thickness of the walls of the projectile prevented any
- sound reaching from the inside to the outside. On the 20th
- of November, at six P.M. exactly, the plate was opened.
- The friends of J. T. Maston had been all along in a state of
- much anxiety; but they were promptly reassured on hearing a
- jolly voice shouting a boisterous hurrah.
-
- Presently afterward the secretary of the Gun Club appeared at
- the top of the cone in a triumphant attitude. He had grown fat!
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIV
-
-
- THE TELESCOPE OF THE ROCKY MOUNTAINS
-
-
- On the 20th of October in the preceding year, after the close of
- the subscription, the president of the Gun Club had credited the
- Observatory of Cambridge with the necessary sums for the
- construction of a gigantic optical instrument. This instrument
- was designed for the purpose of rendering visible on the surface
- of the moon any object exceeding nine feet in diameter.
-
- At the period when the Gun Club essayed their great experiment,
- such instruments had reached a high degree of perfection,
- and produced some magnificent results. Two telescopes in
- particular, at this time, were possessed of remarkable power
- and of gigantic dimensions. The first, constructed by Herschel,
- was thirty-six feet in length, and had an object-glass of four
- feet six inches; it possessed a magnifying power of 6,000.
- The second was raised in Ireland, in Parsonstown Park, and belongs
- to Lord Rosse. The length of this tube is forty-eight feet, and
- the diameter of its object-glass six feet; it magnifies 6,400
- times, and required an immense erection of brick work and
- masonry for the purpose of working it, its weight being twelve
- and a half tons.
-
- Still, despite these colossal dimensions, the actual
- enlargements scarcely exceeded 6,000 times in round numbers;
- consequently, the moon was brought within no nearer an apparent
- distance than thirty-nine miles; and objects of less than sixty
- feet in diameter, unless they were of very considerable length,
- were still imperceptible.
-
- In the present case, dealing with a projectile nine feet in
- diameter and fifteen feet long, it became necessary to bring the
- moon within an apparent distance of five miles at most; and for
- that purpose to establish a magnifying power of 48,000 times.
-
- Such was the question proposed to the Observatory of Cambridge,
- There was no lack of funds; the difficulty was purely one
- of construction.
-
- After considerable discussion as to the best form and principle
- of the proposed instrument the work was finally commenced.
- According to the calculations of the Observatory of Cambridge,
- the tube of the new reflector would require to be 280 feet in
- length, and the object-glass sixteen feet in diameter.
- Colossal as these dimensions may appear, they were diminutive
- in comparison with the 10,000 foot telescope proposed by the
- astronomer Hooke only a few years ago!
-
- Regarding the choice of locality, that matter was
- promptly determined. The object was to select some lofty
- mountain, and there are not many of these in the United States.
- In fact there are but two chains of moderate elevation, between
- which runs the magnificent Mississippi, the "king of rivers"
- as these Republican Yankees delight to call it.
-
- Eastwards rise the Appalachians, the very highest point of
- which, in New Hampshire, does not exceed the very moderate
- altitude of 5,600 feet.
-
- On the west, however, rise the Rocky Mountains, that immense
- range which, commencing at the Straights of Magellan, follows
- the western coast of Southern America under the name of the
- Andes or the Cordilleras, until it crosses the Isthmus of
- Panama, and runs up the whole of North America to the very
- borders of the Polar Sea. The highest elevation of this range
- still does not exceed 10,700 feet. With this elevation,
- nevertheless, the Gun Club were compelled to be content,
- inasmuch as they had determined that both telescope and
- Columbiad should be erected within the limits of the Union.
- All the necessary apparatus was consequently sent on to the
- summit of Long's Peak, in the territory of Missouri.
-
- Neither pen nor language can describe the difficulties of all
- kinds which the American engineers had to surmount, of the
- prodigies of daring and skill which they accomplished. They had
- to raise enormous stones, massive pieces of wrought iron, heavy
- corner-clamps and huge portions of cylinder, with an
- object-glass weighing nearly 30,000 pounds, above the line of
- perpetual snow for more than 10,000 feet in height, after
- crossing desert prairies, impenetrable forests, fearful rapids,
- far from all centers of population, and in the midst of savage
- regions, in which every detail of life becomes an almost
- insoluble problem. And yet, notwithstanding these innumerable
- obstacles, American genius triumphed. In less than a year after
- the commencement of the works, toward the close of September,
- the gigantic reflector rose into the air to a height of 280 feet.
- It was raised by means of an enormous iron crane; an ingenious
- mechanism allowed it to be easily worked toward all the points
- of the heavens, and to follow the stars from the one horizon to
- the other during their journey through the heavens.
-
- It had cost $400,000. The first time it was directed toward the
- moon the observers evinced both curiosity and anxiety. What were
- they about to discover in the field of this telescope which
- magnified objects 48,000 times? Would they perceive peoples,
- herds of lunar animals, towns, lakes, seas? No! there was
- nothing which science had not already discovered! and on all the
- points of its disc the volcanic nature of the moon became
- determinable with the utmost precision.
-
- But the telescope of the Rocky Mountains, before doing its duty
- to the Gun Club, rendered immense services to astronomy. Thanks to
- its penetrative power, the depths of the heavens were sounded to
- the utmost extent; the apparent diameter of a great number of stars
- was accurately measured; and Mr. Clark, of the Cambridge staff,
- resolved the Crab nebula in Taurus, which the reflector of Lord
- Rosse had never been able to decompose.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXV
-
-
- FINAL DETAILS
-
-
- It was the 22nd of November; the departure was to take place in
- ten days. One operation alone remained to be accomplished to
- bring all to a happy termination; an operation delicate and
- perilous, requiring infinite precautions, and against the
- success of which Captain Nicholl had laid his third bet. It was,
- in fact, nothing less than the loading of the Columbiad, and the
- introduction into it of 400,000 pounds of gun-cotton. Nicholl had
- thought, not perhaps without reason, that the handling of such
- formidable quantities of pyroxyle would, in all probability,
- involve a grave catastrophe; and at any rate, that this immense
- mass of eminently inflammable matter would inevitably ignite when
- submitted to the pressure of the projectile.
-
- There were indeed dangers accruing as before from the
- carelessness of the Americans, but Barbicane had set his heart
- on success, and took all possible precautions. In the first
- place, he was very careful as to the transportation of the
- gun-cotton to Stones Hill. He had it conveyed in small
- quantities, carefully packed in sealed cases. These were
- brought by rail from Tampa Town to the camp, and from thence
- were taken to the Columbiad by barefooted workmen, who deposited
- them in their places by means of cranes placed at the orifice of
- the cannon. No steam-engine was permitted to work, and every
- fire was extinguished within two miles of the works.
-
- Even in November they feared to work by day, lest the sun's rays
- acting on the gun-cotton might lead to unhappy results. This led
- to their working at night, by light produced in a vacuum by means
- of Ruhmkorff's apparatus, which threw an artificial brightness
- into the depths of the Columbiad. There the cartridges were
- arranged with the utmost regularity, connected by a metallic thread,
- destined to communicate to them all simultaneously the electric
- spark, by which means this mass of gun-cotton was eventually
- to be ignited.
-
- By the 28th of November eight hundred cartridges had been
- placed in the bottom of the Columbiad. So far the operation had
- been successful! But what confusion, what anxieties, what struggles
- were undergone by President Barbicane! In vain had he refused
- admission to Stones Hill; every day the inquisitive neighbors
- scaled the palisades, some even carrying their imprudence to the
- point of smoking while surrounded by bales of gun-cotton.
- Barbicane was in a perpetual state of alarm. J. T. Maston
- seconded him to the best of his ability, by giving vigorous
- chase to the intruders, and carefully picking up the still
- lighted cigar ends which the Yankees threw about. A somewhat
- difficult task! seeing that more than 300,000 persons were
- gathered round the enclosure. Michel Ardan had volunteered to
- superintend the transport of the cartridges to the mouth of the
- Columbiad; but the president, having surprised him with an
- enormous cigar in his mouth, while he was hunting out the rash
- spectators to whom he himself offered so dangerous an example,
- saw that he could not trust this fearless smoker, and was
- therefore obliged to mount a special guard over him.
-
- At last, Providence being propitious, this wonderful loading
- came to a happy termination, Captain Nicholl's third bet being
- thus lost. It remained now to introduce the projectile into the
- Columbiad, and to place it on its soft bed of gun-cotton.
-
- But before doing this, all those things necessary for the
- journey had to be carefully arranged in the projectile vehicle.
- These necessaries were numerous; and had Ardan been allowed to
- follow his own wishes, there would have been no space remaining
- for the travelers. It is impossible to conceive of half the
- things this charming Frenchman wished to convey to the moon.
- A veritable stock of useless trifles! But Barbicane interfered
- and refused admission to anything not absolutely needed.
- Several thermometers, barometers, and telescopes were packed in
- the instrument case.
-
- The travelers being desirous of examing the moon carefully
- during their voyage, in order to facilitate their studies,
- they took with them Boeer and Moeller's excellent _Mappa
- Selenographica_, a masterpiece of patience and observation,
- which they hoped would enable them to identify those physical
- features in the moon, with which they were acquainted.
- This map reproduced with scrupulous fidelity the smallest
- details of the lunar surface which faces the earth; the
- mountains, valleys, craters, peaks, and ridges were all
- represented, with their exact dimensions, relative positions,
- and names; from the mountains Doerfel and Leibnitz on the
- eastern side of the disc, to the _Mare frigoris_ of the North Pole.
-
- They took also three rifles and three fowling-pieces, and a
- large quantity of balls, shot, and powder.
-
- "We cannot tell whom we shall have to deal with," said Michel Ardan.
- "Men or beasts may possibly object to our visit. It is only wise
- to take all precautions."
-
- These defensive weapons were accompanied by pickaxes, crowbars,
- saws, and other useful implements, not to mention clothing
- adapted to every temperature, from that of polar regions to that
- of the torrid zone.
-
- Ardan wished to convey a number of animals of different sorts,
- not indeed a pair of every known species, as he could not see
- the necessity of acclimatizing serpents, tigers, alligators, or
- any other noxious beasts in the moon. "Nevertheless," he said
- to Barbicane, "some valuable and useful beasts, bullocks, cows,
- horses, and donkeys, would bear the journey very well, and would
- also be very useful to us."
-
- "I dare say, my dear Ardan," replied the president, "but our
- projectile-vehicle is no Noah's ark, from which it differs both in
- dimensions and object. Let us confine ourselves to possibilities."
-
- After a prolonged discussion, it was agreed that the travelers
- should restrict themselves to a sporting-dog belonging to
- Nicholl, and to a large Newfoundland. Several packets of seeds
- were also included among the necessaries. Michel Ardan, indeed,
- was anxious to add some sacks full of earth to sow them in; as
- it was, he took a dozen shrubs carefully wrapped up in straw to
- plant in the moon.
-
- The important question of provisions still remained; it being
- necessary to provide against the possibility of their finding
- the moon absolutely barren. Barbicane managed so successfully,
- that he supplied them with sufficient rations for a year.
- These consisted of preserved meats and vegetables, reduced by
- strong hydraulic pressure to the smallest possible dimensions.
- They were also supplied with brandy, and took water enough for
- two months, being confident, from astronomical observations,
- that there was no lack of water on the moon's surface. As to
- provisions, doubtless the inhabitants of the _earth_ would find
- nourishment somewhere in the _moon_. Ardan never questioned
- this; indeed, had he done so, he would never have undertaken
- the journey.
-
- "Besides," he said one day to his friends, "we shall not be
- completely abandoned by our terrestrial friends; they will take
- care not to forget us."
-
- "No, indeed!" replied J. T. Maston.
-
- "Nothing would be simpler," replied Ardan; "the Columbiad will
- be always there. Well! whenever the moon is in a favorable
- condition as to the zenith, if not to the perigee, that is to
- say about once a year, could you not send us a shell packed
- with provisions, which we might expect on some appointed day?"
-
- "Hurrah! hurrah!" cried J. T. Matson; "what an ingenious fellow!
- what a splendid idea! Indeed, my good friends, we shall not
- forget you!"
-
- "I shall reckon upon you! Then, you see, we shall receive news
- regularly from the earth, and we shall indeed be stupid if we
- hit upon no plan for communicating with our good friends here!"
-
- These words inspired such confidence, that Michel Ardan carried
- all the Gun Club with him in his enthusiasm. What he said
- seemed so simple and so easy, so sure of success, that none
- could be so sordidly attached to this earth as to hesitate to
- follow the three travelers on their lunar expedition.
-
- All being ready at last, it remained to place the projectile in
- the Columbiad, an operation abundantly accompanied by dangers
- and difficulties.
-
- The enormous shell was conveyed to the summit of Stones Hill.
- There, powerful cranes raised it, and held it suspended over the
- mouth of the cylinder.
-
- It was a fearful moment! What if the chains should break under
- its enormous weight? The sudden fall of such a body would
- inevitably cause the gun-cotton to explode!
-
- Fortunately this did not happen; and some hours later the
- projectile-vehicle descended gently into the heart of the cannon
- and rested on its couch of pyroxyle, a veritable bed of
- explosive eider-down. Its pressure had no result, other than
- the more effectual ramming down of the charge in the Columbiad.
-
- "I have lost," said the captain, who forthwith paid President
- Barbicane the sum of three thousand dollars.
-
- Barbicane did not wish to accept the money from one of his
- fellow-travelers, but gave way at last before the determination
- of Nicholl, who wished before leaving the earth to fulfill all
- his engagements.
-
- "Now," said Michel Ardan, "I have only one thing more to wish
- for you, my brave captain."
-
- "What is that?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "It is that you may lose your two other bets! Then we shall be
- sure not to be stopped on our journey!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVI
-
-
- FIRE!
-
-
- The first of December had arrived! the fatal day! for, if the
- projectile were not discharged that very night at 10h. 48m. 40s.
- P.M., more than eighteen years must roll by before the moon
- would again present herself under the same conditions of zenith
- and perigee.
-
- The weather was magnificent. Despite the approach of winter,
- the sun shone brightly, and bathed in its radiant light that
- earth which three of its denizens were about to abandon for a
- new world.
-
- How many persons lost their rest on the night which preceded
- this long-expected day! All hearts beat with disquietude, save
- only the heart of Michel Ardan. That imperturbable personage
- came and went with his habitual business-like air, while nothing
- whatever denoted that any unusual matter preoccupied his mind.
-
- After dawn, an innumerable multitude covered the prairie which
- extends, as far as the eye can reach, round Stones Hill. Every
- quarter of an hour the railway brought fresh accessions of
- sightseers; and, according to the statement of the Tampa Town
- _Observer_, not less than five millions of spectators thronged
- the soil of Florida.
-
- For a whole month previously, the mass of these persons had
- bivouacked round the enclosure, and laid the foundations for a
- town which was afterward called "Ardan's Town." The whole plain
- was covered with huts, cottages, and tents. Every nation under
- the sun was represented there; and every language might be heard
- spoken at the same time. It was a perfect Babel re-enacted.
- All the various classes of American society were mingled
- together in terms of absolute equality. Bankers, farmers,
- sailors, cotton-planters, brokers, merchants, watermen,
- magistrates, elbowed each other in the most free-and-easy way.
- Louisiana Creoles fraternized with farmers from Indiana;
- Kentucky and Tennessee gentlemen and haughty Virginians
- conversed with trappers and the half-savages of the lakes and
- butchers from Cincinnati. Broad-brimmed white hats and Panamas,
- blue-cotton trousers, light-colored stockings, cambric frills,
- were all here displayed; while upon shirt-fronts, wristbands,
- and neckties, upon every finger, even upon the very ears, they
- wore an assortment of rings, shirt-pins, brooches, and trinkets,
- of which the value only equaled the execrable taste. Women, children,
- and servants, in equally expensive dress, surrounded their husbands,
- fathers, or masters, who resembled the patriarchs of tribes in the
- midst of their immense households.
-
- At meal-times all fell to work upon the dishes peculiar to the
- Southern States, and consumed with an appetite that threatened
- speedy exhaustion of the victualing powers of Florida,
- fricasseed frogs, stuffed monkey, fish chowder, underdone
- 'possum, and raccoon steaks. And as for the liquors which
- accompanied this indigestible repast! The shouts, the
- vociferations that resounded through the bars and taverns
- decorated with glasses, tankards, and bottles of marvelous
- shape, mortars for pounding sugar, and bundles of straws!
- "Mint-julep" roars one of the barmen; "Claret sangaree!"
- shouts another; "Cocktail!" "Brandy-smash!" "Real mint-julep
- in the new style!" All these cries intermingled produced a
- bewildering and deafening hubbub.
-
- But on this day, 1st of December, such sounds were rare. No one
- thought of eating or drinking, and at four P.M. there were vast
- numbers of spectators who had not even taken their customary
- lunch! And, a still more significant fact, even the national
- passion for play seemed quelled for the time under the general
- excitement of the hour.
-
- Up till nightfall, a dull, noiseless agitation, such as
- precedes great catastrophes, ran through the anxious multitude.
- An indescribable uneasiness pervaded all minds, an indefinable
- sensation which oppressed the heart. Every one wished it was over.
-
- However, about seven o'clock, the heavy silence was dissipated.
- The moon rose above the horizon. Millions of hurrahs hailed
- her appearance. She was punctual to the rendezvous, and shouts
- of welcome greeted her on all sides, as her pale beams shone
- gracefully in the clear heavens. At this moment the three
- intrepid travelers appeared. This was the signal for renewed
- cries of still greater intensity. Instantly the vast
- assemblage, as with one accord, struck up the national hymn of
- the United States, and "Yankee Doodle," sung by five million of
- hearty throats, rose like a roaring tempest to the farthest
- limits of the atmosphere. Then a profound silence reigned
- throughout the crowd.
-
- The Frenchman and the two Americans had by this time entered the
- enclosure reserved in the center of the multitude. They were
- accompanied by the members of the Gun Club, and by deputations
- sent from all the European Observatories. Barbicane, cool and
- collected, was giving his final directions. Nicholl, with
- compressed lips, his arms crossed behind his back, walked with
- a firm and measured step. Michel Ardan, always easy, dressed in
- thorough traveler's costume, leathern gaiters on his legs, pouch
- by his side, in loose velvet suit, cigar in mouth, was full of
- inexhaustible gayety, laughing, joking, playing pranks with J.
- T. Maston. In one word, he was the thorough "Frenchman" (and
- worse, a "Parisian") to the last moment.
-
- Ten o'clock struck! The moment had arrived for taking their
- places in the projectile! The necessary operations for the
- descent, and the subsequent removal of the cranes and
- scaffolding that inclined over the mouth of the Columbiad,
- required a certain period of time.
-
- Barbicane had regulated his chronometer to the tenth part of a
- second by that of Murchison the engineer, who was charged with
- the duty of firing the gun by means of an electric spark.
- Thus the travelers enclosed within the projectile were enabled
- to follow with their eyes the impassive needle which marked the
- precise moment of their departure.
-
- The moment had arrived for saying "good-by!" The scene was a
- touching one. Despite his feverish gayety, even Michel Ardan
- was touched. J. T. Maston had found in his own dry eyes one
- ancient tear, which he had doubtless reserved for the occasion.
- He dropped it on the forehead of his dear president.
-
- "Can I not go?" he said, "there is still time!"
-
- "Impossible, old fellow!" replied Barbicane. A few moments
- later, the three fellow-travelers had ensconced themselves in
- the projectile, and screwed down the plate which covered the
- entrance-aperture. The mouth of the Columbiad, now completely
- disencumbered, was open entirely to the sky.
-
- The moon advanced upward in a heaven of the purest clearness,
- outshining in her passage the twinkling light of the stars.
- She passed over the constellation of the Twins, and was now
- nearing the halfway point between the horizon and the zenith.
- A terrible silence weighed upon the entire scene! Not a breath of
- wind upon the earth! not a sound of breathing from the countless
- chests of the spectators! Their hearts seemed afraid to beat!
- All eyes were fixed upon the yawning mouth of the Columbiad.
-
- Murchison followed with his eye the hand of his chronometer.
- It wanted scarce forty seconds to the moment of departure, but
- each second seemed to last an age! At the twentieth there was
- a general shudder, as it occurred to the minds of that vast
- assemblage that the bold travelers shut up within the projectile
- were also counting those terrible seconds. Some few cries here
- and there escaped the crowd.
-
- "Thirty-five!-- thirty-six!-- thirty-seven!-- thirty-eight!--
- thirty-nine!-- forty! FIRE!!!"
-
- Instantly Murchison pressed with his finger the key of the
- electric battery, restored the current of the fluid, and
- discharged the spark into the breech of the Columbiad.
-
- An appalling unearthly report followed instantly, such as can be
- compared to nothing whatever known, not even to the roar of
- thunder, or the blast of volcanic explosions! No words can
- convey the slightest idea of the terrific sound! An immense
- spout of fire shot up from the bowels of the earth as from a crater.
- The earth heaved up, and with great difficulty some few spectators
- obtained a momentary glimpse of the projectile victoriously
- cleaving the air in the midst of the fiery vapors!
-
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVII
-
-
- FOUL WEATHER
-
-
- At the moment when that pyramid of fire rose to a prodigious
- height into the air, the glare of flame lit up the whole of
- Florida; and for a moment day superseded night over a
- considerable extent of the country. This immense canopy of fire
- was perceived at a distance of one hundred miles out at sea, and
- more than one ship's captain entered in his log the appearance
- of this gigantic meteor.
-
- The discharge of the Columbiad was accompanied by a
- perfect earthquake. Florida was shaken to its very depths.
- The gases of the powder, expanded by heat, forced back the
- atmospheric strata with tremendous violence, and this
- artificial hurricane rushed like a water-spout through the air.
-
- Not a single spectator remained on his feet! Men, women
- children, all lay prostrate like ears of corn under a tempest.
- There ensued a terrible tumult; a large number of persons were
- seriously injured. J. T. Maston, who, despite all dictates of
- prudence, had kept in advance of the mass, was pitched back 120
- feet, shooting like a projectile over the heads of his
- fellow-citizens. Three hundred thousand persons remained deaf
- for a time, and as though struck stupefied.
-
- As soon as the first effects were over, the injured, the deaf,
- and lastly, the crowd in general, woke up with frenzied cries.
- "Hurrah for Ardan! Hurrah for Barbicane! Hurrah for Nicholl!"
- rose to the skies. Thousands of persons, noses in air, armed
- with telescopes and race-glasses, were questioning space,
- forgetting all contusions and emotions in the one idea of
- watching for the projectile. They looked in vain! It was no
- longer to be seen, and they were obliged to wait for telegrams
- from Long's Peak. The director of the Cambridge Observatory was
- at his post on the Rocky Mountains; and to him, as a skillful
- and persevering astronomer, all observations had been confided.
-
- But an unforeseen phenomenon came in to subject the public
- impatience to a severe trial.
-
- The weather, hitherto so fine, suddenly changed; the sky became
- heavy with clouds. It could not have been otherwise after the
- terrible derangement of the atmospheric strata, and the dispersion
- of the enormous quantity of vapor arising from the combustion of
- 200,000 pounds of pyroxyle!
-
- On the morrow the horizon was covered with clouds-- a thick and
- impenetrable curtain between earth and sky, which unhappily
- extended as far as the Rocky Mountains. It was a fatality!
- But since man had chosen so to disturb the atmosphere, he was
- bound to accept the consequences of his experiment.
-
- Supposing, now, that the experiment had succeeded, the travelers
- having started on the 1st of December, at 10h. 46m. 40s. P.M.,
- were due on the 4th at 0h. P.M. at their destination. So that
- up to that time it would have been very difficult after all to
- have observed, under such conditions, a body so small as the shell.
- Therefore they waited with what patience they might.
-
- From the 4th to the 6th of December inclusive, the weather
- remaining much the same in America, the great European
- instruments of Herschel, Rosse, and Foucault, were constantly
- directed toward the moon, for the weather was then magnificent;
- but the comparative weakness of their glasses prevented any
- trustworthy observations being made.
-
- On the 7th the sky seemed to lighten. They were in hopes now,
- but their hope was of but short duration, and at night again
- thick clouds hid the starry vault from all eyes.
-
- Matters were now becoming serious, when on the 9th the sun
- reappeared for an instant, as if for the purpose of teasing
- the Americans. It was received with hisses; and wounded, no
- doubt, by such a reception, showed itself very sparing of its rays.
-
- On the 10th, no change! J. T. Maston went nearly mad, and great
- fears were entertained regarding the brain of this worthy
- individual, which had hitherto been so well preserved within his
- gutta-percha cranium.
-
- But on the 11th one of those inexplicable tempests peculiar to
- those intertropical regions was let loose in the atmosphere.
- A terrific east wind swept away the groups of clouds which had
- been so long gathering, and at night the semi-disc of the orb of
- night rode majestically amid the soft constellations of the sky.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXVIII
-
-
- A NEW STAR
-
-
- That very night, the startling news so impatiently awaited,
- burst like a thunderbolt over the United States of the Union,
- and thence, darting across the ocean, ran through all the
- telegraphic wires of the globe. The projectile had been
- detected, thanks to the gigantic reflector of Long's Peak!
- Here is the note received by the director of the Observatory
- of Cambridge. It contains the scientific conclusion regarding
- this great experiment of the Gun Club.
-
-
- LONG'S PEAK, December 12.
- To the Officers of the Observatory of Cambridge.
- The projectile discharged by the Columbiad at Stones Hill has
- been detected by Messrs. Belfast and J. T. Maston, 12th of
- December, at 8:47 P.M., the moon having entered her last quarter.
- This projectile has not arrived at its destination. It has
- passed by the side; but sufficiently near to be retained by the
- lunar attraction.
-
- The rectilinear movement has thus become changed into a circular
- motion of extreme velocity, and it is now pursuing an elliptical
- orbit round the moon, of which it has become a true satellite.
-
- The elements of this new star we have as yet been unable to
- determine; we do not yet know the velocity of its passage.
- The distance which separates it from the surface of the moon
- may be estimated at about 2,833 miles.
-
- However, two hypotheses come here into our consideration.
-
- 1. Either the attraction of the moon will end by drawing them
- into itself, and the travelers will attain their destination; or,
-
- 2. The projectile, following an immutable law, will continue to
- gravitate round the moon till the end of time.
-
- At some future time, our observations will be able to determine
- this point, but till then the experiment of the Gun Club can
- have no other result than to have provided our solar system with
- a new star.
- J. BELFAST.
-
-
- To how many questions did this unexpected _denouement_ give rise?
- What mysterious results was the future reserving for the
- investigation of science? At all events, the names of Nicholl,
- Barbicane, and Michel Ardan were certain to be immortalized in
- the annals of astronomy!
-
- When the dispatch from Long's Peak had once become known, there
- was but one universal feeling of surprise and alarm. Was it
- possible to go to the aid of these bold travelers? No! for they
- had placed themselves beyond the pale of humanity, by crossing
- the limits imposed by the Creator on his earthly creatures.
- They had air enough for _two_ months; they had victuals enough
- for _twelve;-- but after that?_ There was only one man who
- would not admit that the situation was desperate-- he alone had
- confidence; and that was their devoted friend J. T. Maston.
-
- Besides, he never let them get out of sight. His home was
- henceforth the post at Long's Peak; his horizon, the mirror of
- that immense reflector. As soon as the moon rose above the
- horizon, he immediately caught her in the field of the
- telescope; he never let her go for an instant out of his
- sight, and followed her assiduously in her course through the
- stellar spaces. He watched with untiring patience the passage
- of the projectile across her silvery disc, and really the worthy
- man remained in perpetual communication with his three friends,
- whom he did not despair of seeing again some day.
-
- "Those three men," said he, "have carried into space all the
- resources of art, science, and industry. With that, one can do
- anything; and you will see that, some day, they will come out
- all right."
-
-
-
- ROUND THE MOON
-
- A SEQUEL TO
-
- FROM THE EARTH TO THE MOON
-
-
-
-
-
- ROUND THE MOON
-
-
-
-
- PRELIMINARY CHAPTER
-
-
- THE FIRST PART OF THIS WORK, AND SERVING AS A PREFACE TO THE SECOND
-
- During the year 186-, the whole world was greatly excited by a
- scientific experiment unprecedented in the annals of science.
- The members of the Gun Club, a circle of artillerymen formed at
- Baltimore after the American war, conceived the idea of
- putting themselves in communication with the moon!-- yes, with
- the moon-- by sending to her a projectile. Their president,
- Barbicane, the promoter of the enterprise, having consulted the
- astronomers of the Cambridge Observatory upon the subject, took
- all necessary means to ensure the success of this extraordinary
- enterprise, which had been declared practicable by the majority
- of competent judges. After setting on foot a public
- subscription, which realized nearly L1,200,000, they began the
- gigantic work.
-
- According to the advice forwarded from the members of the
- Observatory, the gun destined to launch the projectile had to be
- fixed in a country situated between the 0 and 28th degrees of
- north or south latitude, in order to aim at the moon when at the
- zenith; and its initiatory velocity was fixed at twelve thousand
- yards to the second. Launched on the 1st of December, at 10hrs.
- 46m. 40s. P.M., it ought to reach the moon four days after its
- departure, that is on the 5th of December, at midnight
- precisely, at the moment of her attaining her perigee, that is
- her nearest distance from the earth, which is exactly 86,410
- leagues (French), or 238,833 miles mean distance (English).
-
- The principal members of the Gun Club, President Barbicane,
- Major Elphinstone, the secretary Joseph T. Maston, and other
- learned men, held several meetings, at which the shape and
- composition of the projectile were discussed, also the position
- and nature of the gun, and the quality and quantity of powder
- to be used. It was decided: First, that the projectile should
- be a shell made of aluminum with a diameter of 108 inches and a
- thickness of twelve inches to its walls; and should weigh
- 19,250 pounds. Second, that the gun should be a Columbiad
- cast in iron, 900 feet long, and run perpendicularly into
- the earth. Third, that the charge should contain 400,000 pounds
- of gun-cotton, which, giving out six billions of litres of gas in
- rear of the projectile, would easily carry it toward the orb of night.
-
- These questions determined President Barbicane, assisted by
- Murchison the engineer, to choose a spot situated in Florida, in
- 27@ 7' North latitude, and 77@ 3' West (Greenwich) longitude.
- It was on this spot, after stupendous labor, that the Columbiad
- was cast with full success. Things stood thus, when an incident
- took place which increased the interest attached to this great
- enterprise a hundredfold.
-
- A Frenchman, an enthusiastic Parisian, as witty as he was bold,
- asked to be enclosed in the projectile, in order that he might
- reach the moon, and reconnoiter this terrestrial satellite.
- The name of this intrepid adventurer was Michel Ardan. He landed
- in America, was received with enthusiasm, held meetings, saw
- himself carried in triumph, reconciled President Barbicane to
- his mortal enemy, Captain Nicholl, and, as a token of
- reconciliation, persuaded them both to start with him in
- the projectile. The proposition being accepted, the shape
- of the projectile was slightly altered. It was made of a
- cylindro-conical form. This species of aerial car was lined with
- strong springs and partitions to deaden the shock of departure.
- It was provided with food for a year, water for some months,
- and gas for some days. A self-acting apparatus supplied the
- three travelers with air to breathe. At the same time, on one
- of the highest points of the Rocky Mountains, the Gun Club had
- a gigantic telescope erected, in order that they might be able
- to follow the course of the projectile through space. All was
- then ready.
-
- On the 30th of November, at the hour fixed upon, from the midst
- of an extraordinary crowd of spectators, the departure took place,
- and for the first time, three human beings quitted the terrestrial
- globe, and launched into inter-planetary space with almost a
- certainty of reaching their destination. These bold travelers,
- Michel Ardan, President Barbicane, and Captain Nicholl, ought to
- make the passage in ninety-seven hours, thirteen minutes, and
- twenty seconds. Consequently, their arrival on the lunar disc
- could not take place until the 5th of December at twelve at night,
- at the exact moment when the moon should be full, and not on the
- 4th, as some badly informed journalists had announced.
-
- But an unforeseen circumstance, viz., the detonation produced
- by the Columbiad, had the immediate effect of troubling the
- terrestrial atmosphere, by accumulating a large quantity of
- vapor, a phenomenon which excited universal indignation, for the
- moon was hidden from the eyes of the watchers for several nights.
-
- The worthy Joseph T. Maston, the staunchest friend of the three
- travelers, started for the Rocky Mountains, accompanied by the
- Hon. J. Belfast, director of the Cambridge Observatory, and
- reached the station of Long's Peak, where the telescope was
- erected which brought the moon within an apparent distance of
- two leagues. The honorable secretary of the Gun Club wished
- himself to observe the vehicle of his daring friends.
-
- The accumulation of the clouds in the atmosphere prevented all
- observation on the 5th, 6th, 7th, 8th, 9th, and 10th of December.
- Indeed it was thought that all observations would have to be put
- off to the 3d of January in the following year; for the moon
- entering its last quarter on the 11th, would then only present
- an ever-decreasing portion of her disc, insufficient to allow
- of their following the course of the projectile.
-
- At length, to the general satisfaction, a heavy storm cleared
- the atmosphere on the night of the 11th and 12th of December,
- and the moon, with half-illuminated disc, was plainly to be seen
- upon the black sky.
-
- That very night a telegram was sent from the station of Long's
- Peak by Joseph T. Maston and Belfast to the gentlemen of the
- Cambridge Observatory, announcing that on the 11th of December
- at 8h. 47m. P.M., the projectile launched by the Columbiad of
- Stones Hill had been detected by Messrs. Belfast and Maston--
- that it had deviated from its course from some unknown cause,
- and had not reached its destination; but that it had passed near
- enough to be retained by the lunar attraction; that its
- rectilinear movement had been changed to a circular one, and
- that following an elliptical orbit round the star of night it
- had become its satellite. The telegram added that the elements
- of this new star had not yet been calculated; and indeed three
- observations made upon a star in three different positions are
- necessary to determine these elements. Then it showed that the
- distance separating the projectile from the lunar surface "might"
- be reckoned at about 2,833 miles.
-
- It ended with the double hypothesis: either the attraction of
- the moon would draw it to herself, and the travelers thus attain
- their end; or that the projectile, held in one immutable orbit,
- would gravitate around the lunar disc to all eternity.
-
- With such alternatives, what would be the fate of the travelers?
- Certainly they had food for some time. But supposing they did
- succeed in their rash enterprise, how would they return?
- Could they ever return? Should they hear from them?
- These questions, debated by the most learned pens of the day,
- strongly engrossed the public attention.
-
- It is advisable here to make a remark which ought to be well
- considered by hasty observers. When a purely speculative
- discovery is announced to the public, it cannot be done with too
- much prudence. No one is obliged to discover either a planet,
- a comet, or a satellite; and whoever makes a mistake in such a
- case exposes himself justly to the derision of the mass.
- Far better is it to wait; and that is what the impatient Joseph
- T. Maston should have done before sending this telegram forth to
- the world, which, according to his idea, told the whole result
- of the enterprise. Indeed this telegram contained two sorts of
- errors, as was proved eventually. First, errors of observation,
- concerning the distance of the projectile from the surface of
- the moon, for on the 11th of December it was impossible to see
- it; and what Joseph T. Maston had seen, or thought he saw, could
- not have been the projectile of the Columbiad. Second, errors of
- theory on the fate in store for the said projectile; for in making
- it a satellite of the moon, it was putting it in direct
- contradiction of all mechanical laws.
-
- One single hypothesis of the observers of Long's Peak could ever
- be realized, that which foresaw the case of the travelers (if
- still alive) uniting their efforts with the lunar attraction to
- attain the surface of the disc.
-
- Now these men, as clever as they were daring, had survived the
- terrible shock consequent on their departure, and it is their
- journey in the projectile car which is here related in its most
- dramatic as well as in its most singular details. This recital
- will destroy many illusions and surmises; but it will give a
- true idea of the singular changes in store for such an
- enterprise; it will bring out the scientific instincts of
- Barbicane, the industrious resources of Nicholl, and the
- audacious humor of Michel Ardan. Besides this, it will prove
- that their worthy friend, Joseph T. Maston, was wasting his
- time, while leaning over the gigantic telescope he watched the
- course of the moon through the starry space.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER I
-
-
- TWENTY MINUTES PAST TEN TO FORTY-SEVEN MINUTES PAST TEN P. M.
-
- As ten o'clock struck, Michel Ardan, Barbicane, and Nicholl,
- took leave of the numerous friends they were leaving on the earth.
- The two dogs, destined to propagate the canine race on the lunar
- continents, were already shut up in the projectile.
-
- The three travelers approached the orifice of the enormous
- cast-iron tube, and a crane let them down to the conical top of
- the projectile. There, an opening made for the purpose gave
- them access to the aluminum car. The tackle belonging to the
- crane being hauled from outside, the mouth of the Columbiad was
- instantly disencumbered of its last supports.
-
- Nicholl, once introduced with his companions inside the
- projectile, began to close the opening by means of a strong
- plate, held in position by powerful screws. Other plates,
- closely fitted, covered the lenticular glasses, and the
- travelers, hermetically enclosed in their metal prison, were
- plunged in profound darkness.
-
- "And now, my dear companions," said Michel Ardan, "let us
- make ourselves at home; I am a domesticated man and strong
- in housekeeping. We are bound to make the best of our new
- lodgings, and make ourselves comfortable. And first let us
- try and see a little. Gas was not invented for moles."
-
- So saying, the thoughtless fellow lit a match by striking it on
- the sole of his boot; and approached the burner fixed to the
- receptacle, in which the carbonized hydrogen, stored at high
- pressure, sufficed for the lighting and warming of the
- projectile for a hundred and forty-four hours, or six days and
- six nights. The gas caught fire, and thus lighted the
- projectile looked like a comfortable room with thickly padded
- walls, furnished with a circular divan, and a roof rounded in
- the shape of a dome.
-
- Michel Ardan examined everything, and declared himself satisfied
- with his installation.
-
- "It is a prison," said he, "but a traveling prison; and, with
- the right of putting my nose to the window, I could well stand
- a lease of a hundred years. You smile, Barbicane. Have you any
- _arriere-pensee_? Do you say to yourself, `This prison may be
- our tomb?' Tomb, perhaps; still I would not change it for
- Mahomet's, which floats in space but never advances an inch!"
-
- While Michel Ardan was speaking, Barbicane and Nicholl were
- making their last preparations.
-
- Nicholl's chronometer marked twenty minutes past ten P.M. when
- the three travelers were finally enclosed in their projectile.
- This chronometer was set within the tenth of a second by that of
- Murchison the engineer. Barbicane consulted it.
-
- "My friends," said he, "it is twenty minutes past ten. At forty-
- seven minutes past ten Murchison will launch the electric spark
- on the wire which communicates with the charge of the Columbiad.
- At that precise moment we shall leave our spheroid. Thus we
- still have twenty-seven minutes to remain on the earth."
-
- "Twenty-six minutes thirteen seconds," replied the methodical Nicholl.
-
- "Well!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, in a good-humored tone, "much
- may be done in twenty-six minutes. The gravest questions of
- morals and politics may be discussed, and even solved.
- Twenty-six minutes well employed are worth more than twenty-six
- years in which nothing is done. Some seconds of a Pascal or a
- Newton are more precious than the whole existence of a crowd of
- raw simpletons----"
-
- "And you conclude, then, you everlasting talker?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "I conclude that we have twenty-six minutes left," replied Ardan.
-
- "Twenty-four only," said Nicholl.
-
- "Well, twenty-four, if you like, my noble captain," said Ardan;
- "twenty-four minutes in which to investigate----"
-
- "Michel," said Barbicane, "during the passage we shall have
- plenty of time to investigate the most difficult questions.
- For the present we must occupy ourselves with our departure."
-
- "Are we not ready?"
-
- "Doubtless; but there are still some precautions to be taken,
- to deaden as much as possible the first shock."
-
- "Have we not the water-cushions placed between the partition-
- breaks, whose elasticity will sufficiently protect us?"
-
- "I hope so, Michel," replied Barbicane gently, "but I am not sure."
-
- "Ah, the joker!" exclaimed Michel Ardan. "He hopes!--He is not
- sure!-- and he waits for the moment when we are encased to make
- this deplorable admission! I beg to be allowed to get out!"
-
- "And how?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Humph!" said Michel Ardan, "it is not easy; we are in the
- train, and the guard's whistle will sound before twenty-four
- minutes are over."
-
- "Twenty," said Nicholl.
-
- For some moments the three travelers looked at each other.
- Then they began to examine the objects imprisoned with them.
-
- "Everything is in its place," said Barbicane. "We have now to
- decide how we can best place ourselves to resist the shock.
- Position cannot be an indifferent matter; and we must, as much
- as possible, prevent the rush of blood to the head."
-
- "Just so," said Nicholl.
-
- "Then," replied Michel Ardan, ready to suit the action to the
- word, "let us put our heads down and our feet in the air, like
- the clowns in the grand circus."
-
- "No," said Barbicane, "let us stretch ourselves on our sides; we
- shall resist the shock better that way. Remember that, when the
- projectile starts, it matters little whether we are in it or
- before it; it amounts to much the same thing."
-
- "If it is only `much the same thing,' I may cheer up," said
- Michel Ardan.
-
- "Do you approve of my idea, Nicholl?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Entirely," replied the captain. "We've still thirteen minutes
- and a half."
-
- "That Nicholl is not a man," exclaimed Michel; "he is a
- chronometer with seconds, an escape, and eight holes."
-
- But his companions were not listening; they were taking up their
- last positions with the most perfect coolness. They were like
- two methodical travelers in a car, seeking to place themselves
- as comfortably as possible.
-
- We might well ask ourselves of what materials are the hearts of
- these Americans made, to whom the approach of the most frightful
- danger added no pulsation.
-
- Three thick and solidly-made couches had been placed in
- the projectile. Nicholl and Barbicane placed them in the
- center of the disc forming the floor. There the three
- travelers were to stretch themselves some moments before
- their departure.
-
- During this time, Ardan, not being able to keep still, turned in
- his narrow prison like a wild beast in a cage, chatting with his
- friends, speaking to the dogs Diana and Satellite, to whom, as
- may be seen, he had given significant names.
-
- "Ah, Diana! Ah, Satellite!" he exclaimed, teasing them; "so you
- are going to show the moon-dogs the good habits of the dogs of
- the earth! That will do honor to the canine race! If ever we
- do come down again, I will bring a cross type of `moon-dogs,'
- which will make a stir!"
-
- "If there _are_ dogs in the moon," said Barbicane.
-
- "There are," said Michel Ardan, "just as there are horses, cows,
- donkeys, and chickens. I bet that we shall find chickens."
-
- "A hundred dollars we shall find none!" said Nicholl.
-
- "Done, my captain!" replied Ardan, clasping Nicholl's hand.
- "But, by the bye, you have already lost three bets with our
- president, as the necessary funds for the enterprise have been
- found, as the operation of casting has been successful, and
- lastly, as the Columbiad has been loaded without accident, six
- thousand dollars."
-
- "Yes," replied Nicholl. "Thirty-seven minutes six seconds past ten."
-
- "It is understood, captain. Well, before another quarter of an
- hour you will have to count nine thousand dollars to the
- president; four thousand because the Columbiad will not burst,
- and five thousand because the projectile will rise more than six
- miles in the air."
-
- "I have the dollars," replied Nicholl, slapping the pocket of
- this coat. "I only ask to be allowed to pay."
-
- "Come, Nicholl. I see that you are a man of method, which
- I could never be; but indeed you have made a series of bets
- of very little advantage to yourself, allow me to tell you."
-
- "And why?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Because, if you gain the first, the Columbiad will have burst,
- and the projectile with it; and Barbicane will no longer be
- there to reimburse your dollars."
-
- "My stake is deposited at the bank in Baltimore," replied
- Barbicane simply; "and if Nicholl is not there, it will go to
- his heirs."
-
- "Ah, you practical men!" exclaimed Michel Ardan; "I admire you
- the more for not being able to understand you."
-
- "Forty-two minutes past ten!" said Nicholl.
-
- "Only five minutes more!" answered Barbicane.
-
- "Yes, five little minutes!" replied Michel Ardan; "and we are
- enclosed in a projectile, at the bottom of a gun 900 feet long!
- And under this projectile are rammed 400,000 pounds of gun-cotton,
- which is equal to 1,600,000 pounds of ordinary powder! And friend
- Murchison, with his chronometer in hand, his eye fixed on the
- needle, his finger on the electric apparatus, is counting the
- seconds preparatory to launching us into interplanetary space."
-
- "Enough, Michel, enough!" said Barbicane, in a serious voice;
- "let us prepare. A few instants alone separate us from an
- eventful moment. One clasp of the hand, my friends."
-
- "Yes," exclaimed Michel Ardan, more moved than he wished to
- appear; and the three bold companions were united in a last embrace.
-
- "God preserve us!" said the religious Barbicane.
-
- Michel Ardan and Nicholl stretched themselves on the couches
- placed in the center of the disc.
-
- "Forty-seven minutes past ten!" murmured the captain.
-
- "Twenty seconds more!" Barbicane quickly put out the gas and
- lay down by his companions, and the profound silence was only
- broken by the ticking of the chronometer marking the seconds.
-
- Suddenly a dreadful shock was felt, and the projectile, under
- the force of six billions of litres of gas, developed by the
- combustion of pyroxyle, mounted into space.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER II
-
-
- THE FIRST HALF-HOUR
-
-
- What had happened? What effect had this frightful shock produced?
- Had the ingenuity of the constructors of the projectile obtained
- any happy result? Had the shock been deadened, thanks to the
- springs, the four plugs, the water-cushions, and the partition-breaks?
- Had they been able to subdue the frightful pressure of the initiatory
- speed of more than 11,000 yards, which was enough to traverse Paris
- or New York in a second? This was evidently the question suggested
- to the thousand spectators of this moving scene. They forgot the
- aim of the journey, and thought only of the travelers. And if
- one of them-- Joseph T. Maston for example-- could have cast one
- glimpse into the projectile, what would he have seen?
-
- Nothing then. The darkness was profound. But its cylindro-
- conical partitions had resisted wonderfully. Not a rent or a
- dent anywhere! The wonderful projectile was not even heated
- under the intense deflagration of the powder, nor liquefied,
- as they seemed to fear, in a shower of aluminum.
-
- The interior showed but little disorder; indeed, only a few
- objects had been violently thrown toward the roof; but the most
- important seemed not to have suffered from the shock at all;
- their fixtures were intact.
-
- On the movable disc, sunk down to the bottom by the smashing of
- the partition-breaks and the escape of the water, three bodies
- lay apparently lifeless. Barbicane, Nicholl, and Michel Ardan--
- did they still breathe? or was the projectile nothing now but a
- metal coffin, bearing three corpses into space?
-
- Some minutes after the departure of the projectile, one of
- the bodies moved, shook its arms, lifted its head, and finally
- succeeded in getting on its knees. It was Michel Ardan. He felt
- himself all over, gave a sonorous "Hem!" and then said:
-
- "Michel Ardan is whole. How about the others?"
-
- The courageous Frenchman tried to rise, but could not stand.
- His head swam, from the rush of blood; he was blind; he was a
- drunken man.
-
- "Bur-r!" said he. "It produces the same effect as two bottles
- of Corton, though perhaps less agreeable to swallow."
- Then, passing his hand several times across his forehead and
- rubbing his temples, he called in a firm voice:
-
- "Nicholl! Barbicane!"
-
- He waited anxiously. No answer; not even a sigh to show that
- the hearts of his companions were still beating. He called again.
- The same silence.
-
- "The devil!" he exclaimed. "They look as if they had fallen
- from a fifth story on their heads. Bah!" he added, with that
- imperturbable confidence which nothing could check, "if a
- Frenchman can get on his knees, two Americans ought to be able
- to get on their feet. But first let us light up."
-
- Ardan felt the tide of life return by degrees. His blood became
- calm, and returned to its accustomed circulation. Another effort
- restored his equilibrium. He succeeded in rising, drew a match
- from his pocket, and approaching the burner lighted it.
- The receiver had not suffered at all. The gas had not escaped.
- Besides, the smell would have betrayed it; and in that case
- Michel Ardan could not have carried a lighted match with
- impunity through the space filled with hydrogen. The gas mixing
- with the air would have produced a detonating mixture, and the
- explosion would have finished what the shock had perhaps begun.
- When the burner was lit, Ardan leaned over the bodies of his
- companions: they were lying one on the other, an inert mass,
- Nicholl above, Barbicane underneath.
-
- Ardan lifted the captain, propped him up against the divan, and
- began to rub vigorously. This means, used with judgment,
- restored Nicholl, who opened his eyes, and instantly recovering
- his presence of mind, seized Ardan's hand and looked around him.
-
- "And Barbicane?" said he.
-
- "Each in turn," replied Michel Ardan. "I began with you,
- Nicholl, because you were on the top. Now let us look
- to Barbicane." Saying which, Ardan and Nicholl raised the
- president of the Gun Club and laid him on the divan. He seemed
- to have suffered more than either of his companions; he was
- bleeding, but Nicholl was reassured by finding that the
- hemorrhage came from a slight wound on the shoulder, a mere
- graze, which he bound up carefully.
-
- Still, Barbicane was a long time coming to himself, which
- frightened his friends, who did not spare friction.
-
- "He breathes though," said Nicholl, putting his ear to the chest
- of the wounded man.
-
- "Yes," replied Ardan, "he breathes like a man who has some
- notion of that daily operation. Rub, Nicholl; let us rub harder."
- And the two improvised practitioners worked so hard and so well
- that Barbicane recovered his senses. He opened his eyes, sat up,
- took his two friends by the hands, and his first words were--
-
- "Nicholl, are we moving?"
-
- Nicholl and Ardan looked at each other; they had not yet
- troubled themselves about the projectile; their first thought
- had been for the traveler, not for the car.
-
- "Well, are we really moving?" repeated Michel Ardan.
-
- "Or quietly resting on the soil of Florida?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Or at the bottom of the Gulf of Mexico?" added Michel Ardan.
-
- "What an idea!" exclaimed the president.
-
- And this double hypothesis suggested by his companions had the
- effect of recalling him to his senses. In any case they could
- not decide on the position of the projectile. Its apparent
- immovability, and the want of communication with the outside,
- prevented them from solving the question. Perhaps the projectile
- was unwinding its course through space. Perhaps after a short
- rise it had fallen upon the earth, or even in the Gulf of Mexico--
- a fall which the narrowness of the peninsula of Florida would
- render not impossible.
-
- The case was serious, the problem interesting, and one that must
- be solved as soon as possible. Thus, highly excited, Barbicane's
- moral energy triumphed over physical weakness, and he rose to
- his feet. He listened. Outside was perfect silence; but the
- thick padding was enough to intercept all sounds coming from
- the earth. But one circumstance struck Barbicane, viz., that
- the temperature inside the projectile was singularly high.
- The president drew a thermometer from its case and consulted it.
- The instrument showed 81@ Fahr.
-
- "Yes," he exclaimed, "yes, we are moving! This stifling heat,
- penetrating through the partitions of the projectile, is
- produced by its friction on the atmospheric strata. It will
- soon diminish, because we are already floating in space, and
- after having nearly stifled, we shall have to suffer intense cold.
-
- "What!" said Michel Ardan. "According to your showing, Barbicane,
- we are already beyond the limits of the terrestrial atmosphere?"
-
- "Without a doubt, Michel. Listen to me. It is fifty-five
- minutes past ten; we have been gone about eight minutes; and if
- our initiatory speed has not been checked by the friction, six
- seconds would be enough for us to pass through the forty miles
- of atmosphere which surrounds the globe."
-
- "Just so," replied Nicholl; "but in what proportion do you
- estimate the diminution of speed by friction?"
-
- "In the proportion of one-third, Nicholl. This diminution is
- considerable, but according to my calculations it is nothing less.
- If, then, we had an initiatory speed of 12,000 yards, on leaving
- the atmosphere this speed would be reduced to 9,165 yards. In any
- case we have already passed through this interval, and----"
-
- "And then," said Michel Ardan, "friend Nicholl has lost his two
- bets: four thousand dollars because the Columbiad did not burst;
- five thousand dollars because the projectile has risen more than
- six miles. Now, Nicholl, pay up."
-
- "Let us prove it first," said the captain, "and we will
- pay afterward. It is quite possible that Barbicane's reasoning
- is correct, and that I have lost my nine thousand dollars. But a
- new hypothesis presents itself to my mind, and it annuls the wager."
-
- "What is that?" asked Barbicane quickly.
-
- "The hypothesis that, for some reason or other, fire was never
- set to the powder, and we have not started at all."
-
- "My goodness, captain," exclaimed Michel Ardan, "that hypothesis
- is not worthy of my brain! It cannot be a serious one. For have
- we not been half annihilated by the shock? Did I not recall you
- to life? Is not the president's shoulder still bleeding from the
- blow it has received?"
-
- "Granted," replied Nicholl; "but one question."
-
- "Well, captain?"
-
- "Did you hear the detonation, which certainly ought to be loud?"
-
- "No," replied Ardan, much surprised; "certainly I did not hear
- the detonation."
-
- "And you, Barbicane?"
-
- "Nor I, either."
-
- "Very well," said Nicholl.
-
- "Well now," murmured the president "why did we not hear the detonation?"
-
- The three friends looked at each other with a disconcerted air.
- It was quite an inexplicable phenomenon. The projectile had
- started, and consequently there must have been a detonation.
-
- "Let us first find out where we are," said Barbicane, "and let
- down this panel."
-
- This very simple operation was soon accomplished.
-
- The nuts which held the bolts to the outer plates of the
- right-hand scuttle gave way under the pressure of the
- English wrench. These bolts were pushed outside, and the
- buffers covered with India-rubber stopped up the holes which let
- them through. Immediately the outer plate fell back upon its
- hinges like a porthole, and the lenticular glass which closed
- the scuttle appeared. A similar one was let into the thick
- partition on the opposite side of the projectile, another in the
- top of the dome, and finally a fourth in the middle of the base.
- They could, therefore, make observations in four different
- directions; the firmament by the side and most direct windows,
- the earth or the moon by the upper and under openings in
- the projectile.
-
- Barbicane and his two companions immediately rushed to the
- uncovered window. But it was lit by no ray of light.
- Profound darkness surrounded them, which, however, did not
- prevent the president from exclaiming:
-
- "No, my friends, we have not fallen back upon the earth; no, nor
- are we submerged in the Gulf of Mexico. Yes! we are mounting
- into space. See those stars shining in the night, and that
- impenetrable darkness heaped up between the earth and us!"
-
- "Hurrah! hurrah!" exclaimed Michel Ardan and Nicholl in one voice.
-
- Indeed, this thick darkness proved that the projectile had left
- the earth, for the soil, brilliantly lit by the moon-beams would
- have been visible to the travelers, if they had been lying on
- its surface. This darkness also showed that the projectile had
- passed the atmospheric strata, for the diffused light spread in
- the air would have been reflected on the metal walls, which
- reflection was wanting. This light would have lit the window,
- and the window was dark. Doubt was no longer possible; the
- travelers had left the earth.
-
- "I have lost," said Nicholl.
-
- "I congratulate you," replied Ardan.
-
- "Here are the nine thousand dollars," said the captain, drawing
- a roll of paper dollars from his pocket.
-
- "Will you have a receipt for it?" asked Barbicane, taking the sum.
-
- "If you do not mind," answered Nicholl; "it is more business-like."
-
- And coolly and seriously, as if he had been at his strong-box,
- the president drew forth his notebook, tore out a blank leaf,
- wrote a proper receipt in pencil, dated and signed it with the
- usual flourish, [1] and gave it to the captain, who carefully placed
- it in his pocketbook. Michel Ardan, taking off his hat, bowed to
- his two companions without speaking. So much formality under such
- circumstances left him speechless. He had never before seen
- anything so "American."
-
- [1] This is a purely French habit.
-
- This affair settled, Barbicane and Nicholl had returned to the
- window, and were watching the constellations. The stars looked
- like bright points on the black sky. But from that side they
- could not see the orb of night, which, traveling from east to
- west, would rise by degrees toward the zenith. Its absence drew
- the following remark from Ardan:
-
- "And the moon; will she perchance fail at our rendezvous?"
-
- "Do not alarm yourself," said Barbicane; "our future globe is at
- its post, but we cannot see her from this side; let us open the other."
-
- "As Barbicane was about leaving the window to open the opposite
- scuttle, his attention was attracted by the approach of a
- brilliant object. It was an enormous disc, whose colossal
- dimension could not be estimated. Its face, which was turned to
- the earth, was very bright. One might have thought it a small
- moon reflecting the light of the large one. She advanced with
- great speed, and seemed to describe an orbit round the earth,
- which would intersect the passage of the projectile. This body
- revolved upon its axis, and exhibited the phenomena of all
- celestial bodies abandoned in space.
-
- "Ah!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, "What is that? another projectile?"
-
- Barbicane did not answer. The appearance of this enormous body
- surprised and troubled him. A collision was possible, and might
- be attended with deplorable results; either the projectile would
- deviate from its path, or a shock, breaking its impetus, might
- precipitate it to earth; or, lastly, it might be irresistibly
- drawn away by the powerful asteroid. The president caught at a
- glance the consequences of these three hypotheses, either of
- which would, one way or the other, bring their experiment to an
- unsuccessful and fatal termination. His companions stood
- silently looking into space. The object grew rapidly as it
- approached them, and by an optical illusion the projectile
- seemed to be throwing itself before it.
-
- "By Jove!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, "we shall run into one another!"
-
- Instinctively the travelers drew back. Their dread was great,
- but it did not last many seconds. The asteroid passed several
- hundred yards from the projectile and disappeared, not so much
- from the rapidity of its course, as that its face being opposite
- the moon, it was suddenly merged into the perfect darkness of space.
-
- "A happy journey to you," exclaimed Michel Ardan, with a sigh
- of relief. "Surely infinity of space is large enough for a poor
- little projectile to walk through without fear. Now, what is
- this portentous globe which nearly struck us?"
-
- "I know," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Oh, indeed! you know everything."
-
- "It is," said Barbicane, "a simple meteorite, but an enormous one,
- which the attraction of the earth has retained as a satellite."
-
- "Is it possible!" exclaimed Michel Ardan; "the earth then has
- two moons like Neptune?"
-
- "Yes, my friends, two moons, though it passes generally for
- having only one; but this second moon is so small, and its
- speed so great, that the inhabitants of the earth cannot see it.
- It was by noticing disturbances that a French astronomer, M. Petit,
- was able to determine the existence of this second satellite and
- calculate its elements. According to his observations, this
- meteorite will accomplish its revolution around the earth in
- three hours and twenty minutes, which implies a wonderful rate
- of speed."
-
- "Do all astronomers admit the existence of this satellite?"
- asked Nicholl.
-
- "No," replied Barbicane; "but if, like us, they had met it, they
- could no longer doubt it. Indeed, I think that this meteorite,
- which, had it struck the projectile, would have much embarrassed
- us, will give us the means of deciding what our position in
- space is."
-
- "How?" said Ardan.
-
- "Because its distance is known, and when we met it, we were
- exactly four thousand six hundred and fifty miles from the
- surface of the terrestrial globe."
-
- "More than two thousand French leagues," exclaimed Michel Ardan.
- "That beats the express trains of the pitiful globe called the earth."
-
- "I should think so," replied Nicholl, consulting his
- chronometer; "it is eleven o'clock, and it is only thirteen
- minutes since we left the American continent."
-
- "Only thirteen minutes?" said Barbicane.
-
- "Yes," said Nicholl; "and if our initiatory speed of twelve
- thousand yards has been kept up, we shall have made about twenty
- thousand miles in the hour."
-
- "That is all very well, my friends," said the president, "but
- the insoluble question still remains. Why did we not hear the
- detonation of the Columbiad?"
-
- For want of an answer the conversation dropped, and Barbicane
- began thoughtfully to let down the shutter of the second side.
- He succeeded; and through the uncovered glass the moon filled
- the projectile with a brilliant light. Nicholl, as an
- economical man, put out the gas, now useless, and whose
- brilliancy prevented any observation of the inter-planetary space.
-
- The lunar disc shone with wonderful purity. Her rays, no longer
- filtered through the vapory atmosphere of the terrestrial globe,
- shone through the glass, filling the air in the interior of the
- projectile with silvery reflections. The black curtain of the
- firmament in reality heightened the moon's brilliancy, which in
- this void of ether unfavorable to diffusion did not eclipse the
- neighboring stars. The heavens, thus seen, presented quite a
- new aspect, and one which the human eye could never dream of.
- One may conceive the interest with which these bold men watched
- the orb of night, the great aim of their journey.
-
- In its motion the earth's satellite was insensibly nearing the
- zenith, the mathematical point which it ought to attain
- ninety-six hours later. Her mountains, her plains, every
- projection was as clearly discernible to their eyes as if they
- were observing it from some spot upon the earth; but its light
- was developed through space with wonderful intensity. The disc
- shone like a platinum mirror. Of the earth flying from under
- their feet, the travelers had lost all recollection.
-
- It was captain Nicholl who first recalled their attention to the
- vanishing globe.
-
- "Yes," said Michel Ardan, "do not let us be ungrateful to it.
- Since we are leaving our country, let our last looks be directed
- to it. I wish to see the earth once more before it is quite
- hidden from my eyes."
-
- To satisfy his companions, Barbicane began to uncover the window
- at the bottom of the projectile, which would allow them to
- observe the earth direct. The disc, which the force of the
- projection had beaten down to the base, was removed, not
- without difficulty. Its fragments, placed carefully against a wall,
- might serve again upon occasion. Then a circular gap appeared,
- nineteen inches in diameter, hollowed out of the lower part of
- the projectile. A glass cover, six inches thick and strengthened
- with upper fastenings, closed it tightly. Beneath was fixed an
- aluminum plate, held in place by bolts. The screws being undone,
- and the bolts let go, the plate fell down, and visible
- communication was established between the interior and the exterior.
-
- Michel Ardan knelt by the glass. It was cloudy, seemingly opaque.
-
- "Well!" he exclaimed, "and the earth?"
-
- "The earth?" said Barbicane. "There it is."
-
- "What! that little thread; that silver crescent?"
-
- "Doubtless, Michel. In four days, when the moon will be full,
- at the very time we shall reach it, the earth will be new, and
- will only appear to us as a slender crescent which will soon
- disappear, and for some days will be enveloped in utter darkness."
-
- "That the earth?" repeated Michel Ardan, looking with all his
- eyes at the thin slip of his native planet.
-
- The explanation given by President Barbicane was correct.
- The earth, with respect to the projectile, was entering its
- last phase. It was in its octant, and showed a crescent finely
- traced on the dark background of the sky. Its light, rendered
- bluish by the thick strata of the atmosphere was less intense
- than that of the crescent moon, but it was of considerable
- dimensions, and looked like an enormous arch stretched across
- the firmament. Some parts brilliantly lighted, especially on
- its concave part, showed the presence of high mountains, often
- disappearing behind thick spots, which are never seen on the
- lunar disc. They were rings of clouds placed concentrically
- round the terrestrial globe.
-
- While the travelers were trying to pierce the profound darkness,
- a brilliant cluster of shooting stars burst upon their eyes.
- Hundreds of meteorites, ignited by the friction of the
- atmosphere, irradiated the shadow of the luminous train, and
- lined the cloudy parts of the disc with their fire. At this
- period the earth was in its perihelion, and the month of
- December is so propitious to these shooting stars, that
- astronomers have counted as many as twenty-four thousand in
- an hour. But Michel Ardan, disdaining scientific reasonings,
- preferred thinking that the earth was thus saluting the
- departure of her three children with her most brilliant fireworks.
-
- Indeed this was all they saw of the globe lost in the solar
- world, rising and setting to the great planets like a simple
- morning or evening star! This globe, where they had left all
- their affections, was nothing more than a fugitive crescent!
-
- Long did the three friends look without speaking, though united
- in heart, while the projectile sped onward with an
- ever-decreasing speed. Then an irresistible drowsiness crept
- over their brain. Was it weariness of body and mind? No doubt;
- for after the over-excitement of those last hours passed upon
- earth, reaction was inevitable.
-
- "Well," said Nicholl, "since we must sleep, let us sleep."
-
- And stretching themselves on their couches, they were all three
- soon in a profound slumber.
-
- But they had not forgotten themselves more than a quarter of an
- hour, when Barbicane sat up suddenly, and rousing his companions
- with a loud voice, exclaimed----
-
- "I have found it!"
-
- "What have you found?" asked Michel Ardan, jumping from his bed.
-
- "The reason why we did not hear the detonation of the Columbiad."
-
- "And it is----?" said Nicholl.
-
- "Because our projectile traveled faster than the sound!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER III
-
-
- THEIR PLACE OF SHELTER
-
-
- This curious but certainly correct explanation once given, the
- three friends returned to their slumbers. Could they have found
- a calmer or more peaceful spot to sleep in? On the earth,
- houses, towns, cottages, and country feel every shock given to
- the exterior of the globe. On sea, the vessels rocked by the
- waves are still in motion; in the air, the balloon oscillates
- incessantly on the fluid strata of divers densities.
- This projectile alone, floating in perfect space, in the midst
- of perfect silence, offered perfect repose.
-
- Thus the sleep of our adventurous travelers might have been
- indefinitely prolonged, if an unexpected noise had not awakened
- them at about seven o'clock in the morning of the 2nd of
- December, eight hours after their departure.
-
- This noise was a very natural barking.
-
- "The dogs! it is the dogs!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, rising at once.
-
- "They are hungry," said Nicholl.
-
- "By Jove!" replied Michel, "we have forgotten them."
-
- "Where are they?" asked Barbicane.
-
- They looked and found one of the animals crouched under the divan.
- Terrified and shaken by the initiatory shock, it had remained
- in the corner till its voice returned with the pangs of hunger.
- It was the amiable Diana, still very confused, who crept out of
- her retreat, though not without much persuasion, Michel Ardan
- encouraging her with most gracious words.
-
- "Come, Diana," said he: "come, my girl! thou whose destiny will
- be marked in the cynegetic annals; thou whom the pagans would
- have given as companion to the god Anubis, and Christians as
- friend to St. Roch; thou who art rushing into interplanetary
- space, and wilt perhaps be the Eve of all Selenite dogs! come,
- Diana, come here."
-
- Diana, flattered or not, advanced by degrees, uttering
- plaintive cries.
-
- "Good," said Barbicane: "I see Eve, but where is Adam?"
-
- "Adam?" replied Michel; "Adam cannot be far off; he is there
- somewhere; we must call him. Satellite! here, Satellite!"
-
- But Satellite did not appear. Diana would not leave off howling.
- They found, however, that she was not bruised, and they gave her
- a pie, which silenced her complaints. As to Satellite, he seemed
- quite lost. They had to hunt a long time before finding him in
- one of the upper compartments of the projectile, whither some
- unaccountable shock must have violently hurled him. The poor
- beast, much hurt, was in a piteous state.
-
- "The devil!" said Michel.
-
- They brought the unfortunate dog down with great care. Its skull
- had been broken against the roof, and it seemed unlikely that he
- could recover from such a shock. Meanwhile, he was stretched
- comfortably on a cushion. Once there, he heaved a sigh.
-
- "We will take care of you," said Michel; "we are responsible for
- your existence. I would rather lose an arm than a paw of my
- poor Satellite."
-
- Saying which, he offered some water to the wounded dog, who
- swallowed it with avidity.
-
- This attention paid, the travelers watched the earth and the
- moon attentively. The earth was now only discernible by a
- cloudy disc ending in a crescent, rather more contracted than
- that of the previous evening; but its expanse was still
- enormous, compared with that of the moon, which was approaching
- nearer and nearer to a perfect circle.
-
- "By Jove!" said Michel Ardan, "I am really sorry that we did not
- start when the earth was full, that is to say, when our globe
- was in opposition to the sun."
-
- "Why?" said Nicholl.
-
- "Because we should have seen our continents and seas in a new
- light-- the first resplendent under the solar rays, the latter
- cloudy as represented on some maps of the world. I should like
- to have seen those poles of the earth on which the eye of man
- has never yet rested.
-
- "I dare say," replied Barbicane; "but if the earth had been
- _full_, the moon would have been _new_; that is to say,
- invisible, because of the rays of the sun. It is better
- for us to see the destination we wish to reach, than the point
- of departure."
-
- "You are right, Barbicane," replied Captain Nicholl; "and,
- besides, when we have reached the moon, we shall have time
- during the long lunar nights to consider at our leisure the
- globe on which our likenesses swarm."
-
- "Our likenesses!" exclaimed Michel Ardan; "They are no more our
- likenesses than the Selenites are! We inhabit a new world,
- peopled by ourselves-- the projectile! I am Barbicane's
- likeness, and Barbicane is Nicholl's. Beyond us, around us,
- human nature is at an end, and we are the only population of
- this microcosm until we become pure Selenites."
-
- "In about eighty-eight hours," replied the captain.
-
- "Which means to say?" asked Michel Ardan.
-
- "That it is half-past eight," replied Nicholl.
-
- "Very well," retorted Michel; "then it is impossible for me to
- find even the shadow of a reason why we should not go to breakfast."
-
- Indeed the inhabitants of the new star could not live without
- eating, and their stomachs were suffering from the imperious
- laws of hunger. Michel Ardan, as a Frenchman, was declared
- chief cook, an important function, which raised no rival.
- The gas gave sufficient heat for the culinary apparatus, and
- the provision box furnished the elements of this first feast.
-
- The breakfast began with three bowls of excellent soup, thanks to
- the liquefaction in hot water of those precious cakes of Liebig,
- prepared from the best parts of the ruminants of the Pampas.
- To the soup succeeded some beefsteaks, compressed by an hydraulic
- press, as tender and succulent as if brought straight from the
- kitchen of an English eating-house. Michel, who was imaginative,
- maintained that they were even "red."
-
- Preserved vegetables ("fresher than nature," said the amiable
- Michel) succeeded the dish of meat; and was followed by some
- cups of tea with bread and butter, after the American fashion.
-
- The beverage was declared exquisite, and was due to the
- infusion of the choicest leaves, of which the emperor of Russia
- had given some chests for the benefit of the travelers.
-
- And lastly, to crown the repast, Ardan had brought out a fine
- bottle of Nuits, which was found "by chance" in the
- provision-box. The three friends drank to the union of the
- earth and her satellite.
-
- And, as if he had not already done enough for the generous wine
- which he had distilled on the slopes of Burgundy, the sun chose
- to be part of the party. At this moment the projectile emerged
- from the conical shadow cast by the terrestrial globe, and the
- rays of the radiant orb struck the lower disc of the projectile
- direct occasioned by the angle which the moon's orbit makes with
- that of the earth.
-
- "The sun!" exclaimed Michel Ardan.
-
- "No doubt," replied Barbicane; "I expected it."
-
- "But," said Michel, "the conical shadow which the earth leaves
- in space extends beyond the moon?"
-
- "Far beyond it, if the atmospheric refraction is not taken into
- consideration," said Barbicane. "But when the moon is enveloped
- in this shadow, it is because the centers of the three stars,
- the sun, the earth, and the moon, are all in one and the same
- straight line. Then the _nodes_ coincide with the _phases_ of
- the moon, and there is an eclipse. If we had started when there
- was an eclipse of the moon, all our passage would have been in
- the shadow, which would have been a pity."
-
- "Why?"
-
- "Because, though we are floating in space, our projectile,
- bathed in the solar rays, will receive light and heat.
- It economizes the gas, which is in every respect a good economy."
-
- Indeed, under these rays which no atmosphere can temper, either
- in temperature or brilliancy, the projectile grew warm and
- bright, as if it had passed suddenly from winter to summer.
- The moon above, the sun beneath, were inundating it with their fire.
-
- "It is pleasant here," said Nicholl.
-
- "I should think so," said Michel Ardan. "With a little earth
- spread on our aluminum planet we should have green peas in
- twenty-four hours. I have but one fear, which is that the
- walls of the projectile might melt."
-
- "Calm yourself, my worthy friend," replied Barbicane; "the
- projectile withstood a very much higher temperature than this as
- it slid through the strata of the atmosphere. I should not be
- surprised if it did not look like a meteor on fire to the eyes
- of the spectators in Florida."
-
- "But then J. T. Maston will think we are roasted!"
-
- "What astonishes me," said Barbicane, "is that we have not been.
- That was a danger we had not provided for."
-
- "I feared it," said Nicholl simply.
-
- "And you never mentioned it, my sublime captain," exclaimed
- Michel Ardan, clasping his friend's hand.
-
- Barbicane now began to settle himself in the projectile as if he
- was never to leave it. One must remember that this aerial car
- had a base with a _superficies_ of fifty-four square feet.
- Its height to the roof was twelve feet. Carefully laid out in
- the inside, and little encumbered by instruments and traveling
- utensils, which each had their particular place, it left the
- three travelers a certain freedom of movement. The thick window
- inserted in the bottom could bear any amount of weight, and
- Barbicane and his companions walked upon it as if it were solid
- plank; but the sun striking it directly with its rays lit the
- interior of the projectile from beneath, thus producing singular
- effects of light.
-
- They began by investigating the state of their store of water
- and provisions, neither of which had suffered, thanks to the
- care taken to deaden the shock. Their provisions were abundant,
- and plentiful enough to last the three travelers for more than
- a year. Barbicane wished to be cautious, in case the projectile
- should land on a part of the moon which was utterly barren.
- As to water and the reserve of brandy, which consisted of fifty
- gallons, there was only enough for two months; but according to
- the last observations of astronomers, the moon had a low, dense,
- and thick atmosphere, at least in the deep valleys, and there
- springs and streams could not fail. Thus, during their passage,
- and for the first year of their settlement on the lunar
- continent, these adventurous explorers would suffer neither
- hunger nor thirst.
-
- Now about the air in the projectile. There, too, they were secure.
- Reiset and Regnaut's apparatus, intended for the production of
- oxygen, was supplied with chlorate of potassium for two months.
- They necessarily consumed a certain quantity of gas, for they
- were obliged to keep the producing substance at a temperature
- of above 400@. But there again they were all safe. The apparatus
- only wanted a little care. But it was not enough to renew the
- oxygen; they must absorb the carbonic acid produced by expiration.
- During the last twelve hours the atmosphere of the projectile had
- become charged with this deleterious gas. Nicholl discovered
- the state of the air by observing Diana panting painfully.
- The carbonic acid, by a phenomenon similar to that produced in
- the famous Grotto del Cane, had collected at the bottom of the
- projectile owing to its weight. Poor Diana, with her head low,
- would suffer before her masters from the presence of this gas.
- But Captain Nicholl hastened to remedy this state of things,
- by placing on the floor several receivers containing caustic
- potash, which he shook about for a time, and this substance,
- greedy of carbonic acid, soon completely absorbed it, thus
- purifying the air.
-
- An inventory of instruments was then begun. The thermometers
- and barometers had resisted, all but one minimum thermometer,
- the glass of which was broken. An excellent aneroid was drawn
- from the wadded box which contained it and hung on the wall.
- Of course it was only affected by and marked the pressure of the
- air inside the projectile, but it also showed the quantity of
- moisture which it contained. At that moment its needle
- oscillated between 25.24 and 25.08.
-
- It was fine weather.
-
- Barbicane had also brought several compasses, which he found intact.
- One must understand that under present conditions their needles
- were acting _wildly_, that is without any _constant_ direction.
- Indeed, at the distance they were from the earth, the magnetic
- pole could have no perceptible action upon the apparatus; but
- the box placed on the lunar disc might perhaps exhibit some
- strange phenomena. In any case it would be interesting to see
- whether the earth's satellite submitted like herself to its
- magnetic influence.
-
- A hypsometer to measure the height of the lunar mountains, a
- sextant to take the height of the sun, glasses which would be
- useful as they neared the moon, all these instruments were
- carefully looked over, and pronounced good in spite of the
- violent shock.
-
- As to the pickaxes and different tools which were Nicholl's
- especial choice; as to the sacks of different kinds of grain and
- shrubs which Michel Ardan hoped to transplant into Selenite
- ground, they were stowed away in the upper part of the projectile.
- There was a sort of granary there, loaded with things which the
- extravagant Frenchman had heaped up. What they were no one knew,
- and the good-tempered fellow did not explain. Now and then he
- climbed up by cramp-irons riveted to the walls, but kept the
- inspection to himself. He arranged and rearranged, he plunged
- his hand rapidly into certain mysterious boxes, singing in one
- of the falsest of voices an old French refrain to enliven
- the situation.
-
- Barbicane observed with some interest that his guns and other
- arms had not been damaged. These were important, because,
- heavily loaded, they were to help lessen the fall of the
- projectile, when drawn by the lunar attraction (after having
- passed the point of neutral attraction) on to the moon's
- surface; a fall which ought to be six times less rapid than it
- would have been on the earth's surface, thanks to the difference
- of bulk. The inspection ended with general satisfaction, when
- each returned to watch space through the side windows and the
- lower glass coverlid.
-
- There was the same view. The whole extent of the celestial
- sphere swarmed with stars and constellations of wonderful
- purity, enough to drive an astronomer out of his mind! On one
- side the sun, like the mouth of a lighted oven, a dazzling disc
- without a halo, standing out on the dark background of the sky!
- On the other, the moon returning its fire by reflection, and
- apparently motionless in the midst of the starry world. Then, a
- large spot seemingly nailed to the firmament, bordered by a
- silvery cord; it was the earth! Here and there nebulous masses
- like large flakes of starry snow; and from the zenith to the nadir,
- an immense ring formed by an impalpable dust of stars, the "Milky
- Way," in the midst of which the sun ranks only as a star of the
- fourth magnitude. The observers could not take their eyes from
- this novel spectacle, of which no description could give an
- adequate idea. What reflections it suggested! What emotions
- hitherto unknown awoke in their souls! Barbicane wished to begin
- the relation of his journey while under its first impressions,
- and hour after hour took notes of all facts happening in the
- beginning of the enterprise. He wrote quietly, with his large
- square writing, in a business-like style.
-
- During this time Nicholl, the calculator, looked over the
- minutes of their passage, and worked out figures with
- unparalleled dexterity. Michel Ardan chatted first with
- Barbicane, who did not answer him, and then with Nicholl, who
- did not hear him, with Diana, who understood none of his
- theories, and lastly with himself, questioning and answering,
- going and coming, busy with a thousand details; at one time bent
- over the lower glass, at another roosting in the heights of the
- projectile, and always singing. In this microcosm he
- represented French loquacity and excitability, and we beg you to
- believe that they were well represented. The day, or rather
- (for the expression is not correct) the lapse of twelve hours,
- which forms a day upon the earth, closed with a plentiful supper
- carefully prepared. No accident of any nature had yet happened
- to shake the travelers' confidence; so, full of hope, already
- sure of success, they slept peacefully, while the projectile
- under an uniformly decreasing speed was crossing the sky.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IV
-
-
- A LITTLE ALGEBRA
-
-
- The night passed without incident. The word "night," however,
- is scarcely applicable.
-
- The position of the projectile with regard to the sun did
- not change. Astronomically, it was daylight on the lower part,
- and night on the upper; so when during this narrative these
- words are used, they represent the lapse of time between rising
- and setting of the sun upon the earth.
-
- The travelers' sleep was rendered more peaceful by the
- projectile's excessive speed, for it seemed absolutely motionless.
- Not a motion betrayed its onward course through space. The rate
- of progress, however rapid it might be, cannot produce any
- sensible effect on the human frame when it takes place in a
- vacuum, or when the mass of air circulates with the body which
- is carried with it. What inhabitant of the earth perceives its
- speed, which, however, is at the rate of 68,000 miles per hour?
- Motion under such conditions is "felt" no more than repose; and
- when a body is in repose it will remain so as long as no strange
- force displaces it; if moving, it will not stop unless an
- obstacle comes in its way. This indifference to motion or
- repose is called inertia.
-
- Barbicane and his companions might have believed themselves
- perfectly stationary, being shut up in the projectile; indeed,
- the effect would have been the same if they had been on the
- outside of it. Had it not been for the moon, which was
- increasing above them, they might have sworn that they were
- floating in complete stagnation.
-
- That morning, the 3rd of December, the travelers were awakened by
- a joyous but unexpected noise; it was the crowing of a cock
- which sounded through the car. Michel Ardan, who was the first
- on his feet, climbed to the top of the projectile, and shutting
- a box, the lid of which was partly open, said in a low voice,
- "Will you hold your tongue? That creature will spoil my design!"
-
- But Nicholl and Barbicane were awake.
-
- "A cock!" said Nicholl.
-
- "Why no, my friends," Michel answered quickly; "it was I who
- wished to awake you by this rural sound." So saying, he gave
- vent to a splendid cock-a-doodledoo, which would have done honor
- to the proudest of poultry-yards.
-
- The two Americans could not help laughing.
-
- "Fine talent that," said Nicholl, looking suspiciously at his companion.
-
- "Yes," said Michel; "a joke in my country. It is very Gallic;
- they play the cock so in the best society."
-
- Then turning the conversation:
-
- "Barbicane, do you know what I have been thinking of all night?"
-
- "No," answered the president.
-
- "Of our Cambridge friends. You have already remarked that I am
- an ignoramus in mathematical subjects; and it is impossible for
- me to find out how the savants of the observatory were able to
- calculate what initiatory speed the projectile ought to have on
- leaving the Columbiad in order to attain the moon."
-
- "You mean to say," replied Barbicane, "to attain that neutral
- point where the terrestrial and lunar attractions are equal;
- for, starting from that point, situated about nine-tenths of the
- distance traveled over, the projectile would simply fall upon
- the moon, on account of its weight."
-
- "So be it," said Michel; "but, once more; how could they
- calculate the initiatory speed?"
-
- "Nothing can be easier," replied Barbicane.
-
- "And you knew how to make that calculation?" asked Michel Ardan.
-
- "Perfectly. Nicholl and I would have made it, if the
- observatory had not saved us the trouble."
-
- "Very well, old Barbicane," replied Michel; "they might have cut
- off my head, beginning at my feet, before they could have made
- me solve that problem."
-
- "Because you do not know algebra," answered Barbicane quietly.
-
- "Ah, there you are, you eaters of _x_^1; you think you have said
- all when you have said `Algebra.'"
-
- "Michel," said Barbicane, "can you use a forge without a hammer,
- or a plow without a plowshare?"
-
- "Hardly."
-
- "Well, algebra is a tool, like the plow or the hammer, and a
- good tool to those who know how to use it."
-
- "Seriously?"
-
- "Quite seriously."
-
- "And can you use that tool in my presence?"
-
- "If it will interest you."
-
- "And show me how they calculated the initiatory speed of our car?"
-
- "Yes, my worthy friend; taking into consideration all the
- elements of the problem, the distance from the center of the
- earth to the center of the moon, of the radius of the earth, of
- its bulk, and of the bulk of the moon, I can tell exactly what
- ought to be the initiatory speed of the projectile, and that by
- a simple formula."
-
- "Let us see."
-
- "You shall see it; only I shall not give you the real course
- drawn by the projectile between the moon and the earth in
- considering their motion round the sun. No, I shall consider
- these two orbs as perfectly motionless, which will answer all
- our purpose."
-
- "And why?"
-
- "Because it will be trying to solve the problem called `the
- problem of the three bodies,' for which the integral calculus is
- not yet far enough advanced."
-
- "Then," said Michel Ardan, in his sly tone, "mathematics have
- not said their last word?"
-
- "Certainly not," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Well, perhaps the Selenites have carried the integral calculus
- farther than you have; and, by the bye, what is this
- `integral calculus?'"
-
- "It is a calculation the converse of the differential," replied
- Barbicane seriously.
-
- "Much obliged; it is all very clear, no doubt."
-
- "And now," continued Barbicane, "a slip of paper and a bit of
- pencil, and before a half-hour is over I will have found the
- required formula."
-
- Half an hour had not elapsed before Barbicane, raising his head,
- showed Michel Ardan a page covered with algebraical signs, in
- which the general formula for the solution was contained.
-
- "Well, and does Nicholl understand what that means?"
-
- "Of course, Michel," replied the captain. "All these signs,
- which seem cabalistic to you, form the plainest, the clearest,
- and the most logical language to those who know how to read it."
-
- "And you pretend, Nicholl," asked Michel, "that by means of
- these hieroglyphics, more incomprehensible than the Egyptian
- Ibis, you can find what initiatory speed it was necessary to
- give the projectile?"
-
- "Incontestably," replied Nicholl; "and even by this same formula
- I can always tell you its speed at any point of its transit."
-
- "On your word?"
-
- "On my word."
-
- "Then you are as cunning as our president."
-
- "No, Michel; the difficult part is what Barbicane has done; that
- is, to get an equation which shall satisfy all the conditions of
- the problem. The remainder is only a question of arithmetic,
- requiring merely the knowledge of the four rules."
-
- "That is something!" replied Michel Ardan, who for his life
- could not do addition right, and who defined the rule as a
- Chinese puzzle, which allowed one to obtain all sorts of totals.
-
- "The expression _v_ zero, which you see in that equation, is the
- speed which the projectile will have on leaving the atmosphere."
-
- "Just so," said Nicholl; "it is from that point that we must
- calculate the velocity, since we know already that the velocity
- at departure was exactly one and a half times more than on
- leaving the atmosphere."
-
- "I understand no more," said Michel.
-
- "It is a very simple calculation," said Barbicane.
-
- "Not as simple as I am," retorted Michel.
-
- "That means, that when our projectile reached the limits of the
- terrestrial atmosphere it had already lost one-third of its
- initiatory speed."
-
- "As much as that?"
-
- "Yes, my friend; merely by friction against the atmospheric strata.
- You understand that the faster it goes the more resistance it meets
- with from the air."
-
- "That I admit," answered Michel; "and I understand it,
- although your x's and zero's, and algebraic formula, are
- rattling in my head like nails in a bag."
-
- "First effects of algebra," replied Barbicane; "and now, to
- finish, we are going to prove the given number of these
- different expressions, that is, work out their value."
-
- "Finish me!" replied Michel.
-
- Barbicane took the paper, and began to make his calculations
- with great rapidity. Nicholl looked over and greedily read the
- work as it proceeded.
-
- "That's it! that's it!" at last he cried.
-
- "Is it clear?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "It is written in letters of fire," said Nicholl.
-
- "Wonderful fellows!" muttered Ardan.
-
- "Do you understand it at last?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Do I understand it?" cried Ardan; "my head is splitting with it."
-
- "And now," said Nicholl, "to find out the speed of the
- projectile when it leaves the atmosphere, we have only to
- calculate that."
-
- The captain, as a practical man equal to all difficulties, began
- to write with frightful rapidity. Divisions and multiplications
- grew under his fingers; the figures were like hail on the white page.
- Barbicane watched him, while Michel Ardan nursed a growing headache
- with both hands.
-
- "Very well?" asked Barbicane, after some minutes' silence.
-
- "Well!" replied Nicholl; every calculation made, _v_ zero, that
- is to say, the speed necessary for the projectile on leaving the
- atmosphere, to enable it to reach the equal point of attraction,
- ought to be----"
-
- "Yes?" said Barbicane.
-
- "Twelve thousand yards."
-
- "What!" exclaimed Barbicane, starting; "you say----"
-
- "Twelve thousand yards."
-
- "The devil!" cried the president, making a gesture of despair.
-
- "What is the matter?" asked Michel Ardan, much surprised.
-
- "What is the matter! why, if at this moment our speed had
- already diminished one-third by friction, the initiatory speed
- ought to have been----"
-
- "Seventeen thousand yards."
-
- "And the Cambridge Observatory declared that twelve thousand
- yards was enough at starting; and our projectile, which only
- started with that speed----"
-
- "Well?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Well, it will not be enough."
-
- "Good."
-
- "We shall not be able to reach the neutral point."
-
- "The deuce!"
-
- "We shall not even get halfway."
-
- "In the name of the projectile!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, jumping
- as if it was already on the point of striking the terrestrial globe.
-
- "And we shall fall back upon the earth!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER V
-
-
- THE COLD OF SPACE
-
-
- This revelation came like a thunderbolt. Who could have
- expected such an error in calculation? Barbicane would not
- believe it. Nicholl revised his figures: they were exact.
- As to the formula which had determined them, they could not
- suspect its truth; it was evident that an initiatory velocity of
- seventeen thousand yards in the first second was necessary to
- enable them to reach the neutral point.
-
- The three friends looked at each other silently. There was no
- thought of breakfast. Barbicane, with clenched teeth, knitted
- brows, and hands clasped convulsively, was watching through
- the window. Nicholl had crossed his arms, and was examining
- his calculations. Michel Ardan was muttering:
-
- "That is just like these scientific men: they never do anything else.
- I would give twenty pistoles if we could fall upon the Cambridge
- Observatory and crush it, together with the whole lot of dabblers
- in figures which it contains."
-
- Suddenly a thought struck the captain, which he at once
- communicated to Barbicane.
-
- "Ah!" said he; "it is seven o'clock in the morning; we have
- already been gone thirty-two hours; more than half our passage
- is over, and we are not falling that I am aware of."
-
- Barbicane did not answer, but after a rapid glance at the
- captain, took a pair of compasses wherewith to measure the
- angular distance of the terrestrial globe; then from the lower
- window he took an exact observation, and noticed that the
- projectile was apparently stationary. Then rising and wiping
- his forehead, on which large drops of perspiration were
- standing, he put some figures on paper. Nicholl understood that
- the president was deducting from the terrestrial diameter the
- projectile's distance from the earth. He watched him anxiously.
-
- "No," exclaimed Barbicane, after some moments, "no, we are not
- falling! no, we are already more than 50,000 leagues from the earth.
- We have passed the point at which the projectile would have stopped
- if its speed had only been 12,000 yards at starting. We are still
- going up."
-
- "That is evident," replied Nicholl; "and we must conclude that
- our initial speed, under the power of the 400,000 pounds of
- gun-cotton, must have exceeded the required 12,000 yards.
- Now I can understand how, after thirteen minutes only, we met the
- second satellite, which gravitates round the earth at more than
- 2,000 leagues' distance."
-
- "And this explanation is the more probable," added Barbicane,
- "Because, in throwing off the water enclosed between its
- partition-breaks, the projectile found itself lightened of a
- considerable weight."
-
- "Just so," said Nicholl.
-
- "Ah, my brave Nicholl, we are saved!"
-
- "Very well then," said Michel Ardan quietly; "as we are safe,
- let us have breakfast."
-
- Nicholl was not mistaken. The initial speed had been, very
- fortunately, much above that estimated by the Cambridge
- Observatory; but the Cambridge Observatory had nevertheless made
- a mistake.
-
- The travelers, recovered from this false alarm, breakfasted merrily.
- If they ate a good deal, they talked more. Their confidence was
- greater after than before "the incident of the algebra."
-
- "Why should we not succeed?" said Michel Ardan; "why should we
- not arrive safely? We are launched; we have no obstacle before
- us, no stones in the way; the road is open, more so than that of
- a ship battling with the sea; more open than that of a balloon
- battling with the wind; and if a ship can reach its destination,
- a balloon go where it pleases, why cannot our projectile attain
- its end and aim?"
-
- "It _will_ attain it," said Barbicane.
-
- "If only to do honor to the Americans," added Michel Ardan, "the
- only people who could bring such an enterprise to a happy termination,
- and the only one which could produce a President Barbicane. Ah, now
- we are no longer uneasy, I begin to think, What will become of us?
- We shall get right royally weary."
-
- Barbicane and Nicholl made a gesture of denial.
-
- "But I have provided for the contingency, my friends," replied
- Michel; "you have only to speak, and I have chess, draughts,
- cards, and dominoes at your disposal; nothing is wanting but a
- billiard-table."
-
- "What!" exclaimed Barbicane; "you brought away such trifles?"
-
- "Certainly," replied Michel, "and not only to distract
- ourselves, but also with the laudable intention of endowing the
- Selenite smoking divans with them."
-
- "My friend," said Barbicane, "if the moon is inhabited, its
- inhabitants must have appeared some thousands of years before
- those of the earth, for we cannot doubt that their star is much
- older than ours. If then these Selenites have existed their
- hundreds of thousands of years, and if their brain is of the same
- organization of the human brain, they have already invented all
- that we have invented, and even what we may invent in future ages.
- They have nothing to learn from _us_, and we have everything to
- learn from _them_."
-
- "What!" said Michel; "you believe that they have artists like
- Phidias, Michael Angelo, or Raphael?"
-
- "Yes."
-
- "Poets like Homer, Virgil, Milton, Lamartine, and Hugo?"
-
- "I am sure of it."
-
- "Philosophers like Plato, Aristotle, Descartes, Kant?"
-
- "I have no doubt of it."
-
- "Scientific men like Archimedes, Euclid, Pascal, Newton?"
-
- "I could swear it."
-
- "Comic writers like Arnal, and photographers like-- like Nadar?"
-
- "Certain."
-
- "Then, friend Barbicane, if they are as strong as we are, and
- even stronger-- these Selenites-- why have they not tried to
- communicate with the earth? why have they not launched a lunar
- projectile to our terrestrial regions?"
-
- "Who told you that they have never done so?" said Barbicane seriously.
-
- "Indeed," added Nicholl, "it would be easier for them than for
- us, for two reasons; first, because the attraction on the moon's
- surface is six times less than on that of the earth, which would
- allow a projectile to rise more easily; secondly, because it
- would be enough to send such a projectile only at 8,000 leagues
- instead of 80,000, which would require the force of projection
- to be ten times less strong."
-
- "Then," continued Michel, "I repeat it, why have they not done it?"
-
- "And I repeat," said Barbicane; "who told you that they have not
- done it?"
-
- "When?"
-
- "Thousands of years before man appeared on earth."
-
- "And the projectile-- where is the projectile? I demand to see
- the projectile."
-
- "My friend," replied Barbicane, "the sea covers five-sixths of
- our globe. From that we may draw five good reasons for
- supposing that the lunar projectile, if ever launched, is now at
- the bottom of the Atlantic or the Pacific, unless it sped into
- some crevasse at that period when the crust of the earth was not
- yet hardened."
-
- "Old Barbicane," said Michel, "you have an answer for
- everything, and I bow before your wisdom. But there is one
- hypothesis that would suit me better than all the others, which
- is, the Selenites, being older than we, are wiser, and have not
- invented gunpowder."
-
- At this moment Diana joined in the conversation by a sonorous barking.
- She was asking for her breakfast.
-
- "Ah!" said Michel Ardan, "in our discussion we have forgotten
- Diana and Satellite."
-
- Immediately a good-sized pie was given to the dog, which
- devoured it hungrily.
-
- "Do you see, Barbicane," said Michel, "we should have made a
- second Noah's ark of this projectile, and borne with us to the
- moon a couple of every kind of domestic animal."
-
- "I dare say; but room would have failed us."
-
- "Oh!" said Michel, "we might have squeezed a little."
-
- "The fact is," replied Nicholl, "that cows, bulls, and horses,
- and all ruminants, would have been very useful on the lunar
- continent, but unfortunately the car could neither have been
- made a stable nor a shed."
-
- "Well, we might have at least brought a donkey, only a little
- donkey; that courageous beast which old Silenus loved to mount.
- I love those old donkeys; they are the least favored animals in
- creation; they are not only beaten while alive, but even after
- they are dead."
-
- "How do you make that out?" asked Barbicane. "Why," said
- Michel, "they make their skins into drums."
-
- Barbicane and Nicholl could not help laughing at this ridiculous remark.
- But a cry from their merry companion stopped them. The latter was
- leaning over the spot where Satellite lay. He rose, saying:
-
- "My good Satellite is no longer ill."
-
- "Ah!" said Nicholl.
-
- "No," answered Michel, "he is dead! There," added he, in a
- piteous tone, "that is embarrassing. I much fear, my poor
- Diana, that you will leave no progeny in the lunar regions!"
-
- Indeed the unfortunate Satellite had not survived its wound.
- It was quite dead. Michel Ardan looked at his friends with a
- rueful countenance.
-
- "One question presents itself," said Barbicane. "We cannot keep
- the dead body of this dog with us for the next forty-eight hours."
-
- "No! certainly not," replied Nicholl; "but our scuttles are
- fixed on hinges; they can be let down. We will open one, and
- throw the body out into space."
-
- The president thought for some moments, and then said:
-
- "Yes, we must do so, but at the same time taking very great precautions."
-
- "Why?" asked Michel.
-
- "For two reasons which you will understand," answered Barbicane.
- "The first relates to the air shut up in the projectile, and of
- which we must lose as little as possible."
-
- "But we manufacture the air?"
-
- "Only in part. We make only the oxygen, my worthy Michel; and
- with regard to that, we must watch that the apparatus does not
- furnish the oxygen in too great a quantity; for an excess would
- bring us very serious physiological troubles. But if we make
- the oxygen, we do not make the azote, that medium which the
- lungs do not absorb, and which ought to remain intact; and that
- azote will escape rapidly through the open scuttles."
-
- "Oh! the time for throwing out poor Satellite?" said Michel.
-
- "Agreed; but we must act quickly."
-
- "And the second reason?" asked Michel.
-
- "The second reason is that we must not let the outer cold, which
- is excessive, penetrate the projectile or we shall be frozen to death."
-
- "But the sun?"
-
- "The sun warms our projectile, which absorbs its rays; but it
- does not warm the vacuum in which we are floating at this moment.
- Where there is no air, there is no more heat than diffused light;
- and the same with darkness; it is cold where the sun's rays do not
- strike direct. This temperature is only the temperature produced
- by the radiation of the stars; that is to say, what the
- terrestrial globe would undergo if the sun disappeared one day."
-
- "Which is not to be feared," replied Nicholl.
-
- "Who knows?" said Michel Ardan. "But, in admitting that the sun
- does not go out, might it not happen that the earth might move
- away from it?"
-
- "There!" said Barbicane, "there is Michel with his ideas."
-
- "And," continued Michel, "do we not know that in 1861 the earth
- passed through the tail of a comet? Or let us suppose a comet
- whose power of attraction is greater than that of the sun.
- The terrestrial orbit will bend toward the wandering star, and
- the earth, becoming its satellite, will be drawn such a distance
- that the rays of the sun will have no action on its surface."
-
- "That _might_ happen, indeed," replied Barbicane, "but the
- consequences of such a displacement need not be so formidable as
- you suppose."
-
- "And why not?"
-
- "Because the heat and cold would be equalized on our globe.
- It has been calculated that, had our earth been carried along in
- its course by the comet of 1861, at its perihelion, that is, its
- nearest approach to the sun, it would have undergone a heat
- 28,000 times greater than that of summer. But this heat, which
- is sufficient to evaporate the waters, would have formed a thick
- ring of cloud, which would have modified that excessive
- temperature; hence the compensation between the cold of the
- aphelion and the heat of the perihelion."
-
- "At how many degrees," asked Nicholl, "is the temperature of the
- planetary spaces estimated?"
-
- "Formerly," replied Barbicane, "it was greatly exagerated; but
- now, after the calculations of Fourier, of the French Academy of
- Science, it is not supposed to exceed 60@ Centigrade below zero."
-
- "Pooh!" said Michel, "that's nothing!"
-
- "It is very much," replied Barbicane; "the temperature which was
- observed in the polar regions, at Melville Island and Fort
- Reliance, that is 76@ Fahrenheit below zero."
-
- "If I mistake not," said Nicholl, "M. Pouillet, another savant,
- estimates the temperature of space at 250@ Fahrenheit below zero.
- We shall, however, be able to verify these calculations for ourselves."
-
- "Not at present; because the solar rays, beating directly
- upon our thermometer, would give, on the contrary, a very high
- temperature. But, when we arrive in the moon, during its
- fifteen days of night at either face, we shall have leisure to
- make the experiment, for our satellite lies in a vacuum."
-
- "What do you mean by a vacuum?" asked Michel. "Is it perfectly such?"
-
- "It is absolutely void of air."
-
- "And is the air replaced by nothing whatever?"
-
- "By the ether only," replied Barbicane.
-
- "And pray what is the ether?"
-
- "The ether, my friend, is an agglomeration of imponderable
- atoms, which, relatively to their dimensions, are as far removed
- from each other as the celestial bodies are in space. It is
- these atoms which, by their vibratory motion, produce both light
- and heat in the universe."
-
- They now proceeded to the burial of Satellite. They had merely
- to drop him into space, in the same way that sailors drop a body
- into the sea; but, as President Barbicane suggested, they must
- act quickly, so as to lose as little as possible of that air
- whose elasticity would rapidly have spread it into space.
- The bolts of the right scuttle, the opening of which measured
- about twelve inches across, were carefully drawn, while Michel,
- quite grieved, prepared to launch his dog into space. The glass,
- raised by a powerful lever, which enabled it to overcome the
- pressure of the inside air on the walls of the projectile,
- turned rapidly on its hinges, and Satellite was thrown out.
- Scarcely a particle of air could have escaped, and the operation
- was so successful that later on Barbicane did not fear to
- dispose of the rubbish which encumbered the car.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VI
-
-
- QUESTION AND ANSWER
-
-
- On the 4th of December, when the travelers awoke after
- fifty-four hours' journey, the chronometer marked five o'clock
- of the terrestrial morning. In time it was just over five
- hours and forty minutes, half of that assigned to their sojourn
- in the projectile; but they had already accomplished nearly
- seven-tenths of the way. This peculiarity was due to their
- regularly decreasing speed.
-
- Now when they observed the earth through the lower window,
- it looked like nothing more than a dark spot, drowned in the
- solar rays. No more crescent, no more cloudy light! The next
- day, at midnight, the earth would be _new_, at the very moment
- when the moon would be full. Above, the orb of night was nearing
- the line followed by the projectile, so as to meet it at the
- given hour. All around the black vault was studded with brilliant
- points, which seemed to move slowly; but, at the great distance
- they were from them, their relative size did not seem to change.
- The sun and stars appeared exactly as they do to us upon earth.
- As to the moon, she was considerably larger; but the travelers'
- glasses, not very powerful, did not allow them as yet to make
- any useful observations upon her surface, or reconnoiter her
- topographically or geologically.
-
- Thus the time passed in never-ending conversations all about
- the moon. Each one brought forward his own contingent of
- particular facts; Barbicane and Nicholl always serious, Michel
- Ardan always enthusiastic. The projectile, its situation,
- its direction, incidents which might happen, the precautions
- necessitated by their fall on to the moon, were inexhaustible
- matters of conjecture.
-
- As they were breakfasting, a question of Michel's, relating to
- the projectile, provoked rather a curious answer from Barbicane,
- which is worth repeating. Michel, supposing it to be roughly
- stopped, while still under its formidable initial speed, wished
- to know what the consequences of the stoppage would have been.
-
- "But," said Barbicane, "I do not see how it could have been stopped."
-
- "But let us suppose so," said Michel.
-
- "It is an impossible supposition," said the practical Barbicane;
- "unless that impulsive force had failed; but even then its speed
- would diminish by degrees, and it would not have stopped suddenly."
-
- "Admit that it had struck a body in space."
-
- "What body?"
-
- "Why that enormous meteor which we met."
-
- "Then," said Nicholl, "the projectile would have been broken
- into a thousand pieces, and we with it."
-
- "More than that," replied Barbicane; "we should have been burned
- to death."
-
- "Burned?" exclaimed Michel, "by Jove! I am sorry it did not
- happen, `just to see.'"
-
- "And you would have seen," replied Barbicane. "It is known now
- that heat is only a modification of motion. When water is
- warmed-- that is to say, when heat is added to it--its particles
- are set in motion."
-
- "Well," said michel, "that is an ingenious theory!"
-
- "And a true one, my worthy friend; for it explains every
- phenomenon of caloric. Heat is but the motion of atoms, a
- simple oscillation of the particles of a body. When they apply
- the brake to a train, the train comes to a stop; but what
- becomes of the motion which it had previously possessed? It is
- transformed into heat, and the brake becomes hot. Why do they
- grease the axles of the wheels? To prevent their heating,
- because this heat would be generated by the motion which is thus
- lost by transformation."
-
- "Yes, I understand," replied Michel, "perfectly. For example,
- when I have run a long time, when I am swimming, when I am
- perspiring in large drops, why am I obliged to stop?
- Simply because my motion is changed into heat."
-
- Barbicane could not help smiling at Michel's reply; then,
- returning to his theory, said:
-
- "Thus, in case of a shock, it would have been with our
- projectile as with a ball which falls in a burning state after
- having struck the metal plate; it is its motion which is turned
- into heat. Consequently I affirm that, if our projectile had
- struck the meteor, its speed thus suddenly checked would have
- raised a heat great enough to turn it into vapor instantaneously."
-
- "Then," asked Nicholl, "what would happen if the earth's motion
- were to stop suddenly?"
-
- "Her temperature would be raised to such a pitch," said
- Barbicane, "that she would be at once reduced to vapor."
-
- "Well," said Michel, "that is a way of ending the earth which
- will greatly simplify things."
-
- "And if the earth fell upon the sun?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "According to calculation," replied Barbicane, "the fall would
- develop a heat equal to that produced by 16,000 globes of coal,
- each equal in bulk to our terrestrial globe."
-
- "Good additional heat for the sun," replied Michel Ardan, "of
- which the inhabitants of Uranus or Neptune would doubtless not
- complain; they must be perished with cold on their planets."
-
- "Thus, my friends," said Barbicane, "all motion suddenly stopped
- produces heat. And this theory allows us to infer that the heat
- of the solar disc is fed by a hail of meteors falling
- incessantly on its surface. They have even calculated----"
-
- "Oh, dear!" murmured Michel, "the figures are coming."
-
- "They have even calculated," continued the imperturbable Barbicane,
- "that the shock of each meteor on the sun ought to produce a heat
- equal to that of 4,000 masses of coal of an equal bulk."
-
- "And what is the solar heat?" asked Michel.
-
- "It is equal to that produced by the combustion of a stratum of
- coal surrounding the sun to a depth of forty-seven miles."
-
- "And that heat----"
-
- "Would be able to boil two billions nine hundred millions of
- cubic myriameters [2] of water."
-
- [2] The myriameter is equal to rather more than 10,936
- cubic yards English.
-
- "And it does not roast us!" exclaimed Michel.
-
- "No," replied Barbicane, "because the terrestrial atmosphere
- absorbs four-tenths of the solar heat; besides, the quantity of
- heat intercepted by the earth is but a billionth part of the
- entire radiation."
-
- "I see that all is for the best," said Michel, "and that this
- atmosphere is a useful invention; for it not only allows us to
- breathe, but it prevents us from roasting."
-
- "Yes!" said Nicholl, "unfortunately, it will not be the same in
- the moon."
-
- "Bah!" said Michel, always hopeful. "If there are inhabitants,
- they must breathe. If there are no longer any, they must have
- left enough oxygen for three people, if only at the bottom of
- ravines, where its own weight will cause it to accumulate, and
- we will not climb the mountains; that is all." And Michel,
- rising, went to look at the lunar disc, which shone with
- intolerable brilliancy.
-
- "By Jove!" said he, "it must be hot up there!"
-
- "Without considering," replied Nicholl, "that the day lasts 360 hours!"
-
- "And to compensate that," said Barbicane, "the nights have the
- same length; and as heat is restored by radiation, their
- temperature can only be that of the planetary space."
-
- "A pretty country, that!" exclaimed Michel. "Never mind!
- I wish I was there! Ah! my dear comrades, it will be rather
- curious to have the earth for our moon, to see it rise on the
- horizon, to recognize the shape of its continents, and to say
- to oneself, `There is America, there is Europe;' then to follow
- it when it is about to lose itself in the sun's rays! By the
- bye, Barbicane, have the Selenites eclipses?"
-
- "Yes, eclipses of the sun," replied Barbicane, "when the centers
- of the three orbs are on a line, the earth being in the middle.
- But they are only partial, during which the earth, cast like a
- screen upon the solar disc, allows the greater portion to be seen."
-
- "And why," asked Nicholl, "is there no total eclipse? Does not
- the cone of the shadow cast by the earth extend beyond the moon?"
-
- "Yes, if we do not take into consideration the refraction
- produced by the terrestrial atmosphere. No, if we take that
- refraction into consideration. Thus let <lower case delta> be
- the horizontal parallel, and _p_ the apparent semidiameter----"
-
- "Oh!" said Michel. "Do speak plainly, you man of algebra!"
-
- "Very well, replied Barbicane; "in popular language the mean
- distance from the moon to the earth being sixty terrestrial
- radii, the length of the cone of the shadow, on account of
- refraction, is reduced to less than forty-two radii.
- The result is that when there are eclipses, the moon finds
- itself beyond the cone of pure shadow, and that the sun sends
- her its rays, not only from its edges, but also from its center."
-
- "Then," said Michel, in a merry tone, "why are there eclipses,
- when there ought not to be any?"
-
- "Simply because the solar rays are weakened by this refraction,
- and the atmosphere through which they pass extinguished the
- greater part of them!"
-
- "That reason satisfies me," replied Michel. "Besides we shall
- see when we get there. Now, tell me, Barbicane, do you believe
- that the moon is an old comet?"
-
- "There's an idea!"
-
- "Yes," replied Michel, with an amiable swagger, "I have a few
- ideas of that sort."
-
- "But that idea does not spring from Michel," answered Nicholl.
-
- "Well, then, I am a plagiarist."
-
- "No doubt about it. According to the ancients, the Arcadians
- pretend that their ancestors inhabited the earth before the moon
- became her satellite. Starting from this fact, some scientific
- men have seen in the moon a comet whose orbit will one day bring
- it so near to the earth that it will be held there by its attraction."
-
- "Is there any truth in this hypothesis?" asked Michel.
-
- "None whatever," said Barbicane, "and the proof is, that the
- moon has preserved no trace of the gaseous envelope which always
- accompanies comets."
-
- "But," continued Nicholl, "Before becoming the earth's satellite,
- could not the moon, when in her perihelion, pass so near the sun
- as by evaporation to get rid of all those gaseous substances?"
-
- "It is possible, friend Nicholl, but not probable."
-
- "Why not?"
-
- "Because-- Faith I do not know."
-
- "Ah!" exclaimed Michel, "what hundred of volumes we might make
- of all that we do not know!"
-
- "Ah! indeed. What time is it?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Three o'clock," answered Nicholl.
-
- "How time goes," said Michel, "in the conversation of scientific
- men such as we are! Certainly, I feel I know too much! I feel
- that I am becoming a well!"
-
- Saying which, Michel hoisted himself to the roof of the projectile,
- "to observe the moon better," he pretended. During this time his
- companions were watching through the lower glass. Nothing new to note!
-
- When Michel Ardan came down, he went to the side scuttle; and
- suddenly they heard an exclamation of surprise!
-
- "What is it?" asked Barbicane.
-
- The president approached the window, and saw a sort of flattened
- sack floating some yards from the projectile. This object
- seemed as motionless as the projectile, and was consequently
- animated with the same ascending movement.
-
- "What is that machine?" continued Michel Ardan. "Is it one of
- the bodies which our projectile keeps within its attraction, and
- which will accompany it to the moon?"
-
- "What astonishes me," said Nicholl, "is that the specific weight
- of the body, which is certainly less than that of the
- projectile, allows it to keep so perfectly on a level with it."
-
- "Nicholl," replied Barbicane, after a moment's reflection, "I do
- not know what the object it, but I do know why it maintains our level."
-
- "And why?"
-
- "Because we are floating in space, my dear captain, and in space
- bodies fall or move (which is the same thing) with equal speed
- whatever be their weight or form; it is the air, which by its
- resistance creates these differences in weight. When you create
- a vacuum in a tube, the objects you send through it, grains of
- dust or grains of lead, fall with the same rapidity. Here in
- space is the same cause and the same effect."
-
- "Just so," said Nicholl, "and everything we throw out of the
- projectile will accompany it until it reaches the moon."
-
- "Ah! fools that we are!" exclaimed Michel.
-
- "Why that expletive?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "Because we might have filled the projectile with useful objects,
- books, instruments, tools, etc. We could have thrown them all
- out, and all would have followed in our train. But happy thought!
- Why cannot we walk outside like the meteor? Why cannot we launch
- into space through the scuttle? What enjoyment it would be to
- feel oneself thus suspended in ether, more favored than the birds
- who must use their wings to keep themselves up!"
-
- "Granted," said Barbicane, "but how to breathe?"
-
- "Hang the air, to fail so inopportunely!"
-
- "But if it did not fail, Michel, your density being less than
- that of the projectile, you would soon be left behind."
-
- "Then we must remain in our car?"
-
- "We must!"
-
- "Ah!" exclaimed Michel, in a load voice.
-
- "What is the matter," asked Nicholl.
-
- "I know, I guess, what this pretended meteor is! It is no
- asteroid which is accompanying us! It is not a piece of a planet."
-
- "What is it then?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "It is our unfortunate dog! It is Diana's husband!"
-
- Indeed, this deformed, unrecognizable object, reduced to
- nothing, was the body of Satellite, flattened like a bagpipe
- without wind, and ever mounting, mounting!
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VII
-
-
- A MOMENT OF INTOXICATION
-
-
- Thus a phenomenon, curious but explicable, was happening under
- these strange conditions.
-
- Every object thrown from the projectile would follow the same
- course and never stop until it did. There was a subject for
- conversation which the whole evening could not exhaust.
-
- Besides, the excitement of the three travelers increased as they
- drew near the end of their journey. They expected unforseen
- incidents, and new phenomena; and nothing would have astonished
- them in the frame of mind they then were in. Their overexcited
- imagination went faster than the projectile, whose speed was
- evidently diminishing, though insensibly to themselves. But the
- moon grew larger to their eyes, and they fancied if they
- stretched out their hands they could seize it.
-
- The next day, the 5th of November, at five in the morning,
- all three were on foot. That day was to be the last of their
- journey, if all calculations were true. That very night, at
- twelve o'clock, in eighteen hours, exactly at the full moon,
- they would reach its brilliant disc. The next midnight would
- see that journey ended, the most extraordinary of ancient or
- modern times. Thus from the first of the morning, through the
- scuttles silvered by its rays, they saluted the orb of night
- with a confident and joyous hurrah.
-
- The moon was advancing majestically along the starry firmament.
- A few more degrees, and she would reach the exact point where
- her meeting with the projectile was to take place.
-
- According to his own observations, Barbicane reckoned that they
- would land on her northern hemisphere, where stretch immense plains,
- and where mountains are rare. A favorable circumstance if, as
- they thought, the lunar atmosphere was stored only in its depths.
-
- "Besides," observed Michel Ardan, "a plain is easier to
- disembark upon than a mountain. A Selenite, deposited in Europe
- on the summit of Mont Blanc, or in Asia on the top of the
- Himalayas, would not be quite in the right place."
-
- "And," added Captain Nicholl, "on a flat ground, the projectile
- will remain motionless when it has once touched; whereas on a
- declivity it would roll like an avalanche, and not being
- squirrels we should not come out safe and sound. So it is all
- for the best."
-
- Indeed, the success of the audacious attempt no longer
- appeared doubtful. But Barbicane was preoccupied with one
- thought; but not wishing to make his companions uneasy, he
- kept silence on this subject.
-
- The direction the projectile was taking toward the moon's
- northern hemisphere, showed that her course had been
- slightly altered. The discharge, mathematically calculated,
- would carry the projectile to the very center of the lunar disc.
- If it did not land there, there must have been some deviation.
- What had caused it? Barbicane could neither imagine nor
- determine the importance of the deviation, for there were no
- points to go by.
-
- He hoped, however, that it would have no other result than that
- of bringing them nearer the upper border of the moon, a region
- more suitable for landing.
-
- Without imparting his uneasiness to his companions, Barbicane
- contented himself with constantly observing the moon, in order
- to see whether the course of the projectile would not be
- altered; for the situation would have been terrible if it failed
- in its aim, and being carried beyond the disc should be launched
- into interplanetary space. At that moment, the moon, instead of
- appearing flat like a disc, showed its convexity. If the sun's
- rays had struck it obliquely, the shadow thrown would have brought
- out the high mountains, which would have been clearly detached.
- The eye might have gazed into the crater's gaping abysses,
- and followed the capricious fissures which wound through the
- immense plains. But all relief was as yet leveled in
- intense brilliancy. They could scarcely distinguish those
- large spots which give the moon the appearance of a human face.
-
- "Face, indeed!" said Michel Ardan; "but I am sorry for the
- amiable sister of Apollo. A very pitted face!"
-
- But the travelers, now so near the end, were incessantly
- observing this new world. They imagined themselves walking
- through its unknown countries, climbing its highest peaks,
- descending into its lowest depths. Here and there they fancied
- they saw vast seas, scarcely kept together under so rarefied an
- atmosphere, and water-courses emptying the mountain tributaries.
- Leaning over the abyss, they hoped to catch some sounds from
- that orb forever mute in the solitude of space. That last day
- left them.
-
- They took down the most trifling details. A vague uneasiness
- took possession of them as they neared the end. This uneasiness
- would have been doubled had they felt how their speed had decreased.
- It would have seemed to them quite insufficient to carry them to
- the end. It was because the projectile then "weighed" almost nothing.
- Its weight was ever decreasing, and would be entirely annihilated on
- that line where the lunar and terrestrial attractions would
- neutralize each other.
-
- But in spite of his preoccupation, Michel Ardan did not forget
- to prepare the morning repast with his accustomed punctuality.
- They ate with a good appetite. Nothing was so excellent as the
- soup liquefied by the heat of the gas; nothing better than the
- preserved meat. Some glasses of good French wine crowned the
- repast, causing Michel Ardan to remark that the lunar vines,
- warmed by that ardent sun, ought to distill even more generous
- wines; that is, if they existed. In any case, the far-seeing
- Frenchman had taken care not to forget in his collection some
- precious cuttings of the Medoc and Cote d'Or, upon which he
- founded his hopes.
-
- Reiset and Regnaut's apparatus worked with great regularity.
- Not an atom of carbonic acid resisted the potash; and as to
- the oxygen, Captain Nicholl said "it was of the first quality."
- The little watery vapor enclosed in the projectile mixing with
- the air tempered the dryness; and many apartments in London,
- Paris, or New York, and many theaters, were certainly not in
- such a healthy condition.
-
- But that it might act with regularity, the apparatus must be
- kept in perfect order; so each morning Michel visited the escape
- regulators, tried the taps, and regulated the heat of the gas by
- the pyrometer. Everything had gone well up to that time, and
- the travelers, imitating the worthy Joseph T. Maston, began to
- acquire a degree of embonpoint which would have rendered them
- unrecognizable if their imprisonment had been prolonged to
- some months. In a word, they behaved like chickens in a coop;
- they were getting fat.
-
- In looking through the scuttle Barbicane saw the specter of the
- dog, and other divers objects which had been thrown from the
- projectile, obstinately following them. Diana howled
- lugubriously on seeing the remains of Satellite, which seemed as
- motionless as if they reposed on solid earth.
-
- "Do you know, my friends," said Michel Ardan, "that if one of us
- had succumbed to the shock consequent on departure, we should
- have had a great deal of trouble to bury him? What am I saying?
- to _etherize_ him, as here ether takes the place of earth.
- You see the accusing body would have followed us into space like
- a remorse."
-
- "That would have been sad," said Nicholl.
-
- "Ah!" continued Michel, "what I regret is not being able to take a
- walk outside. What voluptuousness to float amid this radiant ether,
- to bathe oneself in it, to wrap oneself in the sun's pure rays.
- If Barbicane had only thought of furnishing us with a diving
- apparatus and an air-pump, I could have ventured out and assumed
- fanciful attitudes of feigned monsters on the top of the projectile."
-
- "Well, old Michel," replied Barbicane, "you would not have made
- a feigned monster long, for in spite of your diver's dress, swollen
- by the expansion of air within you, you would have burst like a
- shell, or rather like a balloon which has risen too high. So do
- not regret it, and do not forget this-- as long as we float in
- space, all sentimental walks beyond the projectile are forbidden."
-
- Michel Ardan allowed himself to be convinced to a certain extent.
- He admitted that the thing was difficult but not impossible,
- a word which he never uttered.
-
- The conversation passed from this subject to another, not failing
- him for an instant. It seemed to the three friends as though,
- under present conditions, ideas shot up in their brains as leaves
- shoot at the first warmth of spring. They felt bewildered. In the
- middle of the questions and answers which crossed each other,
- Nicholl put one question which did not find an immediate solution.
-
- "Ah, indeed!" said he; "it is all very well to go to the moon,
- but how to get back again?"
-
- His two interlocutors looked surprised. One would have thought
- that this possibility now occurred to them for the first time.
-
- "What do you mean by that, Nicholl?" asked Barbicane gravely.
-
- "To ask for means to leave a country," added Michel, "When we
- have not yet arrived there, seems to me rather inopportune."
-
- "I do not say that, wishing to draw back," replied Nicholl;
- "but I repeat my question, and I ask, `How shall we return?'"
-
- "I know nothing about it," answered Barbicane.
-
- "And I," said Michel, "if I had known how to return, I would
- never have started."
-
- "There's an answer!" cried Nicholl.
-
- "I quite approve of Michel's words," said Barbicane; "and add,
- that the question has no real interest. Later, when we think it
- is advisable to return, we will take counsel together. If the
- Columbiad is not there, the projectile will be."
-
- "That is a step certainly. A ball without a gun!"
-
- "The gun," replied Barbicane, "can be manufactured. The powder
- can be made. Neither metals, saltpeter, nor coal can fail in
- the depths of the moon, and we need only go 8,000 leagues in
- order to fall upon the terrestrial globe by virtue of the mere
- laws of weight."
-
- "Enough," said Michel with animation. "Let it be no longer a
- question of returning: we have already entertained it too long.
- As to communicating with our former earthly colleagues, that
- will not be difficult."
-
- "And how?"
-
- "By means of meteors launched by lunar volcanoes."
-
- "Well thought of, Michel," said Barbicane in a convinced tone
- of voice. "Laplace has calculated that a force five times greater
- than that of our gun would suffice to send a meteor from the
- moon to the earth, and there is not one volcano which has not a
- greater power of propulsion than that."
-
- "Hurrah!" exclaimed Michel; "these meteors are handy postmen,
- and cost nothing. And how we shall be able to laugh at the
- post-office administration! But now I think of it----"
-
- "What do you think of?"
-
- "A capital idea. Why did we not fasten a thread to our
- projectile, and we could have exchanged telegrams with the earth?"
-
- "The deuce!" answered Nicholl. "Do you consider the weight of
- a thread 250,000 miles long nothing?"
-
- "As nothing. They could have trebled the Columbiad's charge;
- they could have quadrupled or quintupled it!" exclaimed Michel,
- with whom the verb took a higher intonation each time.
-
- "There is but one little objection to make to your proposition,"
- replied Barbicane, "which is that, during the rotary motion of
- the globe, our thread would have wound itself round it like a
- chain on a capstan, and that it would inevitably have brought us
- to the ground."
-
- "By the thirty-nine stars of the Union!" said Michel, "I have
- nothing but impracticable ideas to-day; ideas worthy of J.
- T. Maston. But I have a notion that, if we do not return to
- earth, J. T. Maston will be able to come to us."
-
- "Yes, he'll come," replied Barbicane; "he is a worthy and a
- courageous comrade. Besides, what is easier? Is not the
- Columbiad still buried in the soil of Florida? Is cotton and
- nitric acid wanted wherewith to manufacture the pyroxyle?
- Will not the moon pass the zenith of Florida? In eighteen
- years' time will she not occupy exactly the same place as to-day?"
-
- "Yes," continued Michel, "yes, Maston will come, and with him
- our friends Elphinstone, Blomsberry, all the members of the Gun
- Club, and they will be well received. And by and by they will
- run trains of projectiles between the earth and the moon!
- Hurrah for J. T. Maston!"
-
- It is probable that, if the Hon. J. T. Maston did not hear the
- hurrahs uttered in his honor, his ears at least tingled. What was
- he doing then? Doubtless, posted in the Rocky Mountains, at the
- station of Long's Peak, he was trying to find the invisible
- projectile gravitating in space. If he was thinking of his dear
- companions, we must allow that they were not far behind him; and
- that, under the influence of a strange excitement, they were
- devoting to him their best thoughts.
-
- But whence this excitement, which was evidently growing upon the
- tenants of the projectile? Their sobriety could not be doubted.
- This strange irritation of the brain, must it be attributed to
- the peculiar circumstances under which they found themselves, to
- their proximity to the orb of night, from which only a few hours
- separated them, to some secret influence of the moon acting upon
- their nervous system? Their faces were as rosy as if they had
- been exposed to the roaring flames of an oven; their voices
- resounded in loud accents; their words escaped like a champagne
- cork driven out by carbonic acid; their gestures became annoying,
- they wanted so much room to perform them; and, strange to say,
- they none of them noticed this great tension of the mind.
-
- "Now," said Nicholl, in a short tone, "now that I do not know
- whether we shall ever return from the moon, I want to know what
- we are going to do there?"
-
- "What we are going to do there?" replied Barbicane, stamping
- with his foot as if he was in a fencing saloon; "I do not know."
-
- "You do not know!" exclaimed Michel, with a bellow which
- provoked a sonorous echo in the projectile.
-
- "No, I have not even thought about it," retorted Barbicane, in
- the same loud tone.
-
- "Well, I know," replied Michel.
-
- "Speak, then," cried Nicholl, who could no longer contain the
- growling of his voice.
-
- "I shall speak if it suits me," exclaimed Michel, seizing his
- companions' arms with violence.
-
- "_It must_ suit you," said Barbicane, with an eye on fire and a
- threatening hand. "It was you who drew us into this frightful
- journey, and we want to know what for."
-
- "Yes," said the captain, "now that I do not know _where_ I am
- going, I want to know _why_ I am going."
-
- "Why?" exclaimed Michel, jumping a yard high, "why? To take
- possession of the moon in the name of the United States; to add
- a fortieth State to the Union; to colonize the lunar regions;
- to cultivate them, to people them, to transport thither all the
- prodigies of art, of science, and industry; to civilize the
- Selenites, unless they are more civilized than we are; and to
- constitute them a republic, if they are not already one!"
-
- "And if there are no Selenites?" retorted Nicholl, who, under the
- influence of this unaccountable intoxication, was very contradictory.
-
- "Who said that there were no Selenites?" exclaimed Michel in a
- threatening tone.
-
- "I do," howled Nicholl.
-
- "Captain," said Michel, "do not repreat that insolence, or I
- will knock your teeth down your throat!"
-
- The two adversaries were going to fall upon each other, and the
- incoherent discussion threatened to merge into a fight, when
- Barbicane intervened with one bound.
-
- "Stop, miserable men," said he, separating his two companions;
- "if there are no Selenites, we will do without them."
-
- "Yes," exclaimed Michel, who was not particular; "yes, we will
- do without them. We have only to make Selenites. Down with
- the Selenites!"
-
- "The empire of the moon belongs to us," said Nicholl.
-
- "Let us three constitute the republic."
-
- "I will be the congress," cried Michel.
-
- "And I the senate," retorted Nicholl.
-
- "And Barbicane, the president," howled Michel.
-
- "Not a president elected by the nation," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Very well, a president elected by the congress," cried Michel;
- "and as I am the congress, you are unanimously elected!"
-
- "Hurrah! hurrah! hurrah! for President Barbicane," exclaimed Nicholl.
-
- "Hip! hip! hip!" vociferated Michel Ardan.
-
- Then the president and the senate struck up in a tremendous
- voice the popular song "Yankee Doodle," while from the congress
- resounded the masculine tones of the "Marseillaise."
-
- Then they struck up a frantic dance, with maniacal gestures,
- idiotic stampings, and somersaults like those of the boneless
- clowns in the circus. Diana, joining in the dance, and howling
- in her turn, jumped to the top of the projectile. An unaccountable
- flapping of wings was then heard amid most fantastic cock-crows,
- while five or six hens fluttered like bats against the walls.
-
- Then the three traveling companions, acted upon by some
- unaccountable influence above that of intoxication, inflamed by
- the air which had set their respiratory apparatus on fire, fell
- motionless to the bottom of the projectile.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VIII
-
-
- AT SEVENTY-EIGHT THOUSAND FIVE HUNDRED AND FOURTEEN LEAGUES
-
- What had happened? Whence the cause of this singular
- intoxication, the consequences of which might have been
- very disastrous? A simple blunder of Michel's, which,
- fortunately, Nicholl was able to correct in time.
-
- After a perfect swoon, which lasted some minutes, the captain,
- recovering first, soon collected his scattered senses.
- Although he had breakfasted only two hours before, he felt a
- gnawing hunger, as if he had not eaten anything for several days.
- Everything about him, stomach and brain, were overexcited to the
- highest degree. He got up and demanded from Michel a
- supplementary repast. Michel, utterly done up, did not answer.
-
- Nicholl then tried to prepare some tea destined to help the
- absorption of a dozen sandwiches. He first tried to get some
- fire, and struck a match sharply. What was his surprise to see
- the sulphur shine with so extraordinary a brilliancy as to be
- almost unbearable to the eye. From the gas-burner which he lit
- rose a flame equal to a jet of electric light.
-
- A revelation dawned on Nicholl's mind. That intensity of light,
- the physiological troubles which had arisen in him, the
- overexcitement of all his moral and quarrelsome faculties-- he
- understood all.
-
- "The oxygen!" he exclaimed.
-
- And leaning over the air apparatus, he saw that the tap was
- allowing the colorless gas to escape freely, life-giving, but in
- its pure state producing the gravest disorders in the system.
- Michel had blunderingly opened the tap of the apparatus to the full.
-
- Nicholl hastened to stop the escape of oxygen with which the
- atmosphere was saturated, which would have been the death of the
- travelers, not by suffocation, but by combustion. An hour
- later, the air less charged with it restored the lungs to their
- normal condition. By degrees the three friends recovered from
- their intoxication; but they were obliged to sleep themselves
- sober over their oxygen as a drunkard does over his wine.
-
- When Michel learned his share of the responsibility of this
- incident, he was not much disconcerted. This unexpected
- drunkenness broke the monotony of the journey. Many foolish
- things had been said while under its influence, but also
- quickly forgotten.
-
- "And then," added the merry Frenchman, "I am not sorry to have
- tasted a little of this heady gas. Do you know, my friends,
- that a curious establishment might be founded with rooms of
- oxygen, where people whose system is weakened could for a few
- hours live a more active life. Fancy parties where the room was
- saturated with this heroic fluid, theaters where it should be
- kept at high pressure; what passion in the souls of the actors
- and spectators! what fire, what enthusiasm! And if, instead of
- an assembly only a whole people could be saturated, what activity
- in its functions, what a supplement to life it would derive.
- From an exhausted nation they might make a great and strong one,
- and I know more than one state in old Europe which ought to put
- itself under the regime of oxygen for the sake of its health!"
-
- Michel spoke with so much animation that one might have fancied
- that the tap was still too open. But a few words from Barbicane
- soon shattered his enthusiasm.
-
- "That is all very well, friend Michel," said he, "but will you
- inform us where these chickens came from which have mixed
- themselves up in our concert?"
-
- "Those chickens?"
-
- "Yes."
-
- Indeed, half a dozen chickens and a fine cock were walking
- about, flapping their wings and chattering.
-
- "Ah, the awkward things!" exclaimed Michel. "The oxygen has
- made them revolt."
-
- "But what do you want to do with these chickens?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "To acclimatize them in the moon, by Jove!"
-
- "Then why did you hide them?"
-
- "A joke, my worthy president, a simple joke, which has proved a
- miserable failure. I wanted to set them free on the lunar
- continent, without saying anything. Oh, what would have been
- your amazement on seeing these earthly-winged animals pecking in
- your lunar fields!"
-
- "You rascal, you unmitigated rascal," replied Barbicane, "you do
- not want oxygen to mount to the head. You are always what we
- were under the influence of the gas; you are always foolish!"
-
- "Ah, who says that we were not wise then?" replied Michel Ardan.
-
- After this philosophical reflection, the three friends set about
- restoring the order of the projectile. Chickens and cock were
- reinstated in their coop. But while proceeding with this
- operation, Barbicane and his two companions had a most desired
- perception of a new phenomenon. From the moment of leaving the
- earth, their own weight, that of the projectile, and the objects
- it enclosed, had been subject to an increasing diminution. If they
- could not prove this loss of the projectile, a moment would arrive
- when it would be sensibly felt upon themselves and the utensils
- and instruments they used.
-
- It is needless to say that a scale would not show this loss; for
- the weight destined to weight the object would have lost exactly
- as much as the object itself; but a spring steelyard for
- example, the tension of which was independent of the attraction,
- would have given a just estimate of this loss.
-
- We know that the attraction, otherwise called the weight, is in
- proportion to the densities of the bodies, and inversely as the
- squares of the distances. Hence this effect: If the earth had
- been alone in space, if the other celestial bodies had been
- suddenly annihilated, the projectile, according to Newton's
- laws, would weigh less as it got farther from the earth, but
- without ever losing its weight entirely, for the terrestrial
- attraction would always have made itself felt, at whatever distance.
-
- But, in reality, a time must come when the projectile would no
- longer be subject to the law of weight, after allowing for the
- other celestial bodies whose effect could not be set down as zero.
- Indeed, the projectile's course was being traced between
- the earth and the moon. As it distanced the earth, the
- terrestrial attraction diminished: but the lunar attraction
- rose in proportion. There must come a point where these two
- attractions would neutralize each other: the projectile would
- possess weight no longer. If the moon's and the earth's
- densities had been equal, this point would have been at an equal
- distance between the two orbs. But taking the different
- densities into consideration, it was easy to reckon that this
- point would be situated at 47/60ths of the whole journey,
- _i.e._, at 78,514 leagues from the earth. At this point, a body
- having no principle of speed or displacement in itself, would
- remain immovable forever, being attracted equally by both orbs,
- and not being drawn more toward one than toward the other.
-
- Now if the projectile's impulsive force had been correctly
- calculated, it would attain this point without speed, having
- lost all trace of weight, as well as all the objects within it.
- What would happen then? Three hypotheses presented themselves.
-
- 1. Either it would retain a certain amount of motion, and pass
- the point of equal attraction, and fall upon the moon by virtue
- of the excess of the lunar attraction over the terrestrial.
-
- 2. Or, its speed failing, and unable to reach the point of equal
- attraction, it would fall upon the moon by virtue of the excess
- of the lunar attraction over the terrestrial.
-
- 3. Or, lastly, animated with sufficient speed to enable it to
- reach the neutral point, but not sufficient to pass it, it would
- remain forever suspended in that spot like the pretended tomb of
- Mahomet, between the zenith and the nadir.
-
- Such was their situation; and Barbicane clearly explained the
- consequences to his traveling companions, which greatly
- interested them. But how should they know when the projectile
- had reached this neutral point situated at that distance,
- especially when neither themselves, nor the objects enclosed in
- the projectile, would be any longer subject to the laws of weight?
-
- Up to this time, the travelers, while admitting that this action
- was constantly decreasing, had not yet become sensible to its
- total absence.
-
- But that day, about eleven o'clock in the morning, Nicholl
- having accidentally let a glass slip from his hand, the glass,
- instead of falling, remained suspended in the air.
-
- "Ah!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, "that is rather an amusing piece
- of natural philosophy."
-
- And immediately divers other objects, firearms and bottles,
- abandoned to themselves, held themselves up as by enchantment.
- Diana too, placed in space by Michel, reproduced, but without
- any trick, the wonderful suspension practiced by Caston and
- Robert Houdin. Indeed the dog did not seem to know that she was
- floating in air.
-
- The three adventurous companions were surprised and stupefied,
- despite their scientific reasonings. They felt themselves being
- carried into the domain of wonders! they felt that weight was
- really wanting to their bodies. If they stretched out their
- arms, they did not attempt to fall. Their heads shook on
- their shoulders. Their feet no longer clung to the floor of
- the projectile. They were like drunken men having no stability
- in themselves.
-
- Fancy has depicted men without reflection, others without shadow.
- But here reality, by the neutralizations of attractive forces,
- produced men in whom nothing had any weight, and who weighed
- nothing themselves.
-
- Suddenly Michel, taking a spring, left the floor and remained
- suspended in the air, like Murillo's monk of the _Cusine des Anges_.
-
- The two friends joined him instantly, and all three formed a
- miraculous "Ascension" in the center of the projectile.
-
- "Is it to be believed? is it probable? is it possible?"
- exclaimed Michel; "and yet it is so. Ah! if Raphael had seen us
- thus, what an `Assumption' he would have thrown upon canvas!"
-
- "The `Assumption' cannot last," replied Barbicane. "If the
- projectile passes the neutral point, the lunar attraction will
- draw us to the moon."
-
- "Then our feet will be upon the roof," replied Michel.
-
- "No," said Barbicane, "because the projectile's center of
- gravity is very low; it will only turn by degrees."
-
- "Then all our portables will be upset from top to bottom, that
- is a fact."
-
- "Calm yourself, Michel," replied Nicholl; "no upset is to be
- feared; not a thing will move, for the projectile's evolution
- will be imperceptible."
-
- "Just so," continued Barbicane; "and when it has passed the
- point of equal attraction, its base, being the heavier, will
- draw it perpendicularly to the moon; but, in order that this
- phenomenon should take place, we must have passed the neutral line."
-
- "Pass the neutral line," cried Michel; "then let us do as the
- sailors do when they cross the equator."
-
- A slight side movement brought Michel back toward the padded
- side; thence he took a bottle and glasses, placed them "in
- space" before his companions, and, drinking merrily, they
- saluted the line with a triple hurrah. The influence of these
- attractions scarcely lasted an hour; the travelers felt
- themselves insensibly drawn toward the floor, and Barbicane
- fancied that the conical end of the projectile was varying a
- little from its normal direction toward the moon. By an inverse
- motion the base was approaching first; the lunar attraction was
- prevailing over the terrestrial; the fall toward the moon was
- beginning, almost imperceptibly as yet, but by degrees the
- attractive force would become stronger, the fall would be more
- decided, the projectile, drawn by its base, would turn its cone
- to the earth, and fall with ever-increasing speed on to the
- surface of the Selenite continent; their destination would then
- be attained. Now nothing could prevent the success of their
- enterprise, and Nicholl and Michel Ardan shared Barbicane's joy.
-
- Then they chatted of all the phenomena which had astonished them
- one after the other, particularly the neutralization of the laws
- of weight. Michel Ardan, always enthusiastic, drew conclusions
- which were purely fanciful.
-
- "Ah, my worthy friends," he exclaimed, "what progress we should
- make if on earth we could throw off some of that weight, some of
- that chain which binds us to her; it would be the prisoner set
- at liberty; no more fatigue of either arms or legs. Or, if it
- is true that in order to fly on the earth's surface, to keep
- oneself suspended in the air merely by the play of the muscles,
- there requires a strength a hundred and fifty times greater than
- that which we possess, a simple act of volition, a caprice,
- would bear us into space, if attraction did not exist."
-
- "Just so," said Nicholl, smiling; "if we could succeed in
- suppressing weight as they suppress pain by anaesthesia,
- that would change the face of modern society!"
-
- "Yes," cried Michel, full of his subject, "destroy weight, and
- no more burdens!"
-
- "Well said," replied Barbicane; "but if nothing had any weight,
- nothing would keep in its place, not even your hat on your head,
- worthy Michel; nor your house, whose stones only adhere by
- weight; nor a boat, whose stability on the waves is only caused
- by weight; not even the ocean, whose waves would no longer be
- equalized by terrestrial attraction; and lastly, not even the
- atmosphere, whose atoms, being no longer held in their places,
- would disperse in space!"
-
- "That is tiresome," retorted Michel; "nothing like these
- matter-of-fact people for bringing one back to the bare reality."
-
- "But console yourself, Michel," continued Barbicane, "for if no
- orb exists from whence all laws of weight are banished, you are
- at least going to visit one where it is much less than on the earth."
-
- "The moon?"
-
- "Yes, the moon, on whose surface objects weigh six times less
- than on the earth, a phenomenon easy to prove."
-
- "And we shall feel it?" asked Michel.
-
- "Evidently, as two hundred pounds will only weigh thirty pounds
- on the surface of the moon."
-
- "And our muscular strength will not diminish?"
-
- "Not at all; instead of jumping one yard high, you will rise
- eighteen feet high."
-
- "But we shall be regular Herculeses in the moon!" exclaimed Michel.
-
- "Yes," replied Nicholl; "for if the height of the Selenites is
- in proportion to the density of their globe, they will be
- scarcely a foot high."
-
- "Lilliputians!" ejaculated Michel; "I shall play the part
- of Gulliver. We are going to realize the fable of the giants.
- This is the advantage of leaving one's own planet and
- over-running the solar world."
-
- "One moment, Michel," answered Barbicane; "if you wish to play
- the part of Gulliver, only visit the inferior planets, such as
- Mercury, Venus, or Mars, whose density is a little less than
- that of the earth; but do not venture into the great planets,
- Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, Neptune; for there the order will be
- changed, and you will become Lilliputian."
-
- "And in the sun?"
-
- "In the sun, if its density is thirteen hundred and twenty-four
- thousand times greater, and the attraction is twenty-seven times
- greater than on the surface of our globe, keeping everything in
- proportion, the inhabitants ought to be at least two hundred
- feet high."
-
- "By Jove!" exclaimed Michel; "I should be nothing more than a
- pigmy, a shrimp!"
-
- "Gulliver with the giants," said Nicholl.
-
- "Just so," replied Barbicane.
-
- "And it would not be quite useless to carry some pieces of
- artillery to defend oneself."
-
- "Good," replied Nicholl; "your projectiles would have no effect
- on the sun; they would fall back upon the earth after some minutes."
-
- "That is a strong remark."
-
- "It is certain," replied Barbicane; "the attraction is so great
- on this enormous orb, that an object weighing 70,000 pounds on
- the earth would weigh but 1,920 pounds on the surface of the sun.
- If you were to fall upon it you would weigh-- let me see-- about
- 5,000 pounds, a weight which you would never be able to raise again."
-
- "The devil!" said Michel; "one would want a portable crane.
- However, we will be satisfied with the moon for the present;
- there at least we shall cut a great figure. We will see about
- the sun by and by."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IX
-
-
- THE CONSEQUENCES OF A DEVIATION
-
-
- Barbicane had now no fear of the issue of the journey, at least
- as far as the projectile's impulsive force was concerned; its
- own speed would carry it beyond the neutral line; it would
- certainly not return to earth; it would certainly not remain
- motionless on the line of attraction. One single hypothesis
- remained to be realized, the arrival of the projectile at its
- destination by the action of the lunar attraction.
-
- It was in reality a fall of 8,296 leagues on an orb, it is true,
- where weight could only be reckoned at one sixth of terrestrial
- weight; a formidable fall, nevertheless, and one against which
- every precaution must be taken without delay.
-
- These precautions were of two sorts, some to deaden the shock
- when the projectile should touch the lunar soil, others to delay
- the fall, and consequently make it less violent.
-
- To deaden the shock, it was a pity that Barbicane was no longer
- able to employ the means which had so ably weakened the shock at
- departure, that is to say, by water used as springs and the
- partition breaks.
-
- The partitions still existed, but water failed, for they could
- not use their reserve, which was precious, in case during the
- first days the liquid element should be found wanting on lunar soil.
-
- And indeed this reserve would have been quite insufficient for
- a spring. The layer of water stored in the projectile at
- the time of starting upon their journey occupied no less than
- three feet in depth, and spread over a surface of not less than
- fifty-four square feet. Besides, the cistern did not contain
- one-fifth part of it; they must therefore give up this efficient
- means of deadening the shock of arrival. Happily, Barbicane,
- not content with employing water, had furnished the movable disc
- with strong spring plugs, destined to lessen the shock against
- the base after the breaking of the horizontal partitions.
- These plugs still existed; they had only to readjust them and
- replace the movable disc; every piece, easy to handle, as their
- weight was now scarcely felt, was quickly mounted.
-
- The different pieces were fitted without trouble, it being only
- a matter of bolts and screws; tools were not wanting, and soon
- the reinstated disc lay on steel plugs, like a table on its legs.
- One inconvenience resulted from the replacing of the disc,
- the lower window was blocked up; thus it was impossible for
- the travelers to observe the moon from that opening while
- they were being precipitated perpendicularly upon her; but they
- were obliged to give it up; even by the side openings they could
- still see vast lunar regions, as an aeronaut sees the earth from
- his car.
-
- This replacing of the disc was at least an hour's work. It was
- past twelve when all preparations were finished. Barbicane took
- fresh observations on the inclination of the projectile, but to
- his annoyance it had not turned over sufficiently for its fall;
- it seemed to take a curve parallel to the lunar disc. The orb
- of night shone splendidly into space, while opposite, the orb of
- day blazed with fire.
-
- Their situation began to make them uneasy.
-
- "Are we reaching our destination?" said Nicholl.
-
- "Let us act as if we were about reaching it," replied Barbicane.
-
- "You are sceptical," retorted Michel Ardan. "We shall arrive,
- and that, too, quicker than we like."
-
- This answer brought Barbicane back to his preparations, and he
- occupied himself with placing the contrivances intended to break
- their descent. We may remember the scene of the meeting held at
- Tampa Town, in Florida, when Captain Nicholl came forward as
- Barbicane's enemy and Michel Ardan's adversary. To Captain
- Nicholl's maintaining that the projectile would smash like glass,
- Michel replied that he would break their fall by means of rockets
- properly placed.
-
- Thus, powerful fireworks, taking their starting-point from the
- base and bursting outside, could, by producing a recoil, check
- to a certain degree the projectile's speed. These rockets were
- to burn in space, it is true; but oxygen would not fail them,
- for they could supply themselves with it, like the lunar
- volcanoes, the burning of which has never yet been stopped by
- the want of atmosphere round the moon.
-
- Barbicane had accordingly supplied himself with these fireworks,
- enclosed in little steel guns, which could be screwed on to the
- base of the projectile. Inside, these guns were flush with the
- bottom; outside, they protruded about eighteen inches. There were
- twenty of them. An opening left in the disc allowed them to light
- the match with which each was provided. All the effect was
- felt outside. The burning mixture had already been rammed
- into each gun. They had, then, nothing to do but raise the
- metallic buffers fixed in the base, and replace them by the
- guns, which fitted closely in their places.
-
- This new work was finished about three o'clock, and after taking
- all these precautions there remained but to wait. But the
- projectile was perceptibly nearing the moon, and evidently
- succumbed to her influence to a certain degree; though its
- own velocity also drew it in an oblique direction. From these
- conflicting influences resulted a line which might become
- a tangent. But it was certain that the projectile would not
- fall directly on the moon; for its lower part, by reason of
- its weight, ought to be turned toward her.
-
- Barbicane's uneasiness increased as he saw his projectile resist
- the influence of gravitation. The Unknown was opening before
- him, the Unknown in interplanetary space. The man of science
- thought he had foreseen the only three hypotheses possible-- the
- return to the earth, the return to the moon, or stagnation on
- the neutral line; and here a fourth hypothesis, big with all the
- terrors of the Infinite, surged up inopportunely. To face it
- without flinching, one must be a resolute savant like Barbicane,
- a phlegmatic being like Nicholl, or an audacious adventurer like
- Michel Ardan.
-
- Conversation was started upon this subject. Other men would
- have considered the question from a practical point of view;
- they would have asked themselves whither their projectile
- carriage was carrying them. Not so with these; they sought for
- the cause which produced this effect.
-
- "So we have become diverted from our route," said Michel; "but why?"
-
- "I very much fear," answered Nicholl, "that, in spite of
- all precautions taken, the Columbiad was not fairly pointed.
- An error, however small, would be enough to throw us out of
- the moon's attraction."
-
- "Then they must have aimed badly?" asked Michel.
-
- "I do not think so," replied Barbicane. "The perpendicularity
- of the gun was exact, its direction to the zenith of the spot
- incontestible; and the moon passing to the zenith of the spot,
- we ought to reach it at the full. There is another reason,
- but it escapes me."
-
- "Are we not arriving too late?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Too late?" said Barbicane.
-
- "Yes," continued Nicholl. "The Cambridge Observatory's note
- says that the transit ought to be accomplished in ninety-seven
- hours thirteen minutes and twenty seconds; which means to say,
- that _sooner_ the moon will _not_ be at the point indicated, and
- _later_ it will have passed it."
-
- "True," replied Barbicane. "But we started the 1st of December,
- at thirteen minutes and twenty-five seconds to eleven at night;
- and we ought to arrive on the 5th at midnight, at the exact
- moment when the moon would be full; and we are now at the
- 5th of December. It is now half-past three in the evening;
- half-past eight ought to see us at the end of our journey.
- Why do we not arrive?"
-
- "Might it not be an excess of speed?" answered Nicholl; "for we
- know now that its initial velocity was greater than they supposed."
-
- "No! a hundred times, no!" replied Barbicane. "An excess of
- speed, if the direction of the projectile had been right, would
- not have prevented us reaching the moon. No, there has been
- a deviation. We have been turned out of our course."
-
- "By whom? by what?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "I cannot say," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Very well, then, Barbicane," said Michel, "do you wish to know
- my opinion on the subject of finding out this deviation?"
-
- "Speak."
-
- "I would not give half a dollar to know it. That we have
- deviated is a fact. Where we are going matters little; we shall
- soon see. Since we are being borne along in space we shall end
- by falling into some center of attraction or other."
-
- Michel Ardan's indifference did not content Barbicane. Not that
- he was uneasy about the future, but he wanted to know at any
- cost _why_ his projectile had deviated.
-
- But the projectile continued its course sideways to the moon,
- and with it the mass of things thrown out. Barbicane could even
- prove, by the elevations which served as landmarks upon the
- moon, which was only two thousand leagues distant, that its
- speed was becoming uniform-- fresh proof that there was no fall.
- Its impulsive force still prevailed over the lunar attraction,
- but the projectile's course was certainly bringing it nearer to
- the moon, and they might hope that at a nearer point the weight,
- predominating, would cause a decided fall.
-
- The three friends, having nothing better to do, continued their
- observations; but they could not yet determine the topographical
- position of the satellite; every relief was leveled under the
- reflection of the solar rays.
-
- They watched thus through the side windows until eight o'clock
- at night. The moon had grown so large in their eyes that it
- filled half of the firmament. The sun on one side, and the orb
- of night on the other, flooded the projectile with light.
-
- At that moment Barbicane thought he could estimate the distance
- which separated them from their aim at no more than 700 leagues.
- The speed of the projectile seemed to him to be more than 200
- yards, or about 170 leagues a second. Under the centripetal
- force, the base of the projectile tended toward the moon; but
- the centrifugal still prevailed; and it was probable that its
- rectilineal course would be changed to a curve of some sort,
- the nature of which they could not at present determine.
-
- Barbicane was still seeking the solution of his insoluble problem.
- Hours passed without any result. The projectile was evidently
- nearing the moon, but it was also evident that it would never
- reach her. As to the nearest distance at which it would pass her,
- that must be the result of two forces, attraction and repulsion,
- affecting its motion.
-
- "I ask but one thing," said Michel; "that we may pass near
- enough to penetrate her secrets."
-
- "Cursed be the thing that has caused our projectile to deviate
- from its course," cried Nicholl.
-
- And, as if a light had suddenly broken in upon his mind, Barbicane
- answered, "Then cursed be the meteor which crossed our path."
-
- "What?" said Michel Ardan.
-
- "What do you mean?" exclaimed Nicholl.
-
- "I mean," said Barbicane in a decided tone, "I mean that our
- deviation is owing solely to our meeting with this erring body."
-
- "But it did not even brush us as it passed," said Michel.
-
- "What does that matter? Its mass, compared to that of our
- projectile, was enormous, and its attraction was enough to
- influence our course."
-
- "So little?" cried Nicholl.
-
- "Yes, Nicholl; but however little it might be," replied
- Barbicane, "in a distance of 84,000 leagues, it wanted no more
- to make us miss the moon."
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER X
-
-
- THE OBSERVERS OF THE MOON
-
-
- Barbicane had evidently hit upon the only plausible reason
- of this deviation. However slight it might have been, it
- had sufficed to modify the course of the projectile. It was
- a fatality. The bold attempt had miscarried by a fortuitous
- circumstance; and unless by some exceptional event, they could
- now never reach the moon's disc.
-
- Would they pass near enough to be able to solve certain physical
- and geological questions until then insoluble? This was the
- question, and the only one, which occupied the minds of these
- bold travelers. As to the fate in store for themselves, they
- did not even dream of it.
-
- But what would become of them amid these infinite solitudes,
- these who would soon want air? A few more days, and they would
- fall stifled in this wandering projectile. But some days to
- these intrepid fellows was a century; and they devoted all their
- time to observe that moon which they no longer hoped to reach.
-
- The distance which had then separated the projectile from the
- satellite was estimated at about two hundred leagues. Under these
- conditions, as regards the visibility of the details of the disc,
- the travelers were farther from the moon than are the inhabitants
- of earth with their powerful telescopes.
-
- Indeed, we know that the instrument mounted by Lord Rosse at
- Parsonstown, which magnifies 6,500 times, brings the moon to
- within an apparent distance of sixteen leagues. And more than
- that, with the powerful one set up at Long's Peak, the orb of
- night, magnified 48,000 times, is brought to within less than
- two leagues, and objects having a diameter of thirty feet are
- seen very distinctly. So that, at this distance, the
- topographical details of the moon, observed without glasses,
- could not be determined with precision. The eye caught the vast
- outline of those immense depressions inappropriately called
- "seas," but they could not recognize their nature. The prominence
- of the mountains disappeared under the splendid irradiation
- produced by the reflection of the solar rays. The eye, dazzled
- as if it was leaning over a bath of molten silver, turned from
- it involuntarily; but the oblong form of the orb was quite clear.
- It appeared like a gigantic egg, with the small end turned toward
- the earth. Indeed the moon, liquid and pliable in the first days
- of its formation, was originally a perfect sphere; but being soon
- drawn within the attraction of the earth, it became elongated
- under the influence of gravitation. In becoming a satellite,
- she lost her native purity of form; her center of gravity was in
- advance of the center of her figure; and from this fact some
- savants draw the conclusion that the air and water had taken
- refuge on the opposite surface of the moon, which is never seen
- from the earth. This alteration in the primitive form of the
- satellite was only perceptible for a few moments. The distance
- of the projectile from the moon diminished very rapidly under
- its speed, though that was much less than its initial velocity--
- but eight or nine times greater than that which propels our
- express trains. The oblique course of the projectile, from its
- very obliquity, gave Michel Ardan some hopes of striking the
- lunar disc at some point or other. He could not think that they
- would never reach it. No! he could not believe it; and this
- opinion he often repeated. But Barbicane, who was a better
- judge, always answered him with merciless logic.
-
- "No, Michel, no! We can only reach the moon by a fall, and we
- are not falling. The centripetal force keeps us under the
- moon's influence, but the centrifugal force draws us
- irresistibly away from it."
-
- This was said in a tone which quenched Michel Ardan's last hope.
-
- The portion of the moon which the projectile was nearing was the
- northern hemisphere, that which the selenographic maps place
- below; for these maps are generally drawn after the outline
- given by the glasses, and we know that they reverse the objects.
- Such was the _Mappa Selenographica_ of Boeer and Moedler which
- Barbicane consulted. This northern hemisphere presented vast
- plains, dotted with isolated mountains.
-
- At midnight the moon was full. At that precise moment the
- travelers should have alighted upon it, if the mischievous
- meteor had not diverted their course. The orb was exactly in
- the condition determined by the Cambridge Observatory. It was
- mathematically at its perigee, and at the zenith of the
- twenty-eighth parallel. An observer placed at the bottom of the
- enormous Columbiad, pointed perpendicularly to the horizon,
- would have framed the moon in the mouth of the gun. A straight
- line drawn through the axis of the piece would have passed
- through the center of the orb of night. It is needless to say,
- that during the night of the 5th-6th of December, the travelers
- took not an instant's rest. Could they close their eyes when so
- near this new world? No! All their feelings were concentrated
- in one single thought:-- See! Representatives of the earth, of
- humanity, past and present, all centered in them! It is through
- their eyes that the human race look at these lunar regions, and
- penetrate the secrets of their satellite! A strange emotion
- filled their hearts as they went from one window to the other.
- Their observations, reproduced by Barbicane, were rigidly determined.
- To take them, they had glasses; to correct them, maps.
-
- As regards the optical instruments at their disposal, they had
- excellent marine glasses specially constructed for this journey.
- They possessed magnifying powers of 100. They would thus have
- brought the moon to within a distance (apparent) of less than
- 2,000 leagues from the earth. But then, at a distance which for
- three hours in the morning did not exceed sixty-five miles, and
- in a medium free from all atmospheric disturbances, these
- instruments could reduce the lunar surface to within less than
- 1,500 yards!
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XI
-
-
- FANCY AND REALITY
-
-
- "Have you ever seen the moon?" asked a professor, ironically,
- of one of his pupils.
-
- "No, sir!" replied the pupil, still more ironically, "but I must
- say I have heard it spoken of."
-
- In one sense, the pupil's witty answer might be given by a large
- majority of sublunary beings. How many people have heard speak
- of the moon who have never seen it-- at least through a glass or
- a telescope! How many have never examined the map of their satellite!
-
- In looking at a selenographic map, one peculiarity strikes us.
- Contrary to the arrangement followed for that of the Earth and
- Mars, the continents occupy more particularly the southern
- hemisphere of the lunar globe. These continents do not show
- such decided, clear, and regular boundary lines as South
- America, Africa, and the Indian peninsula. Their angular,
- capricious, and deeply indented coasts are rich in gulfs
- and peninsulas. They remind one of the confusion in the
- islands of the Sound, where the land is excessively indented.
- If navigation ever existed on the surface of the moon, it must
- have been wonderfully difficult and dangerous; and we may well
- pity the Selenite sailors and hydrographers; the former, when
- they came upon these perilous coasts, the latter when they
- took the soundings of its stormy banks.
-
- We may also notice that, on the lunar sphere, the south pole is
- much more continental than the north pole. On the latter, there
- is but one slight strip of land separated from other continents
- by vast seas. Toward the south, continents clothe almost the
- whole of the hemisphere. It is even possible that the Selenites
- have already planted the flag on one of their poles, while
- Franklin, Ross, Kane, Dumont, d'Urville, and Lambert have never
- yet been able to attain that unknown point of the terrestrial globe.
-
- As to islands, they are numerous on the surface of the moon.
- Nearly all oblong or circular, and as if traced with the
- compass, they seem to form one vast archipelago, equal to that
- charming group lying between Greece and Asia Minor, and which
- mythology in ancient times adorned with most graceful legends.
- Involuntarily the names of Naxos, Tenedos, and Carpathos, rise
- before the mind, and we seek vainly for Ulysses' vessel or the
- "clipper" of the Argonauts. So at least it was in Michel
- Ardan's eyes. To him it was a Grecian archipelago that he saw
- on the map. To the eyes of his matter-of-fact companions, the
- aspect of these coasts recalled rather the parceled-out land of
- New Brunswick and Nova Scotia, and where the Frenchman
- discovered traces of the heroes of fable, these Americans
- were marking the most favorable points for the establishment
- of stores in the interests of lunar commerce and industry.
-
- After wandering over these vast continents, the eye is attracted
- by the still greater seas. Not only their formation, but their
- situation and aspect remind one of the terrestrial oceans; but
- again, as on earth, these seas occupy the greater portion of
- the globe. But in point of fact, these are not liquid spaces,
- but plains, the nature of which the travelers hoped soon
- to determine. Astronomers, we must allow, have graced these
- pretended seas with at least odd names, which science has
- respected up to the present time. Michel Ardan was right when
- he compared this map to a "Tendre card," got up by a Scudary or
- a Cyrano de Bergerac. "Only," said he, "it is no longer the
- sentimental card of the seventeenth century, it is the card of
- life, very neatly divided into two parts, one feminine, the
- other masculine; the right hemisphere for woman, the left for man."
-
- In speaking thus, Michel made his prosaic companions shrug
- their shoulders. Barbicane and Nicholl looked upon the lunar
- map from a very different point of view to that of their
- fantastic friend. Nevertheless, their fantastic friend was a
- little in the right. Judge for yourselves.
-
- In the left hemisphere stretches the "Sea of Clouds," where
- human reason is so often shipwrecked. Not far off lies the "Sea
- of Rains," fed by all the fever of existence. Near this is the
- "Sea of Storms," where man is ever fighting against his
- passions, which too often gain the victory. Then, worn out by
- deceit, treasons, infidelity, and the whole body of terrestrial
- misery, what does he find at the end of his career? that vast
- "Sea of Humors," barely softened by some drops of the waters
- from the "Gulf of Dew!" Clouds, rain, storms, and humors-- does
- the life of man contain aught but these? and is it not summed up
- in these four words?
-
- The right hemisphere, "dedicated to the ladies," encloses
- smaller seas, whose significant names contain every incident of
- a feminine existence. There is the "Sea of Serenity," over
- which the young girl bends; "The Lake of Dreams," reflecting a
- joyous future; "The Sea of Nectar," with its waves of tenderness
- and breezes of love; "The Sea of Fruitfulness;" "The Sea of
- Crises;" then the "Sea of Vapors," whose dimensions are perhaps
- a little too confined; and lastly, that vast "Sea of
- Tranquillity," in which every false passion, every useless
- dream, every unsatisfied desire is at length absorbed, and whose
- waves emerge peacefully into the "Lake of Death!"
-
- What a strange succession of names! What a singular division of
- the moon's two hemispheres, joined to one another like man and
- woman, and forming that sphere of life carried into space!
- And was not the fantastic Michel right in thus interpreting the
- fancies of the ancient astronomers? But while his imagination
- thus roved over "the seas," his grave companions were considering
- things more geographically. They were learning this new world
- by heart. They were measuring angles and diameters.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XII
-
-
- OROGRAPHIC DETAILS
-
-
- The course taken by the projectile, as we have before remarked, was
- bearing it toward the moon's northern hemisphere. The travelers
- were far from the central point which they would have struck,
- had their course not been subject to an irremediable deviation.
- It was past midnight; and Barbicane then estimated the distance
- at seven hundred and fifty miles, which was a little greater than
- the length of the lunar radius, and which would diminish as it
- advanced nearer to the North Pole. The projectile was then not
- at the altitude of the equator; but across the tenth parallel,
- and from that latitude, carefully taken on the map to the pole,
- Barbicane and his two companions were able to observe the moon
- under the most favorable conditions. Indeed, by means of glasses,
- the above-named distance was reduced to little more than
- fourteen miles. The telescope of the Rocky Mountains brought
- the moon much nearer; but the terrestrial atmosphere singularly
- lessened its power. Thus Barbicane, posted in his projectile,
- with the glasses to his eyes, could seize upon details which were
- almost imperceptible to earthly observers.
-
- "My friends," said the president, in a serious voice, "I do not
- know whither we are going; I do not know if we shall ever see
- the terrestrial globe again. Nevertheless, let us proceed as if
- our work would one day by useful to our fellow-men. Let us keep
- our minds free from every other consideration. We are
- astronomers; and this projectile is a room in the Cambridge
- University, carried into space. Let us make our observations!"
-
- This said, work was begun with great exactness; and they
- faithfully reproduced the different aspects of the moon,
- at the different distances which the projectile reached.
-
- At the time that the projectile was as high as the tenth
- parallel, north latitude, it seemed rigidly to follow the
- twentieth degree, east longitude. We must here make one
- important remark with regard to the map by which they were
- taking observations. In the selenographical maps where, on
- account of the reversing of the objects by the glasses, the
- south is above and the north below, it would seem natural that,
- on account of that inversion, the east should be to the left
- hand, and the west to the right. But it is not so. If the map
- were turned upside down, showing the moon as we see her, the
- east would be to the left, and the west to the right, contrary
- to that which exists on terrestrial maps. The following is the
- reason of this anomaly. Observers in the northern hemisphere
- (say in Europe) see the moon in the south-- according to them.
- When they take observations, they turn their backs to the north,
- the reverse position to that which they occupy when they study
- a terrestrial map. As they turn their backs to the north, the
- east is on their left, and the west to their right. To observers
- in the southern hemisphere (Patagonia for example), the moon's
- west would be quite to their left, and the east to their right,
- as the south is behind them. Such is the reason of the apparent
- reversing of these two cardinal points, and we must bear it in mind
- in order to be able to follow President Barbicane's observations.
-
- With the help of Boeer and Moedler's _Mappa Selenographica_,
- the travelers were able at once to recognize that portion
- of the disc enclosed within the field of their glasses.
-
- "What are we looking at, at this moment?" asked Michel.
-
- "At the northern part of the `Sea of Clouds,'" answered Barbicane.
- "We are too far off to recognize its nature. Are these plains
- composed of arid sand, as the first astronomer maintained?
- Or are they nothing but immense forests, according to M. Warren
- de la Rue's opinion, who gives the moon an atmosphere, though
- a very low and a very dense one? That we shall know by and by.
- We must affirm nothing until we are in a position to do so."
-
- This "Sea of Clouds" is rather doubtfully marked out upon the maps.
- It is supposed that these vast plains are strewn with blocks of
- lava from the neighboring volcanoes on its right, Ptolemy,
- Purbach, Arzachel. But the projectile was advancing, and sensibly
- nearing it. Soon there appeared the heights which bound this sea
- at this northern limit. Before them rose a mountain radiant with
- beauty, the top of which seemed lost in an eruption of solar rays.
-
- "That is--?" asked Michel.
-
- "Copernicus," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Let us see Copernicus."
-
- This mount, situated in 9@ north latitude and 20@ east
- longitude, rose to a height of 10,600 feet above the surface of
- the moon. It is quite visible from the earth; and astronomers
- can study it with ease, particularly during the phase between
- the last quarter and the new moon, because then the shadows are
- thrown lengthways from east to west, allowing them to measure
- the heights.
-
- This Copernicus forms the most important of the radiating
- system, situated in the southern hemisphere, according to Tycho
- Brahe. It rises isolated like a gigantic lighthouse on that
- portion of the "Sea of Clouds," which is bounded by the "Sea of
- Tempests," thus lighting by its splendid rays two oceans at
- a time. It was a sight without an equal, those long luminous
- trains, so dazzling in the full moon, and which, passing the
- boundary chain on the north, extends to the "Sea of Rains."
- At one o'clock of the terrestrial morning, the projectile,
- like a balloon borne into space, overlooked the top of this
- superb mount. Barbicane could recognize perfectly its
- chief features. Copernicus is comprised in the series of
- ringed mountains of the first order, in the division of
- great circles. Like Kepler and Aristarchus, which overlook
- the "Ocean of Tempests," sometimes it appeared like a brilliant
- point through the cloudy light, and was taken for a volcano
- in activity. But it is only an extinct one-- like all on that
- side of the moon. Its circumference showed a diameter of about
- twenty-two leagues. The glasses discovered traces of
- stratification produced by successive eruptions, and the
- neighborhood was strewn with volcanic remains which still choked
- some of the craters.
-
- "There exist," said Barbicane, "several kinds of circles on the
- surface of the moon, and it is easy to see that Copernicus
- belongs to the radiating class. If we were nearer, we should
- see the cones bristling on the inside, which in former times
- were so many fiery mouths. A curious arrangement, and one
- without an exception on the lunar disc, is that the interior
- surface of these circles is the reverse of the exterior, and
- contrary to the form taken by terrestrial craters. It follows,
- then, that the general curve of the bottom of these circles
- gives a sphere of a smaller diameter than that of the moon."
-
- "And why this peculiar disposition?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "We do not know," replied Barbicane.
-
- "What splendid radiation!" said Michel. "One could hardly see
- a finer spectacle, I think."
-
- "What would you say, then," replied Barbicane, "if chance should
- bear us toward the southern hemisphere?"
-
- "Well, I should say that it was still more beautiful," retorted
- Michel Ardan.
-
- At this moment the projectile hung perpendicularly over the circle.
- The circumference of Copernicus formed almost a perfect circle,
- and its steep escarpments were clearly defined. They could even
- distinguish a second ringed enclosure. Around spread a grayish
- plain, of a wild aspect, on which every relief was marked in yellow.
- At the bottom of the circle, as if enclosed in a jewel case,
- sparkled for one instant two or three eruptive cones, like enormous
- dazzling gems. Toward the north the escarpments were lowered by a
- depression which would probably have given access to the interior
- of the crater.
-
- In passing over the surrounding plains, Barbicane noticed a
- great number of less important mountains; and among others a
- little ringed one called Guy Lussac, the breadth of which
- measured twelve miles.
-
- Toward the south, the plain was very flat, without one
- elevation, without one projection. Toward the north, on the
- contrary, till where it was bounded by the "Sea of Storms," it
- resembled a liquid surface agitated by a storm, of which the
- hills and hollows formed a succession of waves suddenly congealed.
- Over the whole of this, and in all directions, lay the luminous
- lines, all converging to the summit of Copernicus.
-
- The travelers discussed the origin of these strange rays; but they
- could not determine their nature any more than terrestrial observers.
-
- "But why," said Nicholl, "should not these rays be simply spurs
- of mountains which reflect more vividly the light of the sun?"
-
- "No," replied Barbicane; "if it was so, under certain conditions
- of the moon, these ridges would cast shadows, and they do not
- cast any."
-
- And indeed, these rays only appeared when the orb of day was in
- opposition to the moon, and disappeared as soon as its rays
- became oblique.
-
- "But how have they endeavored to explain these lines of light?"
- asked Michel; "for I cannot believe that savants would ever be
- stranded for want of an explanation."
-
- "Yes," replied Barbicane; "Herschel has put forward an opinion,
- but he did not venture to affirm it."
-
- "Never mind. What was the opinion?"
-
- "He thought that these rays might be streams of cooled lava
- which shone when the sun beat straight upon them. It may be so;
- but nothing can be less certain. Besides, if we pass nearer to
- Tycho, we shall be in a better position to find out the cause of
- this radiation."
-
- "Do you know, my friends, what that plain, seen from the height
- we are at, resembles?" said Michel.
-
- "No," replied Nicholl.
-
- "Very well; with all those pieces of lava lengthened like rockets,
- it resembles an immense game of spelikans thrown pellmell.
- There wants but the hook to pull them out one by one."
-
- "Do be serious," said Barbicane.
-
- "Well, let us be serious," replied Michel quietly; "and instead
- of spelikans, let us put bones. This plain, would then be
- nothing but an immense cemetery, on which would repose the
- mortal remains of thousands of extinct generations. Do you
- prefer that high-flown comparison?"
-
- "One is as good as the other," retorted Barbicane.
-
- "My word, you are difficult to please," answered Michel.
-
- "My worthy friend," continued the matter-of-fact Barbicane, "it
- matters but little what it _resembles_, when we do not know what
- it _is_."
-
- "Well answered," exclaimed Michel. "That will teach me to
- reason with savants."
-
- But the projectile continued to advance with almost uniform
- speed around the lunar disc. The travelers, we may easily
- imagine, did not dream of taking a moment's rest. Every minute
- changed the landscape which fled from beneath their gaze.
- About half past one o'clock in the morning, they caught a glimpse
- of the tops of another mountain. Barbicane, consulting his map,
- recognized Eratosthenes.
-
- It was a ringed mountain nine thousand feet high, and one of
- those circles so numerous on this satellite. With regard to
- this, Barbicane related Kepler's singular opinion on the
- formation of circles. According to that celebrated
- mathematician, these crater-like cavities had been dug by the
- hand of man.
-
- "For what purpose?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "For a very natural one," replied Barbicane. "The Selenites
- might have undertaken these immense works and dug these enormous
- holes for a refuge and shield from the solar rays which beat
- upon them during fifteen consecutive days."
-
- "The Selenites are not fools," said Michel.
-
- "A singular idea," replied Nicholl; "but it is probable that
- Kepler did not know the true dimensions of these circles, for
- the digging of them would have been the work of giants quite
- impossible for the Selenites."
-
- "Why? if weight on the moon's surface is six times less than on
- the earth?" said Michel.
-
- "But if the Selenites are six times smaller?" retorted Nicholl.
-
- "And if there are _no_ Selenites?" added Barbicane.
-
- This put an end to the discussion.
-
- Soon Eratosthenes disappeared under the horizon without the
- projectile being sufficiently near to allow close observation.
- This mountain separated the Apennines from the Carpathians. In the
- lunar orography they have discerned some chains of mountains, which
- are chiefly distributed over the northern hemisphere. Some, however,
- occupy certain portions of the southern hemisphere also.
-
- About two o'clock in the morning Barbicane found that they were
- above the twentieth lunar parallel. The distance of the
- projectile from the moon was not more than six hundred miles.
- Barbicane, now perceiving that the projectile was steadily
- approaching the lunar disc, did not despair; if not of reaching
- her, at least of discovering the secrets of her configuration.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIII
-
-
- LUNAR LANDSCAPES
-
-
- At half-past two in the morning, the projectile was over the
- thirteenth lunar parallel and at the effective distance of five
- hundred miles, reduced by the glasses to five. It still seemed
- impossible, however, that it could ever touch any part of the disc.
- Its motive speed, comparatively so moderate, was inexplicable to
- President Barbicane. At that distance from the moon it must have
- been considerable, to enable it to bear up against her attraction.
- Here was a phenomenon the cause of which escaped them again.
- Besides, time failed them to investigate the cause. All lunar
- relief was defiling under the eyes of the travelers, and they
- would not lose a single detail.
-
- Under the glasses the disc appeared at the distance of five
- miles. What would an aeronaut, borne to this distance from the
- earth, distinguish on its surface? We cannot say, since the
- greatest ascension has not been more than 25,000 feet.
-
- This, however, is an exact description of what Barbicane and his
- companions saw at this height. Large patches of different
- colors appeared on the disc. Selenographers are not agreed upon
- the nature of these colors. There are several, and rather
- vividly marked. Julius Schmidt pretends that, if the
- terrestrial oceans were dried up, a Selenite observer could not
- distinguish on the globe a greater diversity of shades between
- the oceans and the continental plains than those on the moon
- present to a terrestrial observer. According to him, the color
- common to the vast plains known by the name of "seas" is a dark
- gray mixed with green and brown. Some of the large craters
- present the same appearance. Barbicane knew this opinion of the
- German selenographer, an opinion shared by Boeer and Moedler.
- Observation has proved that right was on their side, and not on
- that of some astronomers who admit the existence of only gray on
- the moon's surface. In some parts green was very distinct, such
- as springs, according to Julius Schmidt, from the seas of
- "Serenity and Humors." Barbicane also noticed large craters,
- without any interior cones, which shed a bluish tint similar to
- the reflection of a sheet of steel freshly polished. These colors
- belonged really to the lunar disc, and did not result, as some
- astronomers say, either from the imperfection in the objective
- of the glasses or from the interposition of the terrestrial atmosphere.
-
- Not a doubt existed in Barbicane's mind with regard to it, as he
- observed it through space, and so could not commit any optical error.
- He considered the establishment of this fact as an acquisition
- to science. Now, were these shades of green, belonging to
- tropical vegetation, kept up by a low dense atmosphere? He could
- not yet say.
-
- Farther on, he noticed a reddish tint, quite defined. The same
- shade had before been observed at the bottom of an isolated
- enclosure, known by the name of Lichtenburg's circle, which is
- situated near the Hercynian mountains, on the borders of the
- moon; but they could not tell the nature of it.
-
- They were not more fortunate with regard to another peculiarity
- of the disc, for they could not decide upon the cause of it.
-
- Michel Ardan was watching near the president, when he noticed
- long white lines, vividly lighted up by the direct rays of the sun.
- It was a succession of luminous furrows, very different from the
- radiation of Copernicus not long before; they ran parallel with
- each other.
-
- Michel, with his usual readiness, hastened to exclaim:
-
- "Look there! cultivated fields!"
-
- "Cultivated fields!" replied Nicholl, shrugging his shoulders.
-
- "Plowed, at all events," retorted Michel Ardan; "but what
- laborers those Selenites must be, and what giant oxen they must
- harness to their plow to cut such furrows!"
-
- "They are not furrows," said Barbicane; "they are _rifts_."
-
- "Rifts? stuff!" replied Michel mildly; "but what do you mean by
- `rifts' in the scientific world?"
-
- Barbicane immediately enlightened his companion as to what he
- knew about lunar rifts. He knew that they were a kind of furrow
- found on every part of the disc which was not mountainous; that
- these furrows, generally isolated, measured from 400 to 500
- leagues in length; that their breadth varied from 1,000 to 1,500
- yards, and that their borders were strictly parallel; but he
- knew nothing more either of their formation or their nature.
-
- Barbicane, through his glasses, observed these rifts with
- great attention. He noticed that their borders were formed of
- steep declivities; they were long parallel ramparts, and with some
- small amount of imagination he might have admitted the existence
- of long lines of fortifications, raised by Selenite engineers.
- Of these different rifts some were perfectly straight, as if cut
- by a line; others were slightly curved, though still keeping
- their borders parallel; some crossed each other, some cut through
- craters; here they wound through ordinary cavities, such as
- Posidonius or Petavius; there they wound through the seas, such
- as the "Sea of Serenity."
-
- These natural accidents naturally excited the imaginations of
- these terrestrial astronomers. The first observations had not
- discovered these rifts. Neither Hevelius, Cassin, La Hire, nor
- Herschel seemed to have known them. It was Schroeter who in
- 1789 first drew attention to them. Others followed who studied
- them, as Pastorff, Gruithuysen, Boeer, and Moedler. At this
- time their number amounts to seventy; but, if they have been
- counted, their nature has not yet been determined; they are
- certainly _not_ fortifications, any more than they are the
- ancient beds of dried-up rivers; for, on one side, the waters,
- so slight on the moon's surface, could never have worn such
- drains for themselves; and, on the other, they often cross
- craters of great elevation.
-
- We must, however, allow that Michel Ardan had "an idea," and
- that, without knowing it, he coincided in that respect with
- Julius Schmidt.
-
- "Why," said he, "should not these unaccountable appearances be
- simply phenomena of vegetation?"
-
- "What do you mean?" asked Barbicane quickly.
-
- "Do not excite yourself, my worthy president," replied Michel;
- "might it not be possible that the dark lines forming that
- bastion were rows of trees regularly placed?"
-
- "You stick to your vegetation, then?" said Barbicane.
-
- "I like," retorted Michel Ardan, "to explain what you savants
- cannot explain; at least my hypotheses has the advantage of
- indicating why these rifts disappear, or seem to disappear, at
- certain seasons."
-
- "And for what reason?"
-
- "For the reason that the trees become invisible when they lose
- their leaves, and visible again when they regain them."
-
- "Your explanation is ingenious, my dear companion," replied
- Barbicane, "but inadmissible."
-
- "Why?"
-
- "Because, so to speak, there are no seasons on the moon's surface,
- and that, consequently, the phenomena of vegetation of which you
- speak cannot occur."
-
- Indeed, the slight obliquity of the lunar axis keeps the sun at
- an almost equal height in every latitude. Above the equatorial
- regions the radiant orb almost invariably occupies the zenith,
- and does not pass the limits of the horizon in the polar
- regions; thus, according to each region, there reigns a
- perpetual winter, spring, summer, or autumn, as in the planet
- Jupiter, whose axis is but little inclined upon its orbit.
-
- What origin do they attribute to these rifts? That is a
- question difficult to solve. They are certainly anterior to the
- formation of craters and circles, for several have introduced
- themselves by breaking through their circular ramparts. Thus it
- may be that, contemporary with the later geological epochs, they
- are due to the expansion of natural forces.
-
- But the projectile had now attained the fortieth degree of lunar
- latitude, at a distance not exceeding 40 miles. Through the
- glasses objects appeared to be only four miles distant.
-
- At this point, under their feet, rose Mount Helicon, 1,520 feet
- high, and round about the left rose moderate elevations,
- enclosing a small portion of the "Sea of Rains," under the name
- of the Gulf of Iris. The terrestrial atmosphere would have to
- be one hundred and seventy times more transparent than it is,
- to allow astronomers to make perfect observations on the moon's
- surface; but in the void in which the projectile floated no
- fluid interposed itself between the eye of the observer and
- the object observed. And more, Barbicane found himself carried
- to a greater distance than the most powerful telescopes had
- ever done before, either that of Lord Rosse or that of the
- Rocky Mountains. He was, therefore, under extremely favorable
- conditions for solving that great question of the habitability
- of the moon; but the solution still escaped him; he could
- distinguish nothing but desert beds, immense plains, and toward
- the north, arid mountains. Not a work betrayed the hand of man;
- not a ruin marked his course; not a group of animals was to be
- seen indicating life, even in an inferior degree. In no part
- was there life, in no part was there an appearance of vegetation.
- Of the three kingdoms which share the terrestrial globe between
- them, one alone was represented on the lunar and that the mineral.
-
- "Ah, indeed!" said Michel Ardan, a little out of countenance;
- "then you see no one?"
-
- "No," answered Nicholl; "up to this time, not a man, not an
- animal, not a tree! After all, whether the atmosphere has taken
- refuge at the bottom of cavities, in the midst of the circles,
- or even on the opposite face of the moon, we cannot decide."
-
- "Besides," added Barbicane, "even to the most piercing eye a man
- cannot be distinguished farther than three and a half miles off;
- so that, if there are any Selenites, they can see our projectile,
- but we cannot see them."
-
- Toward four in the morning, at the height of the fiftieth
- parallel, the distance was reduced to 300 miles. To the left
- ran a line of mountains capriciously shaped, lying in the
- full light. To the right, on the contrary, lay a black hollow
- resembling a vast well, unfathomable and gloomy, drilled into
- the lunar soil.
-
- This hole was the "Black Lake"; it was Pluto, a deep circle
- which can be conveniently studied from the earth, between the
- last quarter and the new moon, when the shadows fall from west
- to east.
-
- This black color is rarely met with on the surface of
- the satellite. As yet it has only been recognized in the depths
- of the circle of Endymion, to the east of the "Cold Sea," in the
- northern hemisphere, and at the bottom of Grimaldi's circle, on
- the equator, toward the eastern border of the orb.
-
- Pluto is an annular mountain, situated in 51@ north latitude,
- and 9@ east longitude. Its circuit is forty-seven miles long
- and thirty-two broad.
-
- Barbicane regretted that they were not passing directly above
- this vast opening. There was an abyss to fathom, perhaps some
- mysterious phenomenon to surprise; but the projectile's course
- could not be altered. They must rigidly submit. They could not
- guide a balloon, still less a projectile, when once enclosed
- within its walls. Toward five in the morning the northern
- limits of the "Sea of Rains" was at length passed. The mounts
- of Condamine and Fontenelle remained-- one on the right, the
- other on the left. That part of the disc beginning with 60@ was
- becoming quite mountainous. The glasses brought them to within
- two miles, less than that separating the summit of Mont Blanc
- from the level of the sea. The whole region was bristling with
- spikes and circles. Toward the 60@ Philolaus stood predominant
- at a height of 5,550 feet with its elliptical crater, and seen
- from this distance, the disc showed a very fantastical appearance.
- Landscapes were presented to the eye under very different
- conditions from those on the earth, and also very inferior to them.
-
- The moon having no atmosphere, the consequences arising from
- the absence of this gaseous envelope have already been shown.
- No twilight on her surface; night following day and day following
- night with the suddenness of a lamp which is extinguished or
- lighted amid profound darkness-- no transition from cold to
- heat, the temperature falling in an instant from boiling point
- to the cold of space.
-
- Another consequence of this want of air is that absolute
- darkness reigns where the sun's rays do not penetrate.
- That which on earth is called diffusion of light, that luminous
- matter which the air holds in suspension, which creates the
- twilight and the daybreak, which produces the _umbrae_ and
- _penumbrae_, and all the magic of _chiaro-oscuro_, does not
- exist on the moon. Hence the harshness of contrasts, which
- only admit of two colors, black and white. If a Selenite
- were to shade his eyes from the sun's rays, the sky would seem
- absolutely black, and the stars would shine to him as on the
- darkest night. Judge of the impression produced on Barbicane
- and his three friends by this strange scene! Their eyes
- were confused. They could no longer grasp the respective
- distances of the different plains. A lunar landscape without
- the softening of the phenomena of _chiaro-oscuro_ could not be
- rendered by an earthly landscape painter; it would be spots of
- ink on a white page-- nothing more.
-
- This aspect was not altered even when the projectile, at the
- height of 80@, was only separated from the moon by a distance
- of fifty miles; nor even when, at five in the morning, it
- passed at less than twenty-five miles from the mountain of
- Gioja, a distance reduced by the glasses to a quarter of a mile.
- It seemed as if the moon might be touched by the hand!
- It seemed impossible that, before long, the projectile would
- not strike her, if only at the north pole, the brilliant arch
- of which was so distinctly visible on the black sky.
-
- Michel Ardan wanted to open one of the scuttles and throw
- himself on to the moon's surface! A very useless attempt; for
- if the projectile could not attain any point whatever of the
- satellite, Michel, carried along by its motion, could not attain
- it either.
-
- At that moment, at six o'clock, the lunar pole appeared. The disc
- only presented to the travelers' gaze one half brilliantly lit up,
- while the other disappeared in the darkness. Suddenly the
- projectile passed the line of demarcation between intense light
- and absolute darkness, and was plunged in profound night!
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIV
-
-
- THE NIGHT OF THREE HUNDRED AND FIFTY-FOUR HOURS AND A HALF
-
- At the moment when this phenomenon took place so rapidly, the
- projectile was skirting the moon's north pole at less than
- twenty-five miles distance. Some seconds had sufficed to plunge
- it into the absolute darkness of space. The transition was so
- sudden, without shade, without gradation of light, without
- attenuation of the luminous waves, that the orb seemed to have
- been extinguished by a powerful blow.
-
- "Melted, disappeared!" Michel Ardan exclaimed, aghast.
-
- Indeed, there was neither reflection nor shadow. Nothing more
- was to be seen of that disc, formerly so dazzling. The darkness
- was complete. and rendered even more so by the rays from the stars.
- It was "that blackness" in which the lunar nights are insteeped,
- which last three hundred and fifty-four hours and a half at each
- point of the disc, a long night resulting from the equality of
- the translatory and rotary movements of the moon. The projectile,
- immerged in the conical shadow of the satellite, experienced the
- action of the solar rays no more than any of its invisible points.
-
- In the interior, the obscurity was complete. They could not see
- each other. Hence the necessity of dispelling the darkness.
- However desirous Barbicane might be to husband the gas, the
- reserve of which was small, he was obliged to ask from it a
- fictitious light, an expensive brilliancy which the sun then refused.
-
- "Devil take the radiant orb!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, "which
- forces us to expend gas, instead of giving us his rays gratuitously."
-
- "Do not let us accuse the sun," said Nicholl, "it is not his
- fault, but that of the moon, which has come and placed herself
- like a screen between us and it."
-
- "It is the sun!" continued Michel.
-
- "It is the moon!" retorted Nicholl.
-
- An idle dispute, which Barbicane put an end to by saying:
-
- "My friends, it is neither the fault of the sun nor of the moon;
- it is the fault of the _projectile_, which, instead of rigidly
- following its course, has awkwardly missed it. To be more just,
- it is the fault of that unfortunate meteor which has so
- deplorably altered our first direction."
-
- "Well," replied Michel Ardan, "as the matter is settled, let us
- have breakfast. After a whole night of watching it is fair to
- build ourselves up a little."
-
- This proposal meeting with no contradiction, Michel prepared the
- repast in a few minutes. But they ate for eating's sake, they
- drank without toasts, without hurrahs. The bold travelers being
- borne away into gloomy space, without their accustomed
- _cortege_ of rays, felt a vague uneasiness in their hearts.
- The "strange" shadow so dear to Victor Hugo's pen bound them on
- all sides. But they talked over the interminable night of three
- hundred and fifty-four hours and a half, nearly fifteen days,
- which the law of physics has imposed on the inhabitants of the moon.
-
- Barbicane gave his friends some explanation of the causes and
- the consequences of this curious phenomenon.
-
- "Curious indeed," said they; "for, if each hemisphere of the
- moon is deprived of solar light for fifteen days, that above
- which we now float does not even enjoy during its long night any
- view of the earth so beautifully lit up. In a word she has no
- moon (applying this designation to our globe) but on one side of
- her disc. Now if this were the case with the earth-- if, for
- example, Europe never saw the moon, and she was only visible at
- the antipodes, imagine to yourself the astonishment of a
- European on arriving in Australia."
-
- "They would make the voyage for nothing but to see the moon!"
- replied Michel.
-
- "Very well!" continued Barbicane, "that astonishment is reserved
- for the Selenites who inhabit the face of the moon opposite to
- the earth, a face which is ever invisible to our countrymen of
- the terrestrial globe."
-
- "And which we should have seen," added Nicholl, "if we had arrived
- here when the moon was new, that is to say fifteen days later."
-
- "I will add, to make amends," continued Barbicane, "that the
- inhabitants of the visible face are singularly favored by nature,
- to the detriment of their brethren on the invisible face.
- The latter, as you see, have dark nights of 354 hours, without
- one single ray to break the darkness. The other, on the contrary,
- when the sun which has given its light for fifteen days sinks
- below the horizon, see a splendid orb rise on the opposite horizon.
- It is the earth, which is thirteen times greater than the
- diminutive moon that we know-- the earth which developes itself
- at a diameter of two degrees, and which sheds a light thirteen
- times greater than that qualified by atmospheric strata-- the
- earth which only disappears at the moment when the sun reappears
- in its turn!"
-
- "Nicely worded!" said Michel, "slightly academical perhaps."
-
- "It follows, then," continued Barbicane, without knitting his
- brows, "that the visible face of the disc must be very agreeable
- to inhabit, since it always looks on either the sun when the
- moon is full, or on the earth when the moon is new."
-
- "But," said Nicholl, "that advantage must be well compensated by
- the insupportable heat which the light brings with it."
-
- "The inconvenience, in that respect, is the same for the two
- faces, for the earth's light is evidently deprived of heat.
- But the invisible face is still more searched by the heat than
- the visible face. I say that for _you_, Nicholl, because Michel
- will probably not understand."
-
- "Thank you," said Michel.
-
- "Indeed," continued Barbicane, "when the invisible face receives
- at the same time light and heat from the sun, it is because the
- moon is new; that is to say, she is situated between the sun and
- the earth. It follows, then, considering the position which she
- occupies in opposition when full, that she is nearer to the sun
- by twice her distance from the earth; and that distance may be
- estimated at the two-hundredth part of that which separates the
- sun from the earth, or in round numbers 400,000 miles. So that
- invisible face is so much nearer to the sun when she receives
- its rays."
-
- "Quite right," replied Nicholl.
-
- "On the contrary," continued Barbicane.
-
- "One moment," said Michel, interrupting his grave companion.
-
- "What do you want?"
-
- "I ask to be allowed to continue the explanation."
-
- "And why?"
-
- "To prove that I understand."
-
- "Get along with you," said Barbicane, smiling.
-
- "On the contrary," said Michel, imitating the tone and gestures
- of the president, "on the contrary, when the visible face of the
- moon is lit by the sun, it is because the moon is full, that is
- to say, opposite the sun with regard to the earth. The distance
- separating it from the radiant orb is then increased in round
- numbers to 400,000 miles, and the heat which she receives must
- be a little less."
-
- "Very well said!" exclaimed Barbicane. "Do you know, Michel,
- that, for an amateur, you are intelligent."
-
- "Yes," replied Michel coolly, "we are all so on the Boulevard
- des Italiens."
-
- Barbicane gravely grasped the hand of his amiable companion, and
- continued to enumerate the advantages reserved for the inhabitants
- of the visible face.
-
- Among others, he mentioned eclipses of the sun, which only take
- place on this side of the lunar disc; since, in order that they
- may take place, it is necessary for the moon to be _in
- opposition_. These eclipses, caused by the interposition of the
- earth between the moon and the sun, can last _two hours_; during
- which time, by reason of the rays refracted by its atmosphere,
- the terrestrial globe can appear as nothing but a black point
- upon the sun.
-
- "So," said Nicholl, "there is a hemisphere, that invisible
- hemisphere which is very ill supplied, very ill treated,
- by nature."
-
- "Never mind," replied Michel; "if we ever become Selenites, we
- will inhabit the visible face. I like the light."
-
- "Unless, by any chance," answered Nicholl, "the atmosphere should
- be condensed on the other side, as certain astronomers pretend."
-
- "That would be a consideration," said Michel.
-
- Breakfast over, the observers returned to their post. They tried
- to see through the darkened scuttles by extinguishing all light
- in the projectile; but not a luminous spark made its way through
- the darkness.
-
- One inexplicable fact preoccupied Barbicane. Why, having passed
- within such a short distance of the moon--about twenty-five
- miles only-- why the projectile had not fallen? If its speed
- had been enormous, he could have understood that the fall would
- not have taken place; but, with a relatively moderate speed,
- that resistance to the moon's attraction could not be explained.
- Was the projectile under some foreign influence? Did some kind
- of body retain it in the ether? It was quite evident that it
- could never reach any point of the moon. Whither was it going?
- Was it going farther from, or nearing, the disc? Was it being
- borne in that profound darkness through the infinity of space?
- How could they learn, how calculate, in the midst of this night?
- All these questions made Barbicane uneasy, but he could not
- solve them.
-
- Certainly, the invisible orb was _there_, perhaps only some few
- miles off; but neither he nor his companions could see it.
- If there was any noise on its surface, they could not hear it.
- Air, that medium of sound, was wanting to transmit the groanings
- of that moon which the Arabic legends call "a man already half
- granite, and still breathing."
-
- One must allow that that was enough to aggravate the most
- patient observers. It was just that unknown hemisphere which
- was stealing from their sight. That face which fifteen days
- sooner, or fifteen days later, had been, or would be, splendidly
- illuminated by the solar rays, was then being lost in utter darkness.
- In fifteen days where would the projectile be? Who could say?
- Where would the chances of conflicting attractions have drawn
- it to? The disappointment of the travelers in the midst of this
- utter darkness may be imagined. All observation of the lunar
- disc was impossible. The constellations alone claimed all their
- attention; and we must allow that the astronomers Faye, Charconac,
- and Secchi, never found themselves in circumstances so favorable
- for their observation.
-
- Indeed, nothing could equal the splendor of this starry world,
- bathed in limpid ether. Its diamonds set in the heavenly vault
- sparkled magnificently. The eye took in the firmament from the
- Southern Cross to the North Star, those two constellations which
- in 12,000 years, by reason of the succession of equinoxes, will
- resign their part of the polar stars, the one to Canopus in the
- southern hemisphere, the other to Wega in the northern.
- Imagination loses itself in this sublime Infinity, amid which
- the projectile was gravitating, like a new star created by the
- hand of man. From a natural cause, these constellations shone
- with a soft luster; they did not twinkle, for there was no
- atmosphere which, by the intervention of its layers unequally
- dense and of different degrees of humidity, produces
- this scintillation. These stars were soft eyes, looking out
- into the dark night, amid the silence of absolute space.
-
- Long did the travelers stand mute, watching the constellated
- firmament, upon which the moon, like a vast screen, made an
- enormous black hole. But at length a painful sensation drew
- them from their watchings. This was an intense cold, which soon
- covered the inside of the glass of the scuttles with a thick
- coating of ice. The sun was no longer warming the projectile
- with its direct rays, and thus it was losing the heat stored up
- in its walls by degrees. This heat was rapidly evaporating into
- space by radiation, and a considerably lower temperature was
- the result. The humidity of the interior was changed into ice
- upon contact with the glass, preventing all observation.
-
- Nicholl consulted the thermometer, and saw that it had fallen to
- seventeen degrees (Centigrade) below zero. [3] So that, in spite
- of the many reasons for economizing, Barbicane, after having
- begged light from the gas, was also obliged to beg for heat.
- The projectile's low temperature was no longer endurable.
- Its tenants would have been frozen to death.
-
- [3] 1@ Fahrenheit.
-
- "Well!" observed Michel, "we cannot reasonably complain of the
- monotony of our journey! What variety we have had, at least
- in temperature. Now we are blinded with light and saturated with
- heat, like the Indians of the Pampas! now plunged into profound
- darkness, amid the cold, like the Esquimaux of the north pole.
- No, indeed! we have no right to complain; nature does wonders in
- our honor."
-
- "But," asked Nicholl, "what is the temperature outside?"
-
- "Exactly that of the planetary space," replied Barbicane.
-
- "Then," continued Michel Ardan, "would not this be the time to
- make the experiment which we dared not attempt when we were
- drowned in the sun's rays?
-
- "It is now or never," replied Barbicane, "for we are in a good
- position to verify the temperature of space, and see if Fourier
- or Pouillet's calculations are exact."
-
- "In any case it is cold," said Michel. "See! the steam of the
- interior is condensing on the glasses of the scuttles. If the fall
- continues, the vapor of our breath will fall in snow around us."
-
- "Let us prepare a thermometer," said Barbicane.
-
- We may imagine that an ordinary thermometer would afford no
- result under the circumstances in which this instrument was to
- be exposed. The mercury would have been frozen in its ball,
- as below 42@ Fahrenheit below zero it is no longer liquid.
- But Barbicane had furnished himself with a spirit thermometer
- on Wafferdin's system, which gives the minima of excessively
- low temperatures.
-
- Before beginning the experiment, this instrument was compared
- with an ordinary one, and then Barbicane prepared to use it.
-
- "How shall we set about it?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Nothing is easier," replied Michel Ardan, who was never at a loss.
- "We open the scuttle rapidly; throw out the instrument; it follows
- the projectile with exemplary docility; and a quarter of an hour
- after, draw it in."
-
- "With the hand?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "With the hand," replied Michel.
-
- "Well, then, my friend, do not expose yourself," answered
- Barbicane, "for the hand that you draw in again will be nothing
- but a stump frozen and deformed by the frightful cold."
-
- "Really!"
-
- "You will feel as if you had had a terrible burn, like that of
- iron at a white heat; for whether the heat leaves our bodies
- briskly or enters briskly, it is exactly the same thing.
- Besides, I am not at all certain that the objects we have thrown
- out are still following us."
-
- "Why not?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Because, if we are passing through an atmosphere of the
- slightest density, these objects will be retarded. Again, the
- darkness prevents our seeing if they still float around us.
- But in order not to expose ourselves to the loss of our
- thermometer, we will fasten it, and we can then more easily
- pull it back again."
-
- Barbicane's advice was followed. Through the scuttle rapidly
- opened, Nicholl threw out the instrument, which was held by a
- short cord, so that it might be more easily drawn up. The scuttle
- had not been opened more than a second, but that second had sufficed
- to let in a most intense cold.
-
- "The devil!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, "it is cold enough to
- freeze a white bear."
-
- Barbicane waited until half an hour had elapsed, which was more
- than time enough to allow the instrument to fall to the level of
- the surrounding temperature. Then it was rapidly pulled in.
-
- Barbicane calculated the quantity of spirits of wine overflowed
- into the little vial soldered to the lower part of the
- instrument, and said:
-
- "A hundred and forty degrees Centigrade [4] below zero!"
-
- [4] 218 degrees Fahrenheit below zero.
-
- M. Pouillet was right and Fourier wrong. That was the undoubted
- temperature of the starry space. Such is, perhaps, that of the
- lunar continents, when the orb of night has lost by radiation
- all the heat which fifteen days of sun have poured into her.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XV
-
-
- HYPERBOLA OR PARABOLA
-
-
- We may, perhaps, be astonished to find Barbicane and his
- companions so little occupied with the future reserved for them
- in their metal prison which was bearing them through the
- infinity of space. Instead of asking where they were going,
- they passed their time making experiments, as if they had been
- quietly installed in their own study.
-
- We might answer that men so strong-minded were above such
- anxieties-- that they did not trouble themselves about such
- trifles-- and that they had something else to do than to
- occupy their minds with the future.
-
- The truth was that they were not masters of their projectile;
- they could neither check its course, nor alter its direction.
-
- A sailor can change the head of his ship as he pleases; an
- aeronaut can give a vertical motion to his balloon. They, on
- the contrary, had no power over their vehicle. Every maneuver
- was forbidden. Hence the inclination to let things alone, or as
- the sailors say, "let her run."
-
- Where did they find themselves at this moment, at eight o'clock in
- the morning of the day called upon the earth the 6th of December?
- Very certainly in the neighborhood of the moon, and even near
- enough for her to look to them like an enormous black screen upon
- the firmament. As to the distance which separated them, it was
- impossible to estimate it. The projectile, held by some
- unaccountable force, had been within four miles of grazing the
- satellite's north pole.
-
- But since entering the cone of shadow these last two hours, had
- the distance increased or diminished? Every point of mark was
- wanting by which to estimate both the direction and the speed of
- the projectile.
-
- Perhaps it was rapidly leaving the disc, so that it would soon
- quit the pure shadow. Perhaps, again, on the other hand, it
- might be nearing it so much that in a short time it might strike
- some high point on the invisible hemisphere, which would doubtlessly
- have ended the journey much to the detriment of the travelers.
-
- A discussion arose on this subject, and Michel Ardan, always
- ready with an explanation, gave it as his opinion that the
- projectile, held by the lunar attraction, would end by falling
- on the surface of the terrestrial globe like an aerolite.
-
- "First of all, my friend," answered Barbicane, "every aerolite
- does not fall to the earth; it is only a small proportion which
- do so; and if we had passed into an aerolite, it does not necessarily
- follow that we should ever reach the surface of the moon."
-
- "But how if we get near enough?" replied Michel.
-
- "Pure mistake," replied Barbicane. "Have you not seen shooting
- stars rush through the sky by thousands at certain seasons?"
-
- "Yes."
-
- "Well, these stars, or rather corpuscles, only shine when they
- are heated by gliding over the atmospheric layers. Now, if
- they enter the atmosphere, they pass at least within forty
- miles of the earth, but they seldom fall upon it. The same with
- our projectile. It may approach very near to the moon, and not
- yet fall upon it."
-
- "But then," asked Michel, "I shall be curious to know how our
- erring vehicle will act in space?"
-
- "I see but two hypotheses," replied Barbicane, after some
- moments' reflection.
-
- "What are they?"
-
- "The projectile has the choice between two mathematical curves,
- and it will follow one or the other according to the speed with
- which it is animated, and which at this moment I cannot estimate."
-
- "Yes," said Nicholl, "it will follow either a parabola or
- a hyperbola."
-
- "Just so," replied Barbicane. "With a certain speed it will
- assume the parabola, and with a greater the hyperbola."
-
- "I like those grand words," exclaimed Michel Ardan; "one knows
- directly what they mean. And pray what is your parabola, if
- you please?"
-
- "My friend," answered the captain, "the parabola is a curve of
- the second order, the result of the section of a cone
- intersected by a plane parallel to one of the sides."
-
- "Ah! ah!" said Michel, in a satisfied tone.
-
- "It is very nearly," continued Nicholl, "the course described by
- a bomb launched from a mortar."
-
- "Perfect! And the hyperbola?"
-
- "The hyperbola, Michel, is a curve of the second order, produced
- by the intersection of a conic surface and a plane parallel to
- its axis, and constitutes two branches separated one from the other,
- both tending indefinitely in the two directions."
-
- "Is it possible!" exclaimed Michel Ardan in a serious tone, as
- if they had told him of some serious event. "What I particularly
- like in your definition of the hyperbola (I was going to say
- hyperblague) is that it is still more obscure than the word you
- pretend to define."
-
- Nicholl and Barbicane cared little for Michel Ardan's fun.
- They were deep in a scientific discussion. What curve would
- the projectile follow? was their hobby. One maintained the
- hyperbola, the other the parabola. They gave each other reasons
- bristling with _x_. Their arguments were couched in language
- which made Michel jump. The discussion was hot, and neither
- would give up his chosen curve to his adversary.
-
- This scientific dispute lasted so long that it made Michel
- very impatient.
-
- "Now, gentlemen cosines, will you cease to throw parabolas and
- hyperbolas at each other's heads? I want to understand the only
- interesting question in the whole affair. We shall follow one
- or the other of these curves? Good. But where will they lead
- us to?"
-
- "Nowhere," replied Nicholl.
-
- "How, nowhere?"
-
- "Evidently," said Barbicane, "they are open curves, which may be
- prolonged indefinitely."
-
- "Ah, savants!" cried Michel; "and what are either the one or the
- other to us from the moment we know that they equally lead us
- into infinite space?"
-
- Barbicane and Nicholl could not forbear smiling. They had just
- been creating "art for art's sake." Never had so idle a question
- been raised at such an inopportune moment. The sinister truth
- remained that, whether hyperbolically or parabolically borne away,
- the projectile would never again meet either the earth or the moon.
-
- What would become of these bold travelers in the immediate future?
- If they did not die of hunger, if they did not die of thirst,
- in some days, when the gas failed, they would die from want of air,
- unless the cold had killed them first. Still, important as it was
- to economize the gas, the excessive lowness of the surrounding
- temperature obliged them to consume a certain quantity.
- Strictly speaking, they could do without its _light_, but not
- without its _heat_. Fortunately the caloric generated by Reiset's
- and Regnaut's apparatus raised the temperature of the interior
- of the projectile a little, and without much expenditure they
- were able to keep it bearable.
-
- But observations had now become very difficult. the dampness of
- the projectile was condensed on the windows and congealed immediately.
- This cloudiness had to be dispersed continually. In any case
- they might hope to be able to discover some phenomena of the
- highest interest.
-
- But up to this time the disc remained dumb and dark. It did not
- answer the multiplicity of questions put by these ardent minds;
- a matter which drew this reflection from Michel, apparently a
- just one:
-
- "If ever we begin this journey over again, we shall do well to
- choose the time when the moon is at the full."
-
- "Certainly," said Nicholl, "that circumstance will be more favorable.
- I allow that the moon, immersed in the sun's rays, will not be
- visible during the transit, but instead we should see the earth,
- which would be full. And what is more, if we were drawn round the
- moon, as at this moment, we should at least have the advantage of
- seeing the invisible part of her disc magnificently lit."
-
- "Well said, Nicholl," replied Michel Ardan. "What do you
- think, Barbicane?"
-
- "I think this," answered the grave president: "If ever we begin
- this journey again, we shall start at the same time and under
- the same conditions. Suppose we had attained our end, would it
- not have been better to have found continents in broad daylight
- than a country plunged in utter darkness? Would not our first
- installation have been made under better circumstances?
- Yes, evidently. As to the invisible side, we could have visited
- it in our exploring expeditions on the lunar globe. So that the
- time of the full moon was well chosen. But we ought to have
- arrived at the end; and in order to have so arrived, we ought
- to have suffered no deviation on the road."
-
- "I have nothing to say to that," answered Michel Ardan.
- "Here is, however, a good opportunity lost of observing the
- other side of the moon."
-
- But the projectile was now describing in the shadow that
- incalculable course which no sight-mark would allow them
- to ascertain. Had its direction been altered, either by the
- influence of the lunar attraction, or by the action of some
- unknown star? Barbicane could not say. But a change had taken
- place in the relative position of the vehicle; and Barbicane
- verified it about four in the morning.
-
- The change consisted in this, that the base of the projectile
- had turned toward the moon's surface, and was so held by a
- perpendicular passing through its axis. The attraction, that is
- to say the weight, had brought about this alteration. The heaviest
- part of the projectile inclined toward the invisible disc as if it
- would fall upon it.
-
- Was it falling? Were the travelers attaining that much desired end?
- No. And the observation of a sign-point, quite inexplicable in
- itself, showed Barbicane that his projectile was not nearing the
- moon, and that it had shifted by following an almost concentric curve.
-
- This point of mark was a luminous brightness, which Nicholl
- sighted suddenly, on the limit of the horizon formed by the
- black disc. This point could not be confounded with a star.
- It was a reddish incandescence which increased by degrees, a
- decided proof that the projectile was shifting toward it and
- not falling normally on the surface of the moon.
-
- "A volcano! it is a volcano in action!" cried Nicholl; "a
- disemboweling of the interior fires of the moon! That world is
- not quite extinguished."
-
- "Yes, an eruption," replied Barbicane, who was carefully
- studying the phenomenon through his night glass. "What should
- it be, if not a volcano?"
-
- "But, then," said Michel Ardan, "in order to maintain that
- combustion, there must be air. So the atmosphere does surround
- that part of the moon."
-
- "Perhaps so," replied Barbicane, "but not necessarily.
-
- The volcano, by the decomposition of certain substances, can
- provide its own oxygen, and thus throw flames into space. It seems
- to me that the deflagration, by the intense brilliancy of the
- substances in combustion, is produced in pure oxygen. We must
- not be in a hurry to proclaim the existence of a lunar atmosphere."
-
- The fiery mountain must have been situated about the 45@ south
- latitude on the invisible part of the disc; but, to Barbicane's
- great displeasure, the curve which the projectile was describing
- was taking it far from the point indicated by the eruption.
- Thus he could not determine its nature exactly. Half an hour
- after being sighted, this luminous point had disappeared behind
- the dark horizon; but the verification of this phenomenon was
- of considerable consequence in their selenographic studies.
- It proved that all heat had not yet disappeared from the bowels
- of this globe; and where heat exists, who can affirm that the
- vegetable kingdom, nay, even the animal kingdom itself, has not
- up to this time resisted all destructive influences? The existence
- of this volcano in eruption, unmistakably seen by these earthly
- savants, would doubtless give rise to many theories favorable
- to the grave question of the habitability of the moon.
-
- Barbicane allowed himself to be carried away by these reflections.
- He forgot himself in a deep reverie in which the mysterious
- destiny of the lunar world was uppermost. He was seeking to
- combine together the facts observed up to that time, when a new
- incident recalled him briskly to reality. This incident was more
- than a cosmical phenomenon; it was a threatened danger, the
- consequence of which might be disastrous in the extreme.
-
- Suddenly, in the midst of the ether, in the profound darkness, an
- enormous mass appeared. It was like a moon, but an incandescent
- moon whose brilliancy was all the more intolerable as it cut
- sharply on the frightful darkness of space. This mass, of a
- circular form, threw a light which filled the projectile.
- The forms of Barbicane, Nicholl, and Michel Ardan, bathed in
- its white sheets, assumed that livid spectral appearance which
- physicians produce with the fictitious light of alcohol
- impregnated with salt.
-
- "By Jove!" cried Michel Ardan, "we are hideous. What is that
- ill-conditioned moon?"
-
- "A meteor," replied Barbicane.
-
- "A meteor burning in space?"
-
- "Yes."
-
- This shooting globe suddenly appearing in shadow at a distance
- of at most 200 miles, ought, according to Barbicane, to have a
- diameter of 2,000 yards. It advanced at a speed of about one
- mile and a half per second. It cut the projectile's path and
- must reach it in some minutes. As it approached it grew to
- enormous proportions.
-
- Imagine, if possible, the situation of the travelers! It is
- impossible to describe it. In spite of their courage, their
- _sang-froid_, their carelessness of danger, they were mute,
- motionless with stiffened limbs, a prey to frightful terror.
- Their projectile, the course of which they could not alter, was
- rushing straight on this ignited mass, more intense than the
- open mouth of an oven. It seemed as though they were being
- precipitated toward an abyss of fire.
-
- Barbicane had seized the hands of his two companions, and all
- three looked through their half-open eyelids upon that asteroid
- heated to a white heat. If thought was not destroyed within
- them, if their brains still worked amid all this awe, they must
- have given themselves up for lost.
-
- Two minutes after the sudden appearance of the meteor (to them
- two centuries of anguish) the projectile seemed almost about to
- strike it, when the globe of fire burst like a bomb, but without
- making any noise in that void where sound, which is but the
- agitation of the layers of air, could not be generated.
-
- Nicholl uttered a cry, and he and his companions rushed to
- the scuttle. What a sight! What pen can describe it?
- What palette is rich enough in colors to reproduce so magnificent
- a spectacle?
-
- It was like the opening of a crater, like the scattering of an
- immense conflagration. Thousands of luminous fragments lit up
- and irradiated space with their fires. Every size, every color,
- was there intermingled. There were rays of yellow and pale
- yellow, red, green, gray-- a crown of fireworks of all colors.
- Of the enormous and much-dreaded globe there remained nothing
- but these fragments carried in all directions, now become
- asteroids in their turn, some flaming like a sword, some
- surrounded by a whitish cloud, and others leaving behind them
- trains of brilliant cosmical dust.
-
- These incandescent blocks crossed and struck each other,
- scattering still smaller fragments, some of which struck
- the projectile. Its left scuttle was even cracked by a
- violent shock. It seemed to be floating amid a hail of
- howitzer shells, the smallest of which might destroy
- it instantly.
-
- The light which saturated the ether was so wonderfully intense,
- that Michel, drawing Barbicane and Nicholl to his window,
- exclaimed, "The invisible moon, visible at last!"
-
- And through a luminous emanation, which lasted some seconds, the
- whole three caught a glimpse of that mysterious disc which the eye
- of man now saw for the first time. What could they distinguish
- at a distance which they could not estimate? Some lengthened
- bands along the disc, real clouds formed in the midst of a very
- confined atmosphere, from which emerged not only all the mountains,
- but also projections of less importance; its circles, its yawning
- craters, as capriciously placed as on the visible surface.
- Then immense spaces, no longer arid plains, but real seas, oceans,
- widely distributed, reflecting on their liquid surface all the
- dazzling magic of the fires of space; and, lastly, on the surface
- of the continents, large dark masses, looking like immense forests
- under the rapid illumination of a brilliance.
-
- Was it an illusion, a mistake, an optical illusion? Could they
- give a scientific assent to an observation so superficially obtained?
- Dared they pronounce upon the question of its habitability after
- so slight a glimpse of the invisible disc?
-
- But the lightnings in space subsided by degrees; its accidental
- brilliancy died away; the asteroids dispersed in different
- directions and were extinguished in the distance.
-
- The ether returned to its accustomed darkness; the stars, eclipsed
- for a moment, again twinkled in the firmament, and the disc, so
- hastily discerned, was again buried in impenetrable night.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVI
-
-
- THE SOUTHERN HEMISPHERE
-
-
- The projectile had just escaped a terrible danger, and a very
- unforseen one. Who would have thought of such an encounter
- with meteors? These erring bodies might create serious perils
- for the travelers. They were to them so many sandbanks upon
- that sea of ether which, less fortunate than sailors, they could
- not escape. But did these adventurers complain of space? No, not
- since nature had given them the splendid sight of a cosmical
- meteor bursting from expansion, since this inimitable firework,
- which no Ruggieri could imitate, had lit up for some seconds the
- invisible glory of the moon. In that flash, continents, seas,
- and forests had become visible to them. Did an atmosphere,
- then, bring to this unknown face its life-giving atoms?
- Questions still insoluble, and forever closed against
- human curiousity!
-
- It was then half-past three in the afternoon. The projectile
- was following its curvilinear direction round the moon. Had its
- course again been altered by the meteor? It was to be feared so.
- But the projectile must describe a curve unalterably determined
- by the laws of mechanical reasoning. Barbicane was inclined to
- believe that this curve would be rather a parabola than a hyperbola.
- But admitting the parabola, the projectile must quickly have
- passed through the cone of shadow projected into space opposite
- the sun. This cone, indeed, is very narrow, the angular diameter
- of the moon being so little when compared with the diameter of
- the orb of day; and up to this time the projectile had been
- floating in this deep shadow. Whatever had been its speed
- (and it could not have been insignificant), its period of
- occultation continued. That was evident, but perhaps that would
- not have been the case in a supposedly rigidly parabolical
- trajectory-- a new problem which tormented Barbicane's brain,
- imprisoned as he was in a circle of unknowns which he could
- not unravel.
-
- Neither of the travelers thought of taking an instant's repose.
- Each one watched for an unexpected fact, which might throw some
- new light on their uranographic studies. About five o'clock,
- Michel Ardan distributed, under the name of dinner, some pieces
- of bread and cold meat, which were quickly swallowed without
- either of them abandoning their scuttle, the glass of which was
- incessantly encrusted by the condensation of vapor.
-
- About forty-five minutes past five in the evening, Nicholl,
- armed with his glass, sighted toward the southern border of the
- moon, and in the direction followed by the projectile, some
- bright points cut upon the dark shield of the sky. They looked
- like a succession of sharp points lengthened into a tremulous line.
- They were very bright. Such appeared the terminal line of the
- moon when in one of her octants.
-
- They could not be mistaken. It was no longer a simple meteor.
- This luminous ridge had neither color nor motion. Nor was it a
- volcano in eruption. And Barbicane did not hesitate to
- pronounce upon it.
-
- "The sun!" he exclaimed.
-
- "What! the sun?" answered Nicholl and Michel Ardan.
-
- "Yes, my friends, it is the radiant orb itself lighting up the
- summit of the mountains situated on the southern borders of
- the moon. We are evidently nearing the south pole."
-
- "After having passed the north pole," replied Michel. "We have
- made the circuit of our satellite, then?"
-
- "Yes, my good Michel."
-
- "Then, no more hyperbolas, no more parabolas, no more open
- curves to fear?"
-
- "No, but a closed curve."
-
- "Which is called----"
-
- "An ellipse. Instead of losing itself in interplanetary space,
- it is probable that the projectile will describe an elliptical
- orbit around the moon."
-
- "Indeed!"
-
- "And that it will become _her_ satellite."
-
- "Moon of the moon!" cried Michel Ardan.
-
- "Only, I would have you observe, my worthy friend," replied
- Barbicane, "that we are none the less lost for that."
-
- "Yes, in another manner, and much more pleasantly," answered the
- careless Frenchman with his most amiable smile.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVII
-
-
- TYCHO
-
-
- At six in the evening the projectile passed the south pole at
- less than forty miles off, a distance equal to that already
- reached at the north pole. The elliptical curve was being
- rigidly carried out.
-
- At this moment the travelers once more entered the blessed rays
- of the sun. They saw once more those stars which move slowly
- from east to west. The radiant orb was saluted by a triple hurrah.
- With its light it also sent heat, which soon pierced the metal walls.
- The glass resumed its accustomed appearance. The layers of ice
- melted as if by enchantment; and immediately, for economy's sake,
- the gas was put out, the air apparatus alone consuming its
- usual quantity.
-
- "Ah!" said Nicholl, "these rays of heat are good. With what
- impatience must the Selenites wait the reappearance of the orb
- of day."
-
- "Yes," replied Michel Ardan, "imbibing as it were the brilliant
- ether, light and heat, all life is contained in them."
-
- At this moment the bottom of the projectile deviated somewhat
- from the lunar surface, in order to follow the slightly
- lengthened elliptical orbit. From this point, had the earth
- been at the full, Barbicane and his companions could have
- seen it, but immersed in the sun's irradiation she was
- quite invisible. Another spectacle attracted their attention,
- that of the southern part of the moon, brought by the glasses
- to within 450 yards. They did not again leave the scuttles,
- and noted every detail of this fantastical continent.
-
- Mounts Doerful and Leibnitz formed two separate groups very near
- the south pole. The first group extended from the pole to the
- eighty-fourth parallel, on the eastern part of the orb; the
- second occupied the eastern border, extending from the 65@ of
- latitude to the pole.
-
- On their capriciously formed ridge appeared dazzling sheets, as
- mentioned by Pere Secchi. With more certainty than the
- illustrious Roman astronomer, Barbicane was enabled to recognize
- their nature.
-
- "They are snow," he exclaimed.
-
- "Snow?" repeated Nicholl.
-
- "Yes, Nicholl, snow; the surface of which is deeply frozen.
- See how they reflect the luminous rays. Cooled lava would never
- give out such intense reflection. There must then be water,
- there must be air on the moon. As little as you please, but the
- fact can no longer be contested." No, it could not be. And if
- ever Barbicane should see the earth again, his notes will bear
- witness to this great fact in his selenographic observations.
-
- These mountains of Doerful and Leibnitz rose in the midst of
- plains of a medium extent, which were bounded by an indefinite
- succession of circles and annular ramparts. These two chains
- are the only ones met with in this region of circles.
- Comparatively but slightly marked, they throw up here and there
- some sharp points, the highest summit of which attains an
- altitude of 24,600 feet.
-
- But the projectile was high above all this landscape, and the
- projections disappeared in the intense brilliancy of the disc.
- And to the eyes of the travelers there reappeared that original
- aspect of the lunar landscapes, raw in tone, without gradation
- of colors, and without degrees of shadow, roughly black and
- white, from the want of diffusion of light.
-
- But the sight of this desolate world did not fail to captivate
- them by its very strangeness. They were moving over this region
- as if they had been borne on the breath of some storm, watching
- heights defile under their feet, piercing the cavities with their
- eyes, going down into the rifts, climbing the ramparts, sounding
- these mysterious holes, and leveling all cracks. But no trace
- of vegetation, no appearance of cities; nothing but stratification,
- beds of lava, overflowings polished like immense mirrors,
- reflecting the sun's rays with overpowering brilliancy.
- Nothing belonging to a _living_ world-- everything to a dead
- world, where avalanches, rolling from the summits of the mountains,
- would disperse noiselessly at the bottom of the abyss, retaining
- the motion, but wanting the sound. In any case it was the image
- of death, without its being possible even to say that life had ever
- existed there.
-
- Michel Ardan, however, thought he recognized a heap of ruins,
- to which he drew Barbicane's attention. It was about the 80th
- parallel, in 30@ longitude. This heap of stones, rather
- regularly placed, represented a vast fortress, overlooking a
- long rift, which in former days had served as a bed to the
- rivers of prehistorical times. Not far from that, rose to a
- height of 17,400 feet the annular mountain of Short, equal to
- the Asiatic Caucasus. Michel Ardan, with his accustomed ardor,
- maintained "the evidences" of his fortress. Beneath it he
- discerned the dismantled ramparts of a town; here the still
- intact arch of a portico, there two or three columns lying under
- their base; farther on, a succession of arches which must have
- supported the conduit of an aqueduct; in another part the sunken
- pillars of a gigantic bridge, run into the thickest parts of
- the rift. He distinguished all this, but with so much imagination
- in his glance, and through glasses so fantastical, that we must
- mistrust his observation. But who could affirm, who would dare
- to say, that the amiable fellow did not really see that which
- his two companions would not see?
-
- Moments were too precious to be sacrificed in idle discussion.
- The selenite city, whether imaginary or not, had already
- disappeared afar off. The distance of the projectile from the
- lunar disc was on the increase, and the details of the soil were
- being lost in a confused jumble. The reliefs, the circles,
- the craters, and the plains alone remained, and still showed
- their boundary lines distinctly. At this moment, to the left,
- lay extended one of the finest circles of lunar orography,
- one of the curiosities of this continent. It was Newton,
- which Barbicane recognized without trouble, by referring to
- the _Mappa Selenographica_.
-
- Newton is situated in exactly 77@ south latitude, and 16@
- east longitude. It forms an annular crater, the ramparts of
- which, rising to a height of 21,300 feet, seemed to be impassable.
-
- Barbicane made his companions observe that the height of this
- mountain above the surrounding plain was far from equaling the
- depth of its crater. This enormous hole was beyond all
- measurement, and formed a gloomy abyss, the bottom of which the
- sun's rays could never reach. There, according to Humboldt,
- reigns utter darkness, which the light of the sun and the earth
- cannot break. Mythologists could well have made it the mouth of hell.
-
- "Newton," said Barbicane, "is the most perfect type of these
- annular mountains, of which the earth possesses no sample.
- They prove that the moon's formation, by means of cooling, is
- due to violent causes; for while, under the pressure of internal
- fires the reliefs rise to considerable height, the depths withdraw
- far below the lunar level."
-
- "I do not dispute the fact," replied Michel Ardan.
-
- Some minutes after passing Newton, the projectile directly
- overlooked the annular mountains of Moret. It skirted at some
- distance the summits of Blancanus, and at about half-past seven
- in the evening reached the circle of Clavius.
-
- This circle, one of the most remarkable of the disc, is situated
- in 58@ south latitude, and 15@ east longitude. Its height is
- estimated at 22,950 feet. The travelers, at a distance of
- twenty-four miles (reduced to four by their glasses) could
- admire this vast crater in its entirety.
-
- "Terrestrial volcanoes," said Barbicane, "are but mole-hills
- compared with those of the moon. Measuring the old craters
- formed by the first eruptions of Vesuvius and Etna, we find them
- little more than three miles in breadth. In France the circle
- of Cantal measures six miles across; at Ceyland the circle of
- the island is forty miles, which is considered the largest on
- the globe. What are these diameters against that of Clavius,
- which we overlook at this moment?"
-
- "What is its breadth?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "It is 150 miles," replied Barbicane. "This circle is certainly
- the most important on the moon, but many others measure 150,
- 100, or 75 miles."
-
- "Ah! my friends," exclaimed Michel, "can you picture to
- yourselves what this now peaceful orb of night must have been
- when its craters, filled with thunderings, vomited at the same
- time smoke and tongues of flame. What a wonderful spectacle
- then, and now what decay! This moon is nothing more than a thin
- carcase of fireworks, whose squibs, rockets, serpents, and suns,
- after a superb brilliancy, have left but sadly broken cases.
- Who can say the cause, the reason, the motive force of
- these cataclysms?"
-
- Barbicane was not listening to Michel Ardan; he was
- contemplating these ramparts of Clavius, formed by large
- mountains spread over several miles. At the bottom of the
- immense cavity burrowed hundreds of small extinguished craters,
- riddling the soil like a colander, and overlooked by a peak
- 15,000 feet high.
-
- Around the plain appeared desolate. Nothing so arid as these
- reliefs, nothing so sad as these ruins of mountains, and (if we
- may so express ourselves) these fragments of peaks and mountains
- which strewed the soil. The satellite seemed to have burst at
- this spot.
-
- The projectile was still advancing, and this movement did
- not subside. Circles, craters, and uprooted mountains succeeded
- each other incessantly. No more plains; no more seas. A never
- ending Switzerland and Norway. And lastly, in the canter of
- this region of crevasses, the most splendid mountain on the
- lunar disc, the dazzling Tycho, in which posterity will ever
- preserve the name of the illustrious Danish astronomer.
-
- In observing the full moon in a cloudless sky no one has failed
- to remark this brilliant point of the southern hemisphere.
- Michel Ardan used every metaphor that his imagination could
- supply to designate it by. To him this Tycho was a focus of
- light, a center of irradiation, a crater vomiting rays. It was
- the tire of a brilliant wheel, an _asteria_ enclosing the disc
- with its silver tentacles, an enormous eye filled with flames,
- a glory carved for Pluto's head, a star launched by the
- Creator's hand, and crushed against the face of the moon!
-
- Tycho forms such a concentration of light that the inhabitants
- of the earth can see it without glasses, though at a distance
- of 240,000 miles! Imagine, then, its intensity to the eye of
- observers placed at a distance of only fifty miles! Seen through
- this pure ether, its brilliancy was so intolerable that Barbicane
- and his friends were obliged to blacken their glasses with the gas
- smoke before they could bear the splendor. Then silent, scarcely
- uttering an interjection of admiration, they gazed, they contemplated.
- All their feelings, all their impressions, were concentrated in that
- look, as under any violent emotion all life is concentrated at the heart.
-
- Tycho belongs to the system of radiating mountains, like
- Aristarchus and Copernicus; but it is of all the most complete
- and decided, showing unquestionably the frightful volcanic
- action to which the formation of the moon is due. Tycho is
- situated in 43@ south latitude, and 12@ east longitude. Its center
- is occupied by a crater fifty miles broad. It assumes a slightly
- elliptical form, and is surrounded by an enclosure of annular
- ramparts, which on the east and west overlook the outer plain from
- a height of 15,000 feet. It is a group of Mont Blancs, placed
- round one common center and crowned by radiating beams.
-
- What this incomparable mountain really is, with all the
- projections converging toward it, and the interior excrescences
- of its crater, photography itself could never represent.
- Indeed, it is during the full moon that Tycho is seen in all
- its splendor. Then all shadows disappear, the foreshortening
- of perspective disappears, and all proofs become white-- a
- disagreeable fact: for this strange region would have been
- marvelous if reproduced with photographic exactness. It is
- but a group of hollows, craters, circles, a network of crests;
- then, as far as the eye could see, a whole volcanic network
- cast upon this encrusted soil. One can then understand that
- the bubbles of this central eruption have kept their first form.
- Crystallized by cooling, they have stereotyped that aspect
- which the moon formerly presented when under the Plutonian forces.
-
- The distance which separated the travelers from the annular
- summits of Tycho was not so great but that they could catch
- the principal details. Even on the causeway forming the
- fortifications of Tycho, the mountains hanging on to the
- interior and exterior sloping flanks rose in stories like
- gigantic terraces. They appeared to be higher by 300 or 400
- feet to the west than to the east. No system of terrestrial
- encampment could equal these natural fortifications. A town
- built at the bottom of this circular cavity would have been
- utterly inaccessible.
-
- Inaccessible and wonderfully extended over this soil covered
- with picturesque projections! Indeed, nature had not left the
- bottom of this crater flat and empty. It possessed its own
- peculiar orography, a mountainous system, making it a world
- in itself. The travelers could distinguish clearly cones,
- central hills, remarkable positions of the soil, naturally
- placed to receive the _chefs-d'oeuvre_ of Selenite architecture.
- There was marked out the place for a temple, here the ground of a
- forum, on this spot the plan of a palace, in another the plateau
- for a citadel; the whole overlooked by a central mountain of
- 1,500 feet. A vast circle, in which ancient Rome could have
- been held in its entirety ten times over.
-
- "Ah!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, enthusiastic at the sight; "what
- a grand town might be constructed within that ring of mountains!
- A quiet city, a peaceful refuge, beyond all human misery. How calm
- and isolated those misanthropes, those haters of humanity might
- live there, and all who have a distaste for social life!"
-
- "All! It would be too small for them," replied Barbicane simply.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVIII
-
-
- GRAVE QUESTIONS
-
-
- But the projectile had passed the _enceinte_ of Tycho, and
- Barbicane and his two companions watched with scrupulous
- attention the brilliant rays which the celebrated mountain shed
- so curiously over the horizon.
-
- What was this radiant glory? What geological phenomenon had
- designed these ardent beams? This question occupied Barbicane's mind.
-
- Under his eyes ran in all directions luminous furrows, raised at
- the edges and concave in the center, some twelve miles, others
- thirty miles broad. These brilliant trains extended in some
- places to within 600 miles of Tycho, and seemed to cover,
- particularly toward the east, the northeast and the north, the
- half of the southern hemisphere. One of these jets extended as
- far as the circle of Neander, situated on the 40th meridian.
- Another, by a slight curve, furrowed the "Sea of Nectar," breaking
- against the chain of Pyrenees, after a circuit of 800 miles.
- Others, toward the west, covered the "Sea of Clouds" and
- the "Sea of Humors" with a luminous network. What was the
- origin of these sparkling rays, which shone on the plains as
- well as on the reliefs, at whatever height they might be?
- All started from a common center, the crater of Tycho.
- They sprang from him. Herschel attributed their brilliancy to
- currents of lava congealed by the cold; an opinion, however,
- which has not been generally adopted. Other astronomers have
- seen in these inexplicable rays a kind of moraines, rows of
- erratic blocks, which had been thrown up at the period of
- Tycho's formation.
-
- "And why not?" asked Nicholl of Barbicane, who was relating and
- rejecting these different opinions.
-
- "Because the regularity of these luminous lines, and the
- violence necessary to carry volcanic matter to such distances,
- is inexplicable."
-
- "Eh! by Jove!" replied Michel Ardan, "it seems easy enough to me
- to explain the origin of these rays."
-
- "Indeed?" said Barbicane.
-
- "Indeed," continued Michel. "It is enough to say that it is a
- vast star, similar to that produced by a ball or a stone thrown
- at a square of glass!"
-
- "Well!" replied Barbicane, smiling. "And what hand would be
- powerful enough to throw a ball to give such a shock as that?"
-
- "The hand is not necessary," answered Nicholl, not at all
- confounded; "and as to the stone, let us suppose it to be a comet."
-
- "Ah! those much-abused comets!" exclaimed Barbicane. "My brave
- Michel, your explanation is not bad; but your comet is useless.
- The shock which produced that rent must have some from the
- inside of the star. A violent contraction of the lunar crust,
- while cooling, might suffice to imprint this gigantic star."
-
- "A contraction! something like a lunar stomach-ache." said
- Michel Ardan.
-
- "Besides," added Barbicane, "this opinion is that of an English
- savant, Nasmyth, and it seems to me to sufficiently explain the
- radiation of these mountains."
-
- "That Nasmyth was no fool!" replied Michel.
-
- Long did the travelers, whom such a sight could never weary,
- admire the splendors of Tycho. Their projectile, saturated with
- luminous gleams in the double irradiation of sun and moon, must
- have appeared like an incandescent globe. They had passed
- suddenly from excessive cold to intense heat. Nature was thus
- preparing them to become Selenites. Become Selenites! That idea
- brought up once more the question of the habitability of the moon.
- After what they had seen, could the travelers solve it? Would they
- decide for or against it? Michel Ardan persuaded his two friends
- to form an opinion, and asked them directly if they thought that
- men and animals were represented in the lunar world.
-
- "I think that we can answer," said Barbicane; "but according to
- my idea the question ought not to be put in that form. I ask it
- to be put differently."
-
- "Put it your own way," replied Michel.
-
- "Here it is," continued Barbicane. "The problem is a double one,
- and requires a double solution. Is the moon _habitable_? Has the
- moon ever been _inhabitable_?"
-
- "Good!" replied Nicholl. "First let us see whether the moon
- is habitable."
-
- "To tell the truth, I know nothing about it," answered Michel.
-
- "And I answer in the negative," continued Barbicane. "In her
- actual state, with her surrounding atmosphere certainly very
- much reduced, her seas for the most part dried up, her
- insufficient supply of water restricted, vegetation, sudden
- alternations of cold and heat, her days and nights of 354
- hours-- the moon does not seem habitable to me, nor does she
- seem propitious to animal development, nor sufficient for the
- wants of existence as we understand it."
-
- "Agreed," replied Nicholl. "But is not the moon habitable for
- creatures differently organized from ourselves?"
-
- "That question is more difficult to answer, but I will try; and
- I ask Nicholl if _motion_ appears to him to be a necessary
- result of _life_, whatever be its organization?"
-
- "Without a doubt!" answered Nicholl.
-
- "Then, my worthy companion, I would answer that we have observed
- the lunar continent at a distance of 500 yards at most, and that
- nothing seemed to us to move on the moon's surface. The presence
- of any kind of life would have been betrayed by its attendant marks,
- such as divers buildings, and even by ruins. And what have
- we seen? Everywhere and always the geological works of nature,
- never the work of man. If, then, there exist representatives
- of the animal kingdom on the moon, they must have fled to those
- unfathomable cavities which the eye cannot reach; which I cannot
- admit, for they must have left traces of their passage on those
- plains which the atmosphere must cover, however slightly raised
- it may be. These traces are nowhere visible. There remains but
- one hypothesis, that of a living race to which motion, which is
- life, is foreign."
-
- "One might as well say, living creatures which do not live,"
- replied Michel.
-
- "Just so," said Barbicane, "which for us has no meaning."
-
- "Then we may form our opinion?" said Michel.
-
- "Yes," replied Nicholl.
-
- "Very well," continued Michel Ardan, "the Scientific Commission
- assembled in the projectile of the Gun Club, after having
- founded their argument on facts recently observed, decide
- unanimously upon the question of the habitability of the moon--
- `_No!_ the moon is not habitable.'"
-
- This decision was consigned by President Barbicane to his
- notebook, where the process of the sitting of the 6th of
- December may be seen.
-
- "Now," said Nicholl, "let us attack the second question, an
- indispensable complement of the first. I ask the honorable
- commission, if the moon is not habitable, has she ever been
- inhabited, Citizen Barbicane?"
-
- "My friends," replied Barbicane, "I did not undertake this
- journey in order to form an opinion on the past habitability of
- our satellite; but I will add that our personal observations
- only confirm me in this opinion. I believe, indeed I affirm,
- that the moon has been inhabited by a human race organized like
- our own; that she has produced animals anatomically formed like
- the terrestrial animals: but I add that these races, human and
- animal, have had their day, and are now forever extinct!"
-
- "Then," asked Michel, "the moon must be older than the earth?"
-
- "No!" said Barbicane decidedly, "but a world which has grown old
- quicker, and whose formation and deformation have been more rapid.
- Relatively, the organizing force of matter has been much more
- violent in the interior of the moon than in the interior of the
- terrestrial globe. The actual state of this cracked, twisted,
- and burst disc abundantly proves this. The moon and the earth
- were nothing but gaseous masses originally. These gases have
- passed into a liquid state under different influences, and the
- solid masses have been formed later. But most certainly our
- sphere was still gaseous or liquid, when the moon was solidified
- by cooling, and had become habitable."
-
- "I believe it," said Nicholl.
-
- "Then," continued Barbicane, "an atmosphere surrounded it, the
- waters contained within this gaseous envelope could not evaporate.
- Under the influence of air, water, light, solar heat, and central
- heat, vegetation took possession of the continents prepared to
- receive it, and certainly life showed itself about this period,
- for nature does not expend herself in vain; and a world so
- wonderfully formed for habitation must necessarily be inhabited."
-
- "But," said Nicholl, "many phenomena inherent in our satellite
- might cramp the expansion of the animal and vegetable kingdom.
- For example, its days and nights of 354 hours?"
-
- "At the terrestrial poles they last six months," said Michel.
-
- "An argument of little value, since the poles are not inhabited."
-
- "Let us observe, my friends," continued Barbicane, "that if in
- the actual state of the moon its long nights and long days
- created differences of temperature insupportable to
- organization, it was not so at the historical period of time.
- The atmosphere enveloped the disc with a fluid mantle; vapor
- deposited itself in the shape of clouds; this natural screen
- tempered the ardor of the solar rays, and retained the
- nocturnal radiation. Light, like heat, can diffuse itself in
- the air; hence an equality between the influences which no longer
- exists, now that atmosphere has almost entirely disappeared.
- And now I am going to astonish you."
-
- "Astonish us?" said Michel Ardan.
-
- "I firmly believe that at the period when the moon was inhabited,
- the nights and days did not last 354 hours!"
-
- "And why?" asked Nicholl quickly.
-
- "Because most probably then the rotary motion of the moon upon
- her axis was not equal to her revolution, an equality which
- presents each part of her disc during fifteen days to the action
- of the solar rays."
-
- "Granted," replied Nicholl, "but why should not these two
- motions have been equal, as they are really so?"
-
- "Because that equality has only been determined by
- terrestrial attraction. And who can say that this attraction
- was powerful enough to alter the motion of the moon at that
- period when the earth was still fluid?"
-
- "Just so," replied Nicholl; "and who can say that the moon has
- always been a satellite of the earth?"
-
- "And who can say," exclaimed Michel Ardan, "that the moon did
- not exist before the earth?"
-
- Their imaginations carried them away into an indefinite field
- of hypothesis. Barbicane sought to restrain them.
-
- "Those speculations are too high," said he; "problems
- utterly insoluble. Do not let us enter upon them. Let us only
- admit the insufficiency of the primordial attraction; and then
- by the inequality of the two motions of rotation and revolution,
- the days and nights could have succeeded each other on the moon
- as they succeed each other on the earth. Besides, even without
- these conditions, life was possible."
-
- "And so," asked Michel Ardan, "humanity has disappeared from
- the moon?"
-
- "Yes," replied Barbicane, "after having doubtless remained
- persistently for millions of centuries; by degrees the
- atmosphere becoming rarefied, the disc became uninhabitable, as
- the terrestrial globe will one day become by cooling."
-
- "By cooling?"
-
- "Certainly," replied Barbicane; "as the internal fires became
- extinguished, and the incandescent matter concentrated itself,
- the lunar crust cooled. By degrees the consequences of these
- phenomena showed themselves in the disappearance of organized
- beings, and by the disappearance of vegetation. Soon the
- atmosphere was rarefied, probably withdrawn by terrestrial
- attraction; then aerial departure of respirable air, and
- disappearance of water by means of evaporation. At this period
- the moon becoming uninhabitable, was no longer inhabited.
- It was a dead world, such as we see it to-day."
-
- "And you say that the same fate is in store for the earth?"
-
- "Most probably."
-
- "But when?"
-
- "When the cooling of its crust shall have made it uninhabitable."
-
- "And have they calculated the time which our unfortunate sphere
- will take to cool?"
-
- "Certainly."
-
- "And you know these calculations?"
-
- "Perfectly."
-
- "But speak, then, my clumsy savant," exclaimed Michel Ardan,
- "for you make me boil with impatience!"
-
- "Very well, my good Michel," replied Barbicane quietly; "we know
- what diminution of temperature the earth undergoes in the lapse
- of a century. And according to certain calculations, this mean
- temperature will after a period of 400,000 years, be brought
- down to zero!"
-
- "Four hundred thousand years!" exclaimed Michel. "Ah! I
- breathe again. Really I was frightened to hear you; I imagined
- that we had not more than 50,000 years to live."
-
- Barbicane and Nicholl could not help laughing at their
- companion's uneasiness. Then Nicholl, who wished to end the
- discussion, put the second question, which had just been
- considered again.
-
- "Has the moon been inhabited?" he asked.
-
- The answer was unanimously in the affirmative. But during this
- discussion, fruitful in somewhat hazardous theories, the
- projectile was rapidly leaving the moon: the lineaments faded
- away from the travelers' eyes, mountains were confused in the
- distance; and of all the wonderful, strange, and fantastical
- form of the earth's satellite, there soon remained nothing but
- the imperishable remembrance.
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIX
-
-
- A STRUGGLE AGAINST THE IMPOSSIBLE
-
-
- For a long time Barbicane and his companions looked silently and
- sadly upon that world which they had only seen from a distance,
- as Moses saw the land of Canaan, and which they were leaving
- without a possibility of ever returning to it. The projectile's
- position with regard to the moon had altered, and the base was
- now turned to the earth.
-
- This change, which Barbicane verified, did not fail to surprise them.
- If the projectile was to gravitate round the satellite in an
- elliptical orbit, why was not its heaviest part turned toward it,
- as the moon turns hers to the earth? That was a difficult point.
-
- In watching the course of the projectile they could see that on
- leaving the moon it followed a course analogous to that traced
- in approaching her. It was describing a very long ellipse,
- which would most likely extend to the point of equal attraction,
- where the influences of the earth and its satellite are neutralized.
-
- Such was the conclusion which Barbicane very justly drew from
- facts already observed, a conviction which his two friends
- shared with him.
-
- "And when arrived at this dead point, what will become of us?"
- asked Michel Ardan.
-
- "We don't know," replied Barbicane.
-
- "But one can draw some hypotheses, I suppose?"
-
- "Two," answered Barbicane; "either the projectile's speed will
- be insufficient, and it will remain forever immovable on this
- line of double attraction----"
-
- "I prefer the other hypothesis, whatever it may be," interrupted Michel.
-
- "Or," continued Barbicane, "its speed will be sufficient, and it
- will continue its elliptical course, to gravitate forever around
- the orb of night."
-
- "A revolution not at all consoling," said Michel, "to pass to
- the state of humble servants to a moon whom we are accustomed to
- look upon as our own handmaid. So that is the fate in store for us?"
-
- Neither Barbicane nor Nicholl answered.
-
- "You do not answer," continued Michel impatiently.
-
- "There is nothing to answer," said Nicholl.
-
- "Is there nothing to try?"
-
- "No," answered Barbicane. "Do you pretend to fight against
- the impossible?"
-
- "Why not? Do one Frenchman and two Americans shrink from such
- a word?"
-
- "But what would you do?"
-
- "Subdue this motion which is bearing us away."
-
- "Subdue it?"
-
- "Yes," continued Michel, getting animated, "or else alter it,
- and employ it to the accomplishment of our own ends."
-
- "And how?"
-
- "That is your affair. If artillerymen are not masters of their
- projectile they are not artillerymen. If the projectile is to
- command the gunner, we had better ram the gunner into the gun.
- My faith! fine savants! who do not know what is to become of us
- after inducing me----"
-
- "Inducing you!" cried Barbicane and Nicholl. "Inducing you!
- What do you mean by that?"
-
- "No recrimination," said Michel. "I do not complain, the trip
- has pleased me, and the projectile agrees with me; but let us do
- all that is humanly possible to do the fall somewhere, even if
- only on the moon."
-
- "We ask no better, my worthy Michel," replied Barbicane, "but
- means fail us."
-
- "We cannot alter the motion of the projectile?"
-
- "No."
-
- "Nor diminish its speed?"
-
- "No."
-
- "Not even by lightening it, as they lighten an overloaded vessel?"
-
- "What would you throw out?" said Nicholl. "We have no ballast
- on board; and indeed it seems to me that if lightened it would
- go much quicker."
-
- "Slower."
-
- "Quicker."
-
- "Neither slower nor quicker," said Barbicane, wishing to make
- his two friends agree; "for we float is space, and must no
- longer consider specific weight."
-
- "Very well," cried Michel Ardan in a decided voice; "then their
- remains but one thing to do."
-
- "What is it?" asked Nicholl.
-
- "Breakfast," answered the cool, audacious Frenchman, who always
- brought up this solution at the most difficult juncture.
-
- In any case, if this operation had no influence on the
- projectile's course, it could at least be tried without
- inconvenience, and even with success from a stomachic point
- of view. Certainly Michel had none but good ideas.
-
- They breakfasted then at two in the morning; the hour mattered little.
- Michel served his usual repast, crowned by a glorious bottle drawn
- from his private cellar. If ideas did not crowd on their brains,
- we must despair of the Chambertin of 1853. The repast finished,
- observation began again. Around the projectile, at an invariable
- distance, were the objects which had been thrown out. Evidently, in
- its translatory motion round the moon, it had not passed through
- any atmosphere, for the specific weight of these different objects
- would have checked their relative speed.
-
- On the side of the terrestrial sphere nothing was to be seen.
- The earth was but a day old, having been new the night before at
- twelve; and two days must elapse before its crescent, freed from
- the solar rays, would serve as a clock to the Selenites, as in
- its rotary movement each of its points after twenty-four hours
- repasses the same lunar meridian.
-
- On the moon's side the sight was different; the orb shone in all
- her splendor amid innumerable constellations, whose purity could
- not be troubled by her rays. On the disc, the plains were
- already returning to the dark tint which is seen from the earth.
- The other part of the nimbus remained brilliant, and in the midst
- of this general brilliancy Tycho shone prominently like a sun.
-
- Barbicane had no means of estimating the projectile's speed, but
- reasoning showed that it must uniformly decrease, according to
- the laws of mechanical reasoning. Having admitted that the
- projectile was describing an orbit around the moon, this orbit
- must necessarily be elliptical; science proves that it must be so.
- No motive body circulating round an attracting body fails in
- this law. Every orbit described in space is elliptical. And why
- should the projectile of the Gun Club escape this natural arrangement?
- In elliptical orbits, the attracting body always occupies one of
- the foci; so that at one moment the satellite is nearer, and at
- another farther from the orb around which it gravitates. When the
- earth is nearest the sun she is in her perihelion; and in her
- aphelion at the farthest point. Speaking of the moon, she is
- nearest to the earth in her perigee, and farthest from it in
- her apogee. To use analogous expressions, with which the
- astronomers' language is enriched, if the projectile remains
- as a satellite of the moon, we must say that it is in its
- "aposelene" at its farthest point, and in its "periselene" at
- its nearest. In the latter case, the projectile would attain
- its maximum of speed; and in the former its minimum. It was
- evidently moving toward its aposelenitical point; and Barbicane
- had reason to think that its speed would decrease up to this
- point, and then increase by degrees as it neared the moon.
- This speed would even become _nil_, if this point joined that of
- equal attraction. Barbicane studied the consequences of these
- different situations, and thinking what inference he could draw
- from them, when he was roughly disturbed by a cry from Michel Ardan.
-
- "By Jove!" he exclaimed, "I must admit we are down-right simpletons!"
-
- "I do not say we are not," replied Barbicane; "but why?"
-
- "Because we have a very simple means of checking this speed
- which is bearing us from the moon, and we do not use it!"
-
- "And what is the means?"
-
- "To use the recoil contained in our rockets."
-
- "Done!" said Nicholl.
-
- "We have not used this force yet," said Barbicane, "it is true,
- but we will do so."
-
- "When?" asked Michel.
-
- "When the time comes. Observe, my friends, that in the position
- occupied by the projectile, an oblique position with regard to
- the lunar disc, our rockets, in slightly altering its direction,
- might turn it from the moon instead of drawing it nearer?"
-
- "Just so," replied Michel.
-
- "Let us wait, then. By some inexplicable influence, the
- projectile is turning its base toward the earth. It is probable
- that at the point of equal attraction, its conical cap will be
- directed rigidly toward the moon; at that moment we may hope
- that its speed will be _nil_; then will be the moment to act,
- and with the influence of our rockets we may perhaps
- provoke a fall directly on the surface of the lunar disc."
-
- "Bravo!" said Michel. "What we did not do, what we could not do
- on our first passage at the dead point, because the projectile
- was then endowed with too great a speed."
-
- "Very well reasoned," said Nicholl.
-
- "Let us wait patiently," continued Barbicane. "Putting every
- chance on our side, and after having so much despaired, I may
- say I think we shall gain our end."
-
- This conclusion was a signal for Michel Ardan's hips and hurrahs.
- And none of the audacious boobies remembered the question that
- they themselves had solved in the negative. No! the moon is not
- inhabited; no! the moon is probably not habitable. And yet they
- were going to try everything to reach her.
-
- One single question remained to be solved. At what precise
- moment the projectile would reach the point of equal attraction,
- on which the travelers must play their last card. In order to
- calculate this to within a few seconds, Barbicane had only to
- refer to his notes, and to reckon the different heights taken on
- the lunar parallels. Thus the time necessary to travel over the
- distance between the dead point and the south pole would be equal
- to the distance separating the north pole from the dead point.
- The hours representing the time traveled over were carefully
- noted, and the calculation was easy. Barbicane found that this
- point would be reached at one in the morning on the night of the
- 7th-8th of December. So that, if nothing interfered with its
- course, it would reach the given point in twenty-two hours.
-
- The rockets had primarily been placed to check the fall of the
- projectile upon the moon, and now they were going to employ them
- for a directly contrary purpose. In any case they were ready,
- and they had only to wait for the moment to set fire to them.
-
- "Since there is nothing else to be done," said Nicholl, "I make
- a proposition."
-
- "What is it?" asked Barbicane.
-
- "I propose to go to sleep."
-
- "What a motion!" exclaimed Michel Ardan.
-
- "It is forty hours since we closed our eyes," said Nicholl.
- "Some hours of sleep will restore our strength."
-
- "Never," interrupted Michel.
-
- "Well," continued Nicholl, "every one to his taste; I shall go
- to sleep." And stretching himself on the divan, he soon snored
- like a forty-eight pounder.
-
- "That Nicholl has a good deal of sense," said Barbicane;
- "presently I shall follow his example." Some moments after his
- continued bass supported the captain's baritone.
-
- "Certainly," said Michel Ardan, finding himself alone, "these
- practical people have sometimes most opportune ideas."
-
- And with his long legs stretched out, and his great arms folded
- under his head, Michel slept in his turn.
-
- But this sleep could be neither peaceful nor lasting, the minds
- of these three men were too much occupied, and some hours after,
- about seven in the morning, all three were on foot at the same instant.
-
- The projectile was still leaving the moon, and turning its
- conical part more and more toward her.
-
- An explicable phenomenon, but one which happily served
- Barbicane's ends.
-
- Seventeen hours more, and the moment for action would have arrived.
-
- The day seemed long. However bold the travelers might be, they
- were greatly impressed by the approach of that moment which
- would decide all-- either precipitate their fall on to the moon,
- or forever chain them in an immutable orbit. They counted the
- hours as they passed too slow for their wish; Barbicane and
- Nicholl were obstinately plunged in their calculations, Michel
- going and coming between the narrow walls, and watching that
- impassive moon with a longing eye.
-
- At times recollections of the earth crossed their minds. They saw
- once more their friends of the Gun Club, and the dearest of all,
- J. T. Maston. At that moment, the honorable secretary must be
- filling his post on the Rocky Mountains. If he could see the
- projectile through the glass of his gigantic telescope, what
- would he think? After seeing it disappear behind the moon's
- south pole, he would see them reappear by the north pole!
- They must therefore be a satellite of a satellite! Had J. T.
- Maston given this unexpected news to the world? Was this the
- _denouement_ of this great enterprise?
-
- But the day passed without incident. The terrestrial
- midnight arrived. The 8th of December was beginning.
- One hour more, and the point of equal attraction would
- be reached. What speed would then animate the projectile?
- They could not estimate it. But no error could vitiate
- Barbicane's calculations. At one in the morning this speed
- ought to be and would be _nil_.
-
- Besides, another phenomenon would mark the projectile's
- stopping-point on the neutral line. At that spot the two
- attractions, lunar and terrestrial, would be annulled.
- Objects would "weigh" no more. This singular fact, which had
- surprised Barbicane and his companions so much in going, would
- be repeated on their return under the very same conditions.
- At this precise moment they must act.
-
- Already the projectile's conical top was sensibly turned toward
- the lunar disc, presented in such a way as to utilize the whole
- of the recoil produced by the pressure of the rocket apparatus.
- The chances were in favor of the travelers. If its speed was
- utterly annulled on this dead point, a decided movement toward
- the moon would suffice, however slight, to determine its fall.
-
- "Five minutes to one," said Nicholl.
-
- "All is ready," replied Michel Ardan, directing a lighted match
- to the flame of the gas.
-
- "Wait!" said Barbicane, holding his chronometer in his hand.
-
- At that moment weight had no effect. The travelers felt in
- themselves the entire disappearance of it. They were very near
- the neutral point, if they did not touch it.
-
- "One o'clock," said Barbicane.
-
- Michel Ardan applied the lighted match to a train in
- communication with the rockets. No detonation was heard in
- the inside, for there was no air. But, through the scuttles,
- Barbicane saw a prolonged smoke, the flames of which were
- immediately extinguished.
-
- The projectile sustained a certain shock, which was sensibly
- felt in the interior.
-
- The three friends looked and listened without speaking, and
- scarcely breathing. One might have heard the beating of their
- hearts amid this perfect silence.
-
- "Are we falling?" asked Michel Ardan, at length.
-
- "No," said Nicholl, "since the bottom of the projectile is not
- turning to the lunar disc!"
-
- At this moment, Barbicane, quitting his scuttle, turned to his
- two companions. He was frightfully pale, his forehead wrinkled,
- and his lips contracted.
-
- "We are falling!" said he.
-
- "Ah!" cried Michel Ardan, "on to the moon?"
-
- "On to the earth!"
-
- "The devil!" exclaimed Michel Ardan, adding philosophically,
- "well, when we came into this projectile we were very doubtful
- as to the ease with which we should get out of it!"
-
- And now this fearful fall had begun. The speed retained had
- borne the projectile beyond the dead point. The explosion of
- the rockets could not divert its course. This speed in going
- had carried it over the neutral line, and in returning had done
- the same thing. The laws of physics condemned it _to pass
- through every point which it had already gone through_. It was
- a terrible fall, from a height of 160,000 miles, and no springs
- to break it. According to the laws of gunnery, the projectile
- must strike the earth with a speed equal to that with which it
- left the mouth of the Columbiad, a speed of 16,000 yards in the
- last second.
-
- But to give some figures of comparison, it has been reckoned
- that an object thrown from the top of the towers of Notre Dame,
- the height of which is only 200 feet, will arrive on the
- pavement at a speed of 240 miles per hour. Here the projectile
- must strike the earth with a speed of 115,200 miles per hour.
-
- "We are lost!" said Michel coolly.
-
- "Very well! if we die," answered Barbicane, with a sort of
- religious enthusiasm, "the results of our travels will be
- magnificently spread. It is His own secret that God will
- tell us! In the other life the soul will want to know nothing,
- either of machines or engines! It will be identified with
- eternal wisdom!"
-
- "In fact," interrupted Michel Ardan, "the whole of the other
- world may well console us for the loss of that inferior orb
- called the moon!"
-
- Barbicane crossed his arms on his breast, with a motion of
- sublime resignation, saying at the same time:
-
- "The will of heaven be done!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XX
-
-
- THE SOUNDINGS OF THE SUSQUEHANNA
-
-
- Well, lieutenant, and our soundings?"
-
- "I think, sir, that the operation is nearing its completion,"
- replied Lieutenant Bronsfield. "But who would have thought of
- finding such a depth so near in shore, and only 200 miles from
- the American coast?"
-
- "Certainly, Bronsfield, there is a great depression," said
- Captain Blomsberry. "In this spot there is a submarine valley
- worn by Humboldt's current, which skirts the coast of America as
- far as the Straits of Magellan."
-
- "These great depths," continued the lieutenant, "are not
- favorable for laying telegraphic cables. A level bottom, like
- that supporting the American cable between Valentia and
- Newfoundland, is much better."
-
- "I agree with you, Bronsfield. With your permission,
- lieutenant, where are we now?"
-
- "Sir, at this moment we have 3,508 fathoms of line out, and the
- ball which draws the sounding lead has not yet touched the
- bottom; for if so, it would have come up of itself."
-
- "Brook's apparatus is very ingenious," said Captain Blomsberry;
- "it gives us very exact soundings."
-
- "Touch!" cried at this moment one of the men at the forewheel,
- who was superintending the operation.
-
- The captain and the lieutenant mounted the quarterdeck.
-
- "What depth have we?" asked the captain.
-
- "Three thousand six hundred and twenty-seven fathoms," replied
- the lieutenant, entering it in his notebook.
-
- "Well, Bronsfield," said the captain, "I will take down
- the result. Now haul in the sounding line. It will be the
- work of some hours. In that time the engineer can light the
- furnaces, and we shall be ready to start as soon as you
- have finished. It is ten o'clock, and with your permission,
- lieutenant, I will turn in."
-
- "Do so, sir; do so!" replied the lieutenant obligingly.
-
- The captain of the Susquehanna, as brave a man as need be, and
- the humble servant of his officers, returned to his cabin, took
- a brandy-grog, which earned for the steward no end of praise,
- and turned in, not without having complimented his servant upon
- his making beds, and slept a peaceful sleep.
-
- It was then ten at night. The eleventh day of the month of
- December was drawing to a close in a magnificent night.
-
- The Susquehanna, a corvette of 500 horse-power, of the United
- States navy, was occupied in taking soundings in the Pacific
- Ocean about 200 miles off the American coast, following that
- long peninsula which stretches down the coast of Mexico.
-
- The wind had dropped by degrees. There was no disturbance in
- the air. The pennant hung motionless from the maintop-gallant-
- mast truck.
-
- Captain Jonathan Blomsberry (cousin-german of Colonel
- Blomsberry, one of the most ardent supporters of the Gun Club,
- who had married an aunt of the captain and daughter of an
- honorable Kentucky merchant)-- Captain Blomsberry could not have
- wished for finer weather in which to bring to a close his
- delicate operations of sounding. His corvette had not even felt
- the great tempest, which by sweeping away the groups of clouds
- on the Rocky Mountains, had allowed them to observe the course
- of the famous projectile.
-
- Everything went well, and with all the fervor of a Presbyterian,
- he did not forget to thank heaven for it. The series of
- soundings taken by the Susquehanna, had for its aim the finding
- of a favorable spot for the laying of a submarine cable to
- connect the Hawaiian Islands with the coast of America.
-
- It was a great undertaking, due to the instigation of a
- powerful company. Its managing director, the intelligent Cyrus
- Field, purposed even covering all the islands of Oceanica with
- a vast electrical network, an immense enterprise, and one worthy
- of American genius.
-
- To the corvette Susquehanna had been confided the first
- operations of sounding. It was on the night of the 11th-12th of
- December, she was in exactly 27@ 7' north latitude, and 41@ 37'
- west longitude, on the meridian of Washington.
-
- The moon, then in her last quarter, was beginning to rise above
- the horizon.
-
- After the departure of Captain Blomsberry, the lieutenant and
- some officers were standing together on the poop. On the
- appearance of the moon, their thoughts turned to that orb which
- the eyes of a whole hemisphere were contemplating. The best
- naval glasses could not have discovered the projectile wandering
- around its hemisphere, and yet all were pointed toward that
- brilliant disc which millions of eyes were looking at at the
- same moment.
-
- "They have been gone ten days," said Lieutenant Bronsfield
- at last. "What has become of them?"
-
- "They have arrived, lieutenant," exclaimed a young midshipman,
- "and they are doing what all travelers do when they arrive in a
- new country, taking a walk!"
-
- "Oh! I am sure of that, if you tell me so, my young friend,"
- said Lieutenant Bronsfield, smiling.
-
- "But," continued another officer, "their arrival cannot
- be doubted. The projectile was to reach the moon when full
- on the 5th at midnight. We are now at the 11th of December, which
- makes six days. And in six times twenty-four hours, without
- darkness, one would have time to settle comfortably. I fancy I
- see my brave countrymen encamped at the bottom of some valley,
- on the borders of a Selenite stream, near a projectile half-buried
- by its fall amid volcanic rubbish, Captain Nicholl beginning his
- leveling operations, President Barbicane writing out his notes,
- and Michel Ardan embalming the lunar solitudes with the perfume
- of his----"
-
- "Yes! it must be so, it is so!" exclaimed the young midshipman,
- worked up to a pitch of enthusiasm by this ideal description of
- his superior officer.
-
- "I should like to believe it," replied the lieutenant, who was
- quite unmoved. "Unfortunately direct news from the lunar world
- is still wanting."
-
- "Beg pardon, lieutenant," said the midshipman, "but cannot
- President Barbicane write?"
-
- A burst of laughter greeted this answer.
-
- "No letters!" continued the young man quickly. "The postal
- administration has something to see to there."
-
- "Might it not be the telegraphic service that is at fault?"
- asked one of the officers ironically.
-
- "Not necessarily," replied the midshipman, not at all confused.
- "But it is very easy to set up a graphic communication with
- the earth."
-
- "And how?"
-
- "By means of the telescope at Long's Peak. You know it brings
- the moon to within four miles of the Rocky Mountains, and that
- it shows objects on its surface of only nine feet in diameter.
- Very well; let our industrious friends construct a giant
- alphabet; let them write words three fathoms long, and sentences
- three miles long, and then they can send us news of themselves."
-
- The young midshipman, who had a certain amount of imagination,
- was loudly applauded; Lieutenant Bronsfield allowing that the
- idea was possible, but observing that if by these means they
- could receive news from the lunar world they could not send any
- from the terrestrial, unless the Selenites had instruments fit
- for taking distant observations at their disposal.
-
- "Evidently," said one of the officers; "but what has become of
- the travelers? what they have done, what they have seen, that
- above all must interest us. Besides, if the experiment has
- succeeded (which I do not doubt), they will try it again.
- The Columbiad is still sunk in the soil of Florida. It is now
- only a question of powder and shot; and every time the moon is
- at her zenith a cargo of visitors may be sent to her."
-
- "It is clear," replied Lieutenant Bronsfield, "that J. T. Maston
- will one day join his friends."
-
- "If he will have me," cried the midshipman, "I am ready!"
-
- "Oh! volunteers will not be wanting," answered Bronsfield; "and
- if it were allowed, half of the earth's inhabitants would
- emigrate to the moon!"
-
- This conversation between the officers of the Susquehanna was
- kept up until nearly one in the morning. We cannot say what
- blundering systems were broached, what inconsistent theories
- advanced by these bold spirits. Since Barbicane's attempt,
- nothing seemed impossible to the Americans. They had already
- designed an expedition, not only of savants, but of a whole
- colony toward the Selenite borders, and a complete army,
- consisting of infantry, artillery, and cavalry, to conquer the
- lunar world.
-
- At one in the morning, the hauling in of the sounding-line was
- not yet completed; 1,670 fathoms were still out, which would
- entail some hours' work. According to the commander's orders,
- the fires had been lighted, and steam was being got up.
- The Susquehanna could have started that very instant.
-
- At that moment (it was seventeen minutes past one in the
- morning) Lieutenant Bronsfield was preparing to leave the watch
- and return to his cabin, when his attention was attracted by a
- distant hissing noise. His comrades and himself first thought
- that this hissing was caused by the letting off of steam; but
- lifting their heads, they found that the noise was produced in
- the highest regions of the air. They had not time to question
- each other before the hissing became frightfully intense, and
- suddenly there appeared to their dazzled eyes an enormous
- meteor, ignited by the rapidity of its course and its friction
- through the atmospheric strata.
-
- This fiery mass grew larger to their eyes, and fell, with
- the noise of thunder, upon the bowsprit, which it smashed close
- to the stem, and buried itself in the waves with a deafening roar!
-
- A few feet nearer, and the Susquehanna would have foundered with
- all on board!
-
- At this instant Captain Blomsberry appeared, half-dressed, and
- rushing on to the forecastle-deck, whither all the officers had
- hurried, exclaimed, "With your permission, gentlemen, what
- has happened?"
-
- And the midshipman, making himself as it were the echo of the
- body, cried, "Commander, it is `they' come back again!"
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXI
-
-
- J. T. MASTON RECALLED
-
-
- "It is `they' come back again!" the young midshipman had said,
- and every one had understood him. No one doubted but that the
- meteor was the projectile of the Gun Club. As to the travelers
- which it enclosed, opinions were divided regarding their fate.
-
- "They are dead!" said one.
-
- "They are alive!" said another; "the crater is deep, and the
- shock was deadened."
-
- "But they must have wanted air," continued a third speaker;
- "they must have died of suffocation."
-
- "Burned!" replied a fourth; "the projectile was nothing but an
- incandescent mass as it crossed the atmosphere."
-
- "What does it matter!" they exclaimed unanimously; "living or
- dead, we must pull them out!"
-
- But Captain Blomsberry had assembled his officers, and "with
- their permission," was holding a council. They must decide upon
- something to be done immediately. The more hasty ones were for
- fishing up the projectile. A difficult operation, though not an
- impossible one. But the corvette had no proper machinery, which
- must be both fixed and powerful; so it was resolved that they
- should put in at the nearest port, and give information to the
- Gun Club of the projectile's fall.
-
- This determination was unanimous. The choice of the port had
- to be discussed. The neighboring coast had no anchorage on
- 27@ latitude. Higher up, above the peninsula of Monterey, stands
- the important town from which it takes its name; but, seated on
- the borders of a perfect desert, it was not connected with the
- interior by a network of telegraphic wires, and electricity
- alone could spread these important news fast enough.
-
- Some degrees above opened the bay of San Francisco. Through the
- capital of the gold country communication would be easy with the
- heart of the Union. And in less than two days the Susquehanna,
- by putting on high pressure, could arrive in that port. She must
- therefore start at once.
-
- The fires were made up; they could set off immediately.
- Two thousand fathoms of line were still out, which Captain
- Blomsberry, not wishing to lose precious time in hauling in,
- resolved to cut.
-
- "we will fasten the end to a buoy," said he, "and that buoy will
- show us the exact spot where the projectile fell."
-
- "Besides," replied Lieutenant Bronsfield, "we have our situation
- exact-- 27@ 7' north latitude and 41@ 37' west longitude."
-
- "Well, Mr. Bronsfield," replied the captain, "now, with your
- permission, we will have the line cut."
-
- A strong buoy, strengthened by a couple of spars, was thrown
- into the ocean. The end of the rope was carefully lashed to it;
- and, left solely to the rise and fall of the billows, the buoy
- would not sensibly deviate from the spot.
-
- At this moment the engineer sent to inform the captain that
- steam was up and they could start, for which agreeable
- communication the captain thanked him. The course was then
- given north-northeast, and the corvette, wearing, steered at
- full steam direct for San Francisco. It was three in the morning.
-
- Four hundred and fifty miles to cross; it was nothing for a good
- vessel like the Susquehanna. In thirty-six hours she had covered
- that distance; and on the 14th of December, at twenty-seven
- minutes past one at night, she entered the bay of San Francisco.
-
- At the sight of a ship of the national navy arriving at full speed,
- with her bowsprit broken, public curiosity was greatly roused.
- A dense crowd soon assembled on the quay, waiting for them
- to disembark.
-
- After casting anchor, Captain Blomsberry and Lieutenant
- Bronsfield entered an eight-pared cutter, which soon brought
- them to land.
-
- They jumped on to the quay.
-
- "The telegraph?" they asked, without answering one of the
- thousand questions addressed to them.
-
- The officer of the port conducted them to the telegraph office
- through a concourse of spectators. Blomsberry and Bronsfield
- entered, while the crowd crushed each other at the door.
-
- Some minutes later a fourfold telegram was sent out--the first
- to the Naval Secretary at Washington; the second to the
- vice-president of the Gun Club, Baltimore; the third to the Hon.
- J. T. Maston, Long's Peak, Rocky Mountains; and the fourth to
- the sub-director of the Cambridge Observatory, Massachusetts.
-
- It was worded as follows:
-
-
- In 20@ 7' north latitude, and 41@ 37' west longitude, on the
- 12th of December, at seventeen minutes past one in the morning,
- the projectile of the Columbiad fell into the Pacific.
- Send instructions.-- BLOMSBERRY, Commander Susquehanna.
-
-
- Five minutes afterward the whole town of San Francisco learned
- the news. Before six in the evening the different States of the
- Union had heard the great catastrophe; and after midnight, by
- the cable, the whole of Europe knew the result of the great
- American experiment. We will not attempt to picture the effect
- produced on the entire world by that unexpected denouement.
-
- On receipt of the telegram the Naval Secretary telegraphed to
- the Susquehanna to wait in the bay of San Francisco without
- extinguishing her fires. Day and night she must be ready
- to put to sea.
-
- The Cambridge observatory called a special meeting; and, with
- that composure which distinguishes learned bodies in general,
- peacefully discussed the scientific bearings of the question.
- At the Gun Club there was an explosion. All the gunners
- were assembled. Vice-President the Hon. Wilcome was in the
- act of reading the premature dispatch, in which J. T. Maston
- and Belfast announced that the projectile had just been seen in
- the gigantic reflector of Long's Peak, and also that it was held
- by lunar attraction, and was playing the part of under satellite
- to the lunar world.
-
- We know the truth on that point.
-
- But on the arrival of Blomsberry's dispatch, so decidely
- contradicting J. T. Maston's telegram, two parties were formed
- in the bosom of the Gun Club. On one side were those who
- admitted the fall of the projectile, and consequently the return
- of the travelers; on the other, those who believed in the
- observations of Long's Peak, concluded that the commander of the
- Susquehanna had made a mistake. To the latter the pretended
- projectile was nothing but a meteor! nothing but a meteor, a
- shooting globe, which in its fall had smashed the bows of
- the corvette. It was difficult to answer this argument, for
- the speed with which it was animated must have made observation
- very difficult. The commander of the Susquehanna and her
- officers might have made a mistake in all good faith; one argument
- however, was in their favor, namely, that if the projectile had
- fallen on the earth, its place of meeting with the terrestrial
- globe could only take place on this 27@ north latitude, and
- (taking into consideration the time that had elapsed, and the
- rotary motion of the earth) between the 41@ and the 42@ of
- west longitude. In any case, it was decided in the Gun Club
- that Blomsberry brothers, Bilsby, and Major Elphinstone should
- go straight to San Francisco, and consult as to the means of
- raising the projectile from the depths of the ocean.
-
- These devoted men set off at once; and the railroad, which will
- soon cross the whole of Central America, took them as far as St.
- Louis, where the swift mail-coaches awaited them. Almost at the
- same moment in which the Secretary of Marine, the vice-president
- of the Gun Club, and the sub-director of the Observatory received
- the dispatch from San Francisco, the Honorable J. T. Maston was
- undergoing the greatest excitement he had ever experienced in his
- life, an excitement which even the bursting of his pet gun, which
- had more than once nearly cost him his life, had not caused him.
- We may remember that the secretary of the Gun Club had started
- soon after the projectile (and almost as quickly) for the station
- on Long's Peak, in the Rocky Mountains, J. Belfast, director of the
- Cambridge Observatory, accompanying him. Arrived there, the two
- friends had installed themselves at once, never quitting the
- summit of their enormous telescope. We know that this gigantic
- instrument had been set up according to the reflecting system,
- called by the English "front view." This arrangement subjected
- all objects to but one reflection, making the view consequently
- much clearer; the result was that, when they were taking
- observation, J. T. Maston and Belfast were placed in the _upper_
- part of the instrument and not in the lower, which they reached
- by a circular staircase, a masterpiece of lightness, while below
- them opened a metal well terminated by the metallic mirror,
- which measured two hundred and eighty feet in depth.
-
- It was on a narrow platform placed above the telescope that the
- two savants passed their existence, execrating the day which hid
- the moon from their eyes, and the clouds which obstinately
- veiled her during the night.
-
- What, then, was their delight when, after some days of waiting,
- on the night of the 5th of December, they saw the vehicle which
- was bearing their friends into space! To this delight succeeded
- a great deception, when, trusting to a cursory observation, they
- launched their first telegram to the world, erroneously
- affirming that the projectile had become a satellite of the
- moon, gravitating in an immutable orbit.
-
- From that moment it had never shown itself to their eyes-- a
- disappearance all the more easily explained, as it was then
- passing behind the moon's invisible disc; but when it was time
- for it to reappear on the visible disc, one may imagine the
- impatience of the fuming J. T. Maston and his not less
- impatient companion. Each minute of the night they thought
- they saw the projectile once more, and they did not see it.
- Hence constant discussions and violent disputes between them,
- Belfast affirming that the projectile could not be seen, J. T.
- Maston maintaining that "it had put his eyes out."
-
- "It is the projectile!" repeated J. T. Maston.
-
- "No," answered Belfast; "it is an avalanche detached from a
- lunar mountain."
-
- "Well, we shall see it to-morrow."
-
- "No, we shall not see it any more. It is carried into space."
-
- "Yes!"
-
- "No!"
-
- And at these moments, when contradictions rained like hail, the
- well-known irritability of the secretary of the Gun Club
- constituted a permanent danger for the Honorable Belfast.
- The existence of these two together would soon have become
- impossible; but an unforseen event cut short their
- everlasting discussions.
-
- During the night, from the 14th to the 15th of December, the two
- irreconcilable friends were busy observing the lunar disc, J. T.
- Maston abusing the learned Belfast as usual, who was by his
- side; the secretary of the Gun Club maintaining for the
- thousandth time that he had just seen the projectile, and adding
- that he could see Michel Ardan's face looking through one of the
- scuttles, at the same time enforcing his argument by a series of
- gestures which his formidable hook rendered very unpleasant.
-
- At this moment Belfast's servant appeared on the platform (it
- was ten at night) and gave him a dispatch. It was the commander
- of the Susquehanna's telegram.
-
- Belfast tore the envelope and read, and uttered a cry.
-
- "What!" said J. T. Maston.
-
- "The projectile!"
-
- "Well!"
-
- "Has fallen to the earth!"
-
- Another cry, this time a perfect howl, answered him. He turned
- toward J. T. Maston. The unfortunate man, imprudently leaning
- over the metal tube, had disappeared in the immense telescope.
- A fall of two hundred and eighty feet! Belfast, dismayed,
- rushed to the orifice of the reflector.
-
- He breathed. J. T. Maston, caught by his metal hook, was
- holding on by one of the rings which bound the telescope
- together, uttering fearful cries.
-
- Belfast called. Help was brought, tackle was let down, and they
- hoisted up, not without some trouble, the imprudent secretary of
- the Gun Club.
-
- He reappeared at the upper orifice without hurt.
-
- "Ah!" said he, "if I had broken the mirror?"
-
- "You would have paid for it," replied Belfast severely.
-
- "And that cursed projectile has fallen?" asked J. T. Maston.
-
- "Into the Pacific!"
-
- "Let us go!"
-
- A quarter of an hour after the two savants were descending the
- declivity of the Rocky Mountains; and two days after, at the
- same time as their friends of the Gun Club, they arrived at San
- Francisco, having killed five horses on the road.
-
- Elphinstone, the brothers Blomsberry, and Bilsby rushed toward
- them on their arrival.
-
- "What shall we do?" they exclaimed.
-
- "Fish up the projectile," replied J. T. Maston, "and the sooner
- the better."
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXII
-
-
- RECOVERED FROM THE SEA
-
-
- The spot where the projectile sank under the waves was exactly
- known; but the machinery to grasp it and bring it to the surface
- of the ocean was still wanting. It must first be invented,
- then made. American engineers could not be troubled with
- such trifles. The grappling-irons once fixed, by their help
- they were sure to raise it in spite of its weight, which was
- lessened by the density of the liquid in which it was plunged.
-
- But fishing-up the projectile was not the only thing to be thought of.
- They must act promptly in the interest of the travelers. No one
- doubted that they were still living.
-
- "Yes," repeated J. T. Maston incessantly, whose confidence
- gained over everybody, "our friends are clever people, and they
- cannot have fallen like simpletons. They are alive, quite alive;
- but we must make haste if we wish to find them so. Food and
- water do not trouble me; they have enough for a long while.
- But air, air, that is what they will soon want; so quick, quick!"
-
- And they did go quick. They fitted up the Susquehanna for her
- new destination. Her powerful machinery was brought to bear
- upon the hauling-chains. The aluminum projectile only weighed
- 19,250 pounds, a weight very inferior to that of the transatlantic
- cable which had been drawn up under similar conditions. The only
- difficulty was in fishing up a cylindro-conical projectile, the
- walls of which were so smooth as to offer no hold for the hooks.
- On that account Engineer Murchison hastened to San Francisco,
- and had some enormous grappling-irons fixed on an automatic
- system, which would never let the projectile go if it once
- succeeded in seizing it in its powerful claws. Diving-dresses
- were also prepared, which through this impervious covering allowed
- the divers to observe the bottom of the sea. He also had put on
- board an apparatus of compressed air very cleverly designed.
- There were perfect chambers pierced with scuttles, which, with
- water let into certain compartments, could draw it down into
- great depths. These apparatuses were at San Francisco, where
- they had been used in the construction of a submarine breakwater;
- and very fortunately it was so, for there was no time to
- construct any. But in spite of the perfection of the machinery,
- in spite of the ingenuity of the savants entrusted with the use
- of them, the success of the operation was far from being certain.
- How great were the chances against them, the projectile being
- 20,000 feet under the water! And if even it was brought to the
- surface, how would the travelers have borne the terrible shock
- which 20,000 feet of water had perhaps not sufficiently broken?
- At any rate they must act quickly. J. T. Maston hurried the
- workmen day and night. He was ready to don the diving-dress
- himself, or try the air apparatus, in order to reconnoiter the
- situation of his courageous friends.
-
- But in spite of all the diligence displayed in preparing the
- different engines, in spite of the considerable sum placed at
- the disposal of the Gun Club by the Government of the Union,
- five long days (five centuries!) elapsed before the preparations
- were complete. During this time public opinion was excited to
- the highest pitch. Telegrams were exchanged incessantly
- throughout the entire world by means of wires and electric cables.
- The saving of Barbicane, Nicholl, and Michel Ardan was an
- international affair. Every one who had subscribed to the Gun
- Club was directly interested in the welfare of the travelers.
-
- At length the hauling-chains, the air-chambers, and the
- automatic grappling-irons were put on board. J. T. Maston,
- Engineer Murchison, and the delegates of the Gun Club, were
- already in their cabins. They had but to start, which they did
- on the 21st of December, at eight o'clock at night, the corvette
- meeting with a beautiful sea, a northeasterly wind, and rather
- sharp cold. The whole population of San Francisco was gathered
- on the quay, greatly excited but silent, reserving their hurrahs
- for the return. Steam was fully up, and the screw of the
- Susquehanna carried them briskly out of the bay.
-
- It is needless to relate the conversations on board between
- the officers, sailors, and passengers. All these men had but
- one thought. All these hearts beat under the same emotion.
- While they were hastening to help them, what were Barbicane and
- his companions doing? What had become of them? Were they able to
- attempt any bold maneuver to regain their liberty? None could say.
- The truth is that every attempt must have failed! Immersed nearly
- four miles under the ocean, this metal prison defied every effort
- of its prisoners.
-
- On the 23rd inst., at eight in the morning, after a rapid
- passage, the Susquehanna was due at the fatal spot. They must
- wait till twelve to take the reckoning exactly. The buoy
- to which the sounding line had been lashed had not yet
- been recognized.
-
- At twelve, Captain Blomsberry, assisted by his officers who
- superintended the observations, took the reckoning in the
- presence of the delegates of the Gun Club. Then there was a
- moment of anxiety. Her position decided, the Susquehanna was
- found to be some minutes westward of the spot where the
- projectile had disappeared beneath the waves.
-
- The ship's course was then changed so as to reach this exact point.
-
- At forty-seven minutes past twelve they reached the buoy; it was
- in perfect condition, and must have shifted but little.
-
- "At last!" exclaimed J. T. Maston.
-
- "Shall we begin?" asked Captain Blomsberry.
-
- "Without losing a second."
-
- Every precaution was taken to keep the corvette almost
- completely motionless. Before trying to seize the projectile,
- Engineer Murchison wanted to find its exact position at the
- bottom of the ocean. The submarine apparatus destined for this
- expedition was supplied with air. The working of these engines
- was not without danger, for at 20,000 feet below the surface of
- the water, and under such great pressure, they were exposed to
- fracture, the consequences of which would be dreadful.
-
- J. T. Maston, the brothers Blomsberry, and Engineer Murchison,
- without heeding these dangers, took their places in the
- air-chamber. The commander, posted on his bridge, superintended
- the operation, ready to stop or haul in the chains on the
- slightest signal. The screw had been shipped, and the whole
- power of the machinery collected on the capstan would have
- quickly drawn the apparatus on board. The descent began at
- twenty-five minutes past one at night, and the chamber,
- drawn under by the reservoirs full of water, disappeared
- from the surface of the ocean.
-
- The emotion of the officers and sailors on board was now
- divided between the prisoners in the projectile and the
- prisoners in the submarine apparatus. As to the latter, they
- forgot themselves, and, glued to the windows of the scuttles,
- attentively watched the liquid mass through which they were passing.
-
- The descent was rapid. At seventeen minutes past two, J. T.
- Maston and his companions had reached the bottom of the Pacific;
- but they saw nothing but an arid desert, no longer animated by
- either fauna or flora. By the light of their lamps, furnished
- with powerful reflectors, they could see the dark beds of the
- ocean for a considerable extent of view, but the projectile was
- nowhere to be seen.
-
- The impatience of these bold divers cannot be described, and
- having an electrical communication with the corvette, they made
- a signal already agreed upon, and for the space of a mile the
- Susquehanna moved their chamber along some yards above the bottom.
-
- Thus they explored the whole submarine plain, deceived at every
- turn by optical illusions which almost broke their hearts.
- Here a rock, there a projection from the ground, seemed to be
- the much-sought-for projectile; but their mistake was soon
- discovered, and then they were in despair.
-
- "But where are they? where are they?" cried J. T. Maston. And the
- poor man called loudly upon Nicholl, Barbicane, and Michel Ardan,
- as if his unfortunate friends could either hear or answer him
- through such an impenetrable medium! The search continued under
- these conditions until the vitiated air compelled the divers to ascend.
-
- The hauling in began about six in the evening, and was not ended
- before midnight.
-
- "To-morrow," said J. T. Maston, as he set foot on the bridge of
- the corvette.
-
- "Yes," answered Captain Blomsberry.
-
- "And on another spot?"
-
- "Yes."
-
- J. T. Maston did not doubt of their final success, but his
- companions, no longer upheld by the excitement of the first
- hours, understood all the difficulty of the enterprise.
- What seemed easy at San Francisco, seemed here in the wide
- ocean almost impossible. The chances of success diminished in
- rapid proportion; and it was from chance alone that the meeting
- with the projectile might be expected.
-
- The next day, the 24th, in spite of the fatigue of the previous
- day, the operation was renewed. The corvette advanced some
- minutes to westward, and the apparatus, provided with air, bore
- the same explorers to the depths of the ocean.
-
- The whole day passed in fruitless research; the bed of the sea
- was a desert. The 25th brought no other result, nor the 26th.
-
- It was disheartening. They thought of those unfortunates shut
- up in the projectile for twenty-six days. Perhaps at that
- moment they were experiencing the first approach of suffocation;
- that is, if they had escaped the dangers of their fall. The air
- was spent, and doubtless with the air all their _morale_.
-
- "The air, possibly," answered J. T. Maston resolutely, "but
- their _morale_ never!"
-
- On the 28th, after two more days of search, all hope was gone.
- This projectile was but an atom in the immensity of the ocean.
- They must give up all idea of finding it.
-
- But J. T. Maston would not hear of going away. He would not
- abandon the place without at least discovering the tomb of
- his friends. But Commander Blomsberry could no longer persist,
- and in spite of the exclamations of the worthy secretary, was
- obliged to give the order to sail.
-
- On the 29th of December, at nine A.M., the Susquehanna, heading
- northeast, resumed her course to the bay of San Francisco.
-
- It was ten in the morning; the corvette was under half-steam, as
- it was regretting to leave the spot where the catastrophe had
- taken place, when a sailor, perched on the main-top-gallant
- crosstrees, watching the sea, cried suddenly:
-
- "A buoy on the lee bow!"
-
- The officers looked in the direction indicated, and by the help
- of their glasses saw that the object signalled had the
- appearance of one of those buoys which are used to mark the
- passages of bays or rivers. But, singularly to say, a flag
- floating on the wind surmounted its cone, which emerged five
- or six feet out of water. This buoy shone under the rays
- of the sun as if it had been made of plates of silver.
- Commander Blomsberry, J. T. Maston, and the delegates of the Gun
- Club were mounted on the bridge, examining this object straying
- at random on the waves.
-
- All looked with feverish anxiety, but in silence. None dared
- give expression to the thoughts which came to the minds of all.
-
- The corvette approached to within two cables' lengths of the object.
-
- A shudder ran through the whole crew. That flag was the
- American flag!
-
- At this moment a perfect howling was heard; it was the brave J.
- T. Maston who had just fallen all in a heap. Forgetting on the
- one hand that his right arm had been replaced by an iron hook,
- and on the other that a simple gutta-percha cap covered his
- brain-box, he had given himself a formidable blow.
-
- They hurried toward him, picked him up, restored him to life.
- And what were his first words?
-
- "Ah! trebly brutes! quadruply idiots! quintuply boobies that we are!"
-
- "What is it?" exclaimed everyone around him.
-
- "What is it?"
-
- "Come, speak!"
-
- "It is, simpletons," howled the terrible secretary, "it is that
- the projectile only weighs 19,250 pounds!"
-
- "Well?"
-
- "And that it displaces twenty-eight tons, or in other words
- 56,000 pounds, and that consequently _it floats_!"
-
- Ah! what stress the worthy man had laid on the verb "float!"
- And it was true! All, yes! all these savants had forgotten
- this fundamental law, namely, that on account of its specific
- lightness, the projectile, after having been drawn by its fall
- to the greatest depths of the ocean, must naturally return to
- the surface. And now it was floating quietly at the mercy of
- the waves.
-
- The boats were put to sea. J. T. Maston and his friends had
- rushed into them! Excitement was at its height! Every heart
- beat loudly while they advanced to the projectile. What did
- it contain? Living or dead?
-
- Living, yes! living, at least unless death had struck
- Barbicane and his two friends since they had hoisted the flag.
- Profound silence reigned on the boats. All were breathless.
- Eyes no longer saw. One of the scuttles of the projectile was open.
- Some pieces of glass remained in the frame, showing that it had
- been broken. This scuttle was actually five feet above the water.
-
- A boat came alongside, that of J. T. Maston, and J. T. Maston
- rushed to the broken window.
-
- At that moment they heard a clear and merry voice, the voice of
- Michel Ardan, exclaiming in an accent of triumph:
-
- "White all, Barbicane, white all!"
-
- Barbicane, Michel Ardan, and Nicholl were playing at dominoes!
-
-
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XXIII
-
-
- THE END
-
-
- We may remember the intense sympathy which had accompanied the
- travelers on their departure. If at the beginning of the
- enterprise they had excited such emotion both in the old and
- new world, with what enthusiasm would they be received on
- their return! The millions of spectators which had beset
- the peninsula of Florida, would they not rush to meet these
- sublime adventurers? Those legions of strangers, hurrying from
- all parts of the globe toward the American shores, would they
- leave the Union without having seen Barbicane, Nicholl, and
- Michel Ardan? No! and the ardent passion of the public was
- bound to respond worthily to the greatness of the enterprise.
- Human creatures who had left the terrestrial sphere, and returned
- after this strange voyage into celestial space, could not fail
- to be received as the prophet Elias would be if he came back
- to earth. To see them first, and then to hear them, such was
- the universal longing.
-
- Barbicane, Michel Ardan, Nicholl, and the delegates of the Gun
- Club, returning without delay to Baltimore, were received with
- indescribable enthusiasm. The notes of President Barbicane's
- voyage were ready to be given to the public. The New York
- _Herald_ bought the manuscript at a price not yet known, but
- which must have been very high. Indeed, during the publication
- of "A Journey to the Moon," the sale of this paper amounted to
- five millions of copies. Three days after the return of
- the travelers to the earth, the slightest detail of their
- expedition was known. There remained nothing more but to see
- the heroes of this superhuman enterprise.
-
- The expedition of Barbicane and his friends round the moon had
- enabled them to correct the many admitted theories regarding the
- terrestrial satellite. These savants had observed _de visu_,
- and under particular circumstances. They knew what systems
- should be rejected, what retained with regard to the formation
- of that orb, its origin, its habitability. Its past, present,
- and future had even given up their last secrets. Who could
- advance objections against conscientious observers, who at less
- than twenty-four miles distance had marked that curious mountain
- of Tycho, the strangest system of lunar orography? How answer
- those savants whose sight had penetrated the abyss of
- Pluto's circle? How contradict those bold ones whom the chances
- of their enterprise had borne over that invisible face of the
- disc, which no human eye until then had ever seen? It was now
- their turn to impose some limit on that selenographic science,
- which had reconstructed the lunar world as Cuvier did the
- skeleton of a fossil, and say, "The moon _was_ this, a habitable
- world, inhabited before the earth. The moon _is_ that, a world
- uninhabitable, and now uninhabited."
-
- To celebrate the return of its most illustrious member and his
- two companions, the Gun Club decided upon giving a banquet, but
- a banquet worthy of the conquerors, worthy of the American
- people, and under such conditions that all the inhabitants of
- the Union could directly take part in it.
-
- All the head lines of railroads in the States were joined by
- flying rails; and on all the platforms, lined with the same
- flags, and decorated with the same ornaments, were tables laid
- and all served alike. At certain hours, successively
- calculated, marked by electric clocks which beat the seconds at
- the same time, the population were invited to take their places
- at the banquet tables. For four days, from the 5th to the 9th
- of January, the trains were stopped as they are on Sundays on
- the railways of the United States, and every road was open.
- One engine only at full speed, drawing a triumphal carriage, had
- the right of traveling for those four days on the railroads of
- the United States.
-
- The engine was manned by a driver and a stoker, and bore, by
- special favor, the Hon. J. T. Maston, secretary of the Gun Club.
- The carriage was reserved for President Barbicane, Colonel
- Nicholl, and Michel Ardan. At the whistle of the driver, amid
- the hurrahs, and all the admiring vociferations of the American
- language, the train left the platform of Baltimore. It traveled
- at a speed of one hundred and sixty miles in the hour. But what
- was this speed compared with that which had carried the three
- heroes from the mouth of the Columbiad?
-
- Thus they sped from one town to the other, finding whole
- populations at table on their road, saluting them with the same
- acclamations, lavishing the same bravos! They traveled in this
- way through the east of the Union, Pennsylvania, Connecticut,
- Massachusetts, Vermont, Maine, and New Hampshire; the north and
- west by New York, Ohio, Michigan, and Wisconsin; returning to
- the south by Illinois, Missouri, Arkansas, Texas, and Louisiana;
- they went to the southeast by Alabama and Florida, going up by
- Georgia and the Carolinas, visiting the center by Tennessee,
- Kentucky, Virginia, and Indiana, and, after quitting the
- Washington station, re-entered Baltimore, where for four days
- one would have thought that the United States of America were
- seated at one immense banquet, saluting them simultaneously with
- the same hurrahs! The apotheosis was worthy of these three
- heroes whom fable would have placed in the rank of demigods.
-
- And now will this attempt, unprecedented in the annals of
- travels, lead to any practical result? Will direct
- communication with the moon ever be established? Will they
- ever lay the foundation of a traveling service through the
- solar world? Will they go from one planet to another, from
- Jupiter to Mercury, and after awhile from one star to another,
- from the Polar to Sirius? Will this means of locomotion allow
- us to visit those suns which swarm in the firmament?
-
- To such questions no answer can be given. But knowing the bold
- ingenuity of the Anglo-Saxon race, no one would be astonished if
- the Americans seek to make some use of President Barbicane's attempt.
-
- Thus, some time after the return of the travelers, the public
- received with marked favor the announcement of a company,
- limited, with a capital of a hundred million of dollars, divided
- into a hundred thousand shares of a thousand dollars each, under
- the name of the "National Company of Interstellary Communication."
- President, Barbicane; vice-president, Captain Nicholl; secretary,
- J. T. Maston; director of movements, Michel Ardan.
-
- And as it is part of the American temperament to foresee
- everything in business, even failure, the Honorable Harry
- Trolloppe, judge commissioner, and Francis Drayton, magistrate,
- were nominated beforehand!
-
-
- End of Project Gutenberg etext of "From the Earth to the Moon"
- and the sequel "Round the Moon" published as one Etext.
-
-
- ******* Notes:
- Jules Verne's "From the Earth to the Moon" and "A Trip Around It"
- >
- >I originally intended to "correct" some of the numbers in the book.
- >For example, page 207 has "thirteenth" where "thirtieth" would be
- >more appropriate. Some of the densities and volumes and masses don't
- >match up. The business with the wrong exhaust velocity of the gun
- >is also a bit confusing. The dates and times aren't quite consistent
- >throughout, although they are close enough that Verne must have been
- >working from a time-line. For example, I think he has the time for
- >the fall back to earth exactly matching the time for the trip out.
- >There are also inconsistent spellings, for example "aluminum" and
- >"aluminium". Some of these annoyed me, in the sense of disturbing
- >my reading; since the reader is reading for pleasure, the annoyance
- >should be removed.
-
-
- All cases of the British? spelling of aluminium have been changed
- to the American spelling aluminum.
-
-
- >I decided that the correction project was going to be a lot of trouble,
- >and might be a perversion of the original work. I concentrated instead
- >on producing an accurate rendition of the text. However, if a French
- >speaker can find a French edition, it might be nice to see if the
- >translators introduced errors. The measurements seem to have been
- >converted from metric without regard for significant figures. Occasional
- >conversions are simply omitted, with "feet" inserted for "meters" without
- >fixing the numbers. These might be safely recomputed without doing
- >violence to the spirit of the original work. Whether one should
- >standardize the spelling of "aluminium" I don't know. "Aluminium"
- >has a certain charm. I don't know what American or English usage was
- >at the time. We might consider converting all the temperatures to
- >Fahrenheit. I suggest removing the page numbers, undoing all the
- >hyphenation, and repackaging the lines at a length of (up to) 72
- >characters,
- >with only occasional word breaks.
-
-
- Page #s and a full reformating has been done. Line widow/orphans
- have been painstakingly removed. Hypenated words at the end of lines
- have been eliminated to the best of my judgement.
-
-
- >I think a table of units should be offered for the reader.
- >myriameter = 10 km
- >fathom = 6 feet; league ~ 3 miles, but don't know French usage in 1865.
- >page 125 has perigee 86,410 leagues (French), or 238,833 miles <mean>
- >Would be nice to know the currency conversions of the day.
- >
- >We may criticize Verne for his errors, but the remarkable thing is
- >how much he got right! I think this was the first engineering proposal
- >for space travel, using physics instead of magic. Verne deserves much
- >of the credit for inspiring the early rocket pioneers, and ultimately
- >today's space program. As "literary" history, I note that Heinlein's
- >"The Man Who Sold the Moon" borrows from it.
- >
- ><add conversion table for units. fathom, league, meter, mile, foot, C/F>
- ><contact publisher for translator information>
- ><is perihelium {sic} a real word? maybe substitute perihelion?>
-
-
- I have changed the one case of perihelium to the correct perihelion.
-
-
- ><There's an incorrect reference to Nov. 30 in the early part of book 2 to
- >fix> [I read it over and left it there. Close enough for fiction, but I
- am sure they would have missed the moon by a lot.]
-
-
- Dates were not fixed.
-
-
- ><inconsistent spelling of Palliser, Palisser>
-
-
- This only occurs twice in the book, so both are left in.
-
-
- ><pyroxyle sometimes with xile>
-
-
- `yle' ending was accepted by undisputed "majority rule"
-
-
- ><aluminum and aluminium>
-
-
- The former accepted.
-
-
- ><maybe 18000 instead of 17000 yards/sec?>
- ><30th degree of lunar latitude instead of 13th?>
- ><there seems to be an inconsistency in the title for book 2>
-
-
- Numbers, units, dates, times and math errors have NOT been changed.
-
-
- >Typographic conventions in the book:
- >The book uses ligatures for ff fi fl ffi ffl; I have simply spelled these
- >out.
- >Chapter N is in italics.
- >The chapter titles are in small caps.
- >The first word of each chapter has an oversize capital,
- >and the rest of the word is in small caps. If the first
- >word is two letters or less, the second word is also in
- >small caps.
- >AM and PM are always in small caps, as A.M. or P.M.
-
-
- All these have been changed to PG standards.
-
-
- >My typographic conventions:
- >There are a few lines longer than 80 character, usually because I have
- >inserted a {sic phrase} in the line. I am using % as a line-break
- >character
- >in these cases; the % and the following new-line should be deleted.
- >{correction} I have indicated some candidates for correction in braces.
-
-
- All these were appreciated! and either corrected or ignored.
-
-
- >_italics_ are marked with underbars
-
-
- These are left in for the next proofer to turn into CAPS for PG.
-
-
- >#SMALL CAPS# are enclosed in hash-marks
- >$ae $'e dollar-sign preceeds ligatures and accented characters.
- > The accent follows the $ and precedes the letter. I've tried to get
- > ' and ` (as accents) right.
- > I have used : as an accent marker for umlaut.
-
-
- All are removed.
-
-
- >^2 means superscript 2. circumflex also occurs as an accent marker.
- >I've used ` and ' to enclose (recursive) quotes. Ascii has no provision
- >for distinguishable open and close doublequotes.
- >The book uses ligatures for ff fi fl ffi ffl; I have simply spelled these
- >out.
- >-- moderate dash and---- long dash I have added surrounding spaces.
- >I also switched to double space between sentences.
- >@ degree sign
- >L for British Pound.
-
-
- All these conventions (except the circumflex) have been accepted.
-
-
- ><bold> indicates a different typeface
-
- Removed (only one case) and probably a printers error?
-
-
- ><delta> indicates a non-ascii character, here the greek letter delta
-
-
- Left in.
-
-
-